DS2155GN [MAXIM]

T1/E1/J1 Single-Chip Transceiver;
DS2155GN
型号: DS2155GN
厂家: MAXIM INTEGRATED PRODUCTS    MAXIM INTEGRATED PRODUCTS
描述:

T1/E1/J1 Single-Chip Transceiver

电信 电信集成电路
文件: 总238页 (文件大小:2001K)
中文:  中文翻译
下载:  下载PDF数据表文档文件
DS2155  
T1/E1/J1 Single-Chip Transceiver  
www.maxim-ic.com  
GENERAL DESCRIPTION  
FEATURES  
The DS2155 is a software-selectable T1, E1, or J1  
single-chip transceiver (SCT) for short-haul and  
long-haul applications. The DS2155 is composed of a  
line interface unit (LIU), framer, HDLC controllers,  
and a TDM backplane interface, and is controlled by  
an 8-bit parallel port configured for Intel or Motorola  
bus operations. The DS2155 is pin and software  
compatible with the DS2156.  
Complete T1/DS1/ISDN-PRI/J1 Transceiver  
Functionality  
Complete E1 (CEPT) PCM-30/ISDN-PRI  
Transceiver Functionality  
Long-Haul and Short-Haul Line Interface for  
Clock/Data Recovery and Waveshaping  
CMI Coder/Decoder for Optical I/F  
Crystal-Less Jitter Attenuator  
Fully Independent Transmit and Receive  
Functionality  
The LIU is composed of transmit and receive  
interfaces and a jitter attenuator. The transmit  
interface is responsible for generating the necessary  
waveshapes for driving the network and providing  
the correct source impedance depending on the type  
of media used. T1 waveform generation includes  
DSX-1 line buildouts as well as CSU line buildouts  
of -7.5dB, -15dB, and -22.5dB. E1 waveform  
generation includes G.703 waveshapes for both 75  
coax and 120twisted cables. The receive interface  
provides network termination and recovers clock and  
data from the network.  
Dual HDLC Controllers  
Programmable BERT Generator and Detector  
Internal Software-Selectable Receive and  
Transmit-Side Termination Resistors for  
75/100/120T1 and E1 Interfaces  
Dual Two-Frame Elastic-Store Slip Buffers that  
Connect to Asynchronous Backplanes Up to  
16.384MHz  
16.384MHz, 8.192MHz, 4.096MHz, or  
2.048MHz Clock Output Synthesized to  
Recovered Network Clock  
Features continued in Section 3.  
APPLICATIONS  
T1/E1/J1 Line Cards  
Switches and Routers  
Add-Drop Multiplexers  
ORDERING INFORMATION  
PART  
TEMP RANGE PIN-PACKAGE  
DS2155L  
0°C to +70°C  
0°C to +70°C  
-40°C to +85°C 100 LQFP  
-40°C to +85°C 100 LQFP  
0°C to +70°C  
0°C to +70°C  
-40°C to +85°C 100 CSBGA  
-40°C to +85°C 100 CSBGA  
100 LQFP  
100 LQFP  
DS2155L+  
DS2155LN  
DS2155LN+  
DS2155G  
DS2155G+  
DS2155GN  
DS2155GN  
DS2155  
T1/E1/J1  
SCT  
T1/E1/J1  
NETWORK  
BACKPLANE  
100 CSBGA  
100 CSBGA  
TDM  
+ Denotes a lead-free/RoHS-compliant package.  
Note: Some revisions of this device may incorporate deviations from published specifications known as errata. Multiple revisions of any device  
may be simultaneously available through various sales channels. For information about device errata, click here: www.maxim-ic.com/errata.  
1 of 238  
REV: 080607  
DS2155  
1. TABLE OF CONTENTS  
1.  
TABLE OF CONTENTS............................................................................................................................2  
1.1 TABLE OF FIGURES ........................................................................................................................................6  
1.2 TABLE OF TABLES..........................................................................................................................................7  
2.  
3.  
DATA SHEET REVISION HISTORY .....................................................................................................8  
MAIN FEATURES....................................................................................................................................10  
3.1 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION .........................................................................................................................13  
3.2 BLOCK DIAGRAM.........................................................................................................................................15  
4.  
PIN FUNCTION DESCRIPTION ...........................................................................................................19  
4.1 TRANSMIT SIDE ...........................................................................................................................................19  
4.2 RECEIVE SIDE ..............................................................................................................................................21  
4.3 PARALLEL CONTROL PORT PINS .................................................................................................................24  
4.4 EXTENDED SYSTEM INFORMATION BUS......................................................................................................25  
4.5 USER OUTPUT PORT PINS ............................................................................................................................26  
4.6 JTAG TEST ACCESS PORT PINS...................................................................................................................27  
4.7 LINE INTERFACE PINS..................................................................................................................................28  
4.8 SUPPLY PINS ................................................................................................................................................29  
4.9 L AND G PACKAGE PINOUT.........................................................................................................................30  
4.10  
10MM CSBGA PIN CONFIGURATION ......................................................................................................32  
5.  
6.  
PARALLEL PORT ...................................................................................................................................33  
5.1 REGISTER MAP ............................................................................................................................................33  
PROGRAMMING MODEL.....................................................................................................................39  
6.1 POWER-UP SEQUENCE.................................................................................................................................40  
6.1.1  
Master Mode Register.........................................................................................................................40  
6.2 INTERRUPT HANDLING ................................................................................................................................41  
6.3 STATUS REGISTERS......................................................................................................................................41  
6.4 INFORMATION REGISTERS ...........................................................................................................................42  
6.5 INTERRUPT INFORMATION REGISTERS ........................................................................................................42  
7.  
8.  
9.  
SPECIAL PER-CHANNEL REGISTER OPERATION.......................................................................43  
CLOCK MAP ............................................................................................................................................45  
T1 FRAMER/FORMATTER CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS............................................46  
9.1 T1 CONTROL REGISTERS .............................................................................................................................46  
9.2 T1 TRANSMIT TRANSPARENCY ...................................................................................................................51  
9.3 AIS-CI AND RAI-CI GENERATION AND DETECTION ..................................................................................51  
9.4 T1 RECEIVE-SIDE DIGITAL-MILLIWATT CODE GENERATION.....................................................................52  
10.  
E1 FRAMER/FORMATTER CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS............................................55  
10.1  
E1 CONTROL REGISTERS.........................................................................................................................55  
AUTOMATIC ALARM GENERATION .........................................................................................................59  
E1 INFORMATION REGISTERS..................................................................................................................60  
10.2  
10.3  
11.  
11.1  
COMMON CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS ..........................................................................62  
T1/E1 STATUS REGISTERS ......................................................................................................................63  
2 of 238  
 
DS2155  
12.  
13.  
I/O PIN CONFIGURATION OPTIONS.................................................................................................69  
LOOPBACK CONFIGURATION ..........................................................................................................71  
PER-CHANNEL LOOPBACK ......................................................................................................................73  
ERROR COUNT REGISTERS ...............................................................................................................75  
LINE-CODE VIOLATION COUNT REGISTER (LCVCR).............................................................................76  
13.1  
14.  
14.1  
14.1.1 T1 Operation.......................................................................................................................................76  
14.1.2 E1 Operation.......................................................................................................................................76  
14.2  
PATH CODE VIOLATION COUNT REGISTER (PCVCR) ............................................................................78  
14.2.1 T1 Operation.......................................................................................................................................78  
14.2.2 E1 Operation.......................................................................................................................................78  
14.3  
FRAMES OUT-OF-SYNC COUNT REGISTER (FOSCR)..............................................................................79  
14.3.1 T1 Operation.......................................................................................................................................79  
14.3.2 E1 Operation.......................................................................................................................................79  
14.4  
E-BIT COUNTER (EBCR).........................................................................................................................80  
15.  
DS0 MONITORING FUNCTION ...........................................................................................................81  
16.  
SIGNALING OPERATION .....................................................................................................................83  
16.1  
RECEIVE SIGNALING ...............................................................................................................................83  
16.1.1 Processor-Based Signaling.................................................................................................................83  
16.1.2 Hardware-Based Receive Signaling ...................................................................................................84  
16.2  
TRANSMIT SIGNALING.............................................................................................................................89  
16.2.1 Processor-Based Mode.......................................................................................................................89  
16.2.2 Software Signaling Insertion-Enable Registers, E1 CAS Mode..........................................................93  
16.2.3 Software Signaling Insertion-Enable Registers, T1 Mode..................................................................95  
16.2.4 Hardware-Based Mode.......................................................................................................................95  
17.  
PER-CHANNEL IDLE CODE GENERATION ....................................................................................96  
17.1  
IDLE-CODE PROGRAMMING EXAMPLES..................................................................................................97  
18.  
CHANNEL BLOCKING REGISTERS ................................................................................................101  
19.  
ELASTIC STORES OPERATION........................................................................................................104  
19.1  
RECEIVE SIDE........................................................................................................................................107  
19.1.1 T1 Mode............................................................................................................................................107  
19.1.2 E1 Mode............................................................................................................................................107  
19.2  
TRANSMIT SIDE .....................................................................................................................................107  
19.2.1 T1 Mode............................................................................................................................................108  
19.2.2 E1 Mode............................................................................................................................................108  
19.3  
19.4  
ELASTIC STORES INITIALIZATION .........................................................................................................108  
MINIMUM DELAY MODE .......................................................................................................................108  
20.  
G.706 INTERMEDIATE CRC-4 UPDATING (E1 MODE ONLY)...................................................109  
21.  
T1 BIT-ORIENTED CODE (BOC) CONTROLLER..........................................................................110  
21.1  
TRANSMIT BOC.....................................................................................................................................110  
Transmit a BOC ..............................................................................................................................................110  
21.2  
RECEIVE BOC .......................................................................................................................................110  
Receive a BOC.................................................................................................................................................110  
22.  
ADDITIONAL (SA) AND INTERNATIONAL (SI) BIT OPERATION (E1 ONLY) ......................113  
3 of 238  
DS2155  
22.1  
22.2  
22.3  
METHOD 1: HARDWARE SCHEME .........................................................................................................113  
METHOD 2: INTERNAL REGISTER SCHEME BASED ON DOUBLE-FRAME ..............................................113  
METHOD 3: INTERNAL REGISTER SCHEME BASED ON CRC4 MULTIFRAME........................................116  
23.  
HDLC CONTROLLERS........................................................................................................................126  
23.1  
23.2  
BASIC OPERATION DETAILS..................................................................................................................126  
HDLC CONFIGURATION........................................................................................................................126  
23.2.1 FIFO Control....................................................................................................................................130  
23.3  
HDLC MAPPING....................................................................................................................................131  
23.3.1 Receive..............................................................................................................................................131  
23.3.2 Transmit............................................................................................................................................133  
23.3.3 FIFO Information .............................................................................................................................138  
23.3.4 Receive Packet-Bytes Available........................................................................................................138  
23.3.5 HDLC FIFOs ....................................................................................................................................139  
23.4  
23.5  
RECEIVE HDLC CODE EXAMPLE..........................................................................................................140  
LEGACY FDL SUPPORT (T1 MODE)......................................................................................................140  
23.5.1 Overview ...........................................................................................................................................140  
23.5.2 Receive Section .................................................................................................................................140  
23.5.3 Transmit Section ...............................................................................................................................142  
23.6  
24.  
24.1  
24.2  
D4/SLC-96 OPERATION ........................................................................................................................142  
LINE INTERFACE UNIT (LIU) ...........................................................................................................143  
LIU OPERATION ....................................................................................................................................143  
RECEIVER ..............................................................................................................................................143  
24.2.1 Receive Level Indicator and Threshold Interrupt.............................................................................144  
24.2.2 Receive G.703 Synchronization Signal (E1 Mode)...........................................................................144  
24.2.3 Monitor Mode ...................................................................................................................................144  
24.3  
TRANSMITTER .......................................................................................................................................145  
24.3.1 Transmit Short-Circuit Detector/Limiter..........................................................................................145  
24.3.2 Transmit Open-Circuit Detector.......................................................................................................145  
24.3.3 Transmit BPV Error Insertion ..........................................................................................................145  
24.3.4 Transmit G.703 Synchronization Signal (E1 Mode).........................................................................145  
24.4  
MCLK PRESCALER ...............................................................................................................................146  
JITTER ATTENUATOR.............................................................................................................................146  
CMI (CODE MARK INVERSION) OPTION...............................................................................................146  
LIU CONTROL REGISTERS.....................................................................................................................147  
RECOMMENDED CIRCUITS.....................................................................................................................156  
COMPONENT SPECIFICATIONS...............................................................................................................158  
24.5  
24.6  
24.7  
24.8  
24.9  
25.  
26.  
26.1  
PROGRAMMABLE IN-BAND LOOP CODE GENERATION AND DETECTION......................163  
BERT FUNCTION..................................................................................................................................170  
STATUS..................................................................................................................................................170  
MAPPING ...............................................................................................................................................170  
BERT REGISTER DESCRIPTIONS ...........................................................................................................172  
BERT REPETITIVE PATTERN SET..........................................................................................................176  
BERT BIT COUNTER .............................................................................................................................177  
BERT ERROR COUNTER........................................................................................................................178  
26.2  
26.3  
26.4  
26.5  
26.6  
27.  
27.1  
PAYLOAD ERROR-INSERTION FUNCTION (T1 MODE ONLY)................................................180  
NUMBER-OF-ERRORS REGISTERS..........................................................................................................182  
27.1.1 Number-of-Errors Left Register........................................................................................................183  
INTERLEAVED PCM BUS OPERATION (IBO)...............................................................................184  
4 of 238  
28.  
DS2155  
28.1  
28.2  
CHANNEL INTERLEAVE .........................................................................................................................184  
FRAME INTERLEAVE..............................................................................................................................184  
29.  
EXTENDED SYSTEM INFORMATION BUS (ESIB) .......................................................................187  
PROGRAMMABLE BACKPLANE CLOCK SYNTHESIZER ........................................................191  
FRACTIONAL T1/E1 SUPPORT .........................................................................................................191  
USER-PROGRAMMABLE OUTPUT PINS........................................................................................193  
TRANSMIT FLOW DIAGRAMS .........................................................................................................194  
JTAG BOUNDARY SCAN ARCHITECTURE AND TEST ACCESS PORT .................................199  
30.  
31.  
32.  
33.  
34.  
34.1  
DESCRIPTION .........................................................................................................................................199  
INSTRUCTION REGISTER........................................................................................................................202  
TEST REGISTERS....................................................................................................................................204  
BOUNDARY SCAN REGISTER.................................................................................................................204  
BYPASS REGISTER.................................................................................................................................204  
IDENTIFICATION REGISTER....................................................................................................................204  
34.2  
34.3  
34.4  
34.5  
34.6  
35.  
FUNCTIONAL TIMING DIAGRAMS.................................................................................................208  
35.1  
35.2  
T1 MODE ...............................................................................................................................................208  
E1 MODE ...............................................................................................................................................213  
36.  
OPERATING PARAMETERS..............................................................................................................222  
37.  
AC TIMING PARAMETERS AND DIAGRAMS ...............................................................................224  
37.1  
MULTIPLEXED BUS AC CHARACTERISTICS ..........................................................................................224  
NONMULTIPLEXED BUS AC CHARACTERISTICS ...................................................................................227  
RECEIVE-SIDE AC CHARACTERISTICS..................................................................................................230  
BACKPLANE CLOCK TIMING: AC CHARACTERISTICS .........................................................................233  
TRANSMIT AC CHARACTERISTICS ........................................................................................................234  
37.2  
37.3  
37.4  
37.5  
38.  
PACKAGE INFORMATION ................................................................................................................237  
38.1  
38.2  
100-PIN LQFP (56-G5002-000)............................................................................................................237  
100-BALL CSBGA (56-G6008-001) .....................................................................................................238  
5 of 238  
DS2155  
1.1 Table of Figures  
Figure 3-1. Block Diagram........................................................................................................................................ 15  
Figure 3-2. Receive and Transmit LIU...................................................................................................................... 16  
Figure 3-3. Receive and Transmit Framer/HDLC..................................................................................................... 17  
Figure 3-4. Backplane Interface ................................................................................................................................ 18  
Figure 4-1. 10mm CSBGA Pin Configuration .......................................................................................................... 32  
Figure 6-1. Programming Sequence .......................................................................................................................... 39  
Figure 8-1. Clock Map............................................................................................................................................... 45  
Figure 16-1. Simplified Diagram of Receive Signaling Path .................................................................................... 83  
Figure 16-2. Simplified Diagram of Transmit Signaling Path................................................................................... 89  
Figure 20-1. CRC-4 Recalculate Method ................................................................................................................ 109  
Figure 24-1. Typical Monitor Application .............................................................................................................. 144  
Figure 24-2. CMI Coding ........................................................................................................................................ 146  
Figure 24-3. Software-Selected Termination, Metallic Protection.......................................................................... 156  
Figure 24-4. Software-Selected Termination, Longitudinal Protection................................................................... 157  
Figure 24-5. E1 Transmit Pulse Template............................................................................................................... 159  
Figure 24-6. T1 Transmit Pulse Template............................................................................................................... 159  
Figure 24-7. Jitter Tolerance.................................................................................................................................... 160  
Figure 24-8. Jitter Tolerance (E1 Mode) ................................................................................................................. 160  
Figure 24-9. Jitter Attenuation (T1 Mode) .............................................................................................................. 161  
Figure 24-10. Jitter Attenuation (E1 Mode) ............................................................................................................ 161  
Figure 24-11. Optional Crystal Connections........................................................................................................... 162  
Figure 26-1. Simplified Diagram of BERT in Network Direction.......................................................................... 171  
Figure 26-2. Simplified Diagram of BERT in Backplane Direction ....................................................................... 171  
Figure 28-1. IBO Example ...................................................................................................................................... 186  
Figure 29-1. ESIB Group of Four DS2155s ............................................................................................................ 187  
Figure 33-1. T1 Transmit Flow Diagram ................................................................................................................ 194  
Figure 33-2. E1 Transmit Flow Diagram ................................................................................................................ 195  
Figure 34-1. JTAG Functional Block Diagram ....................................................................................................... 199  
Figure 34-2. TAP Controller State Diagram............................................................................................................ 202  
Figure 35-1. Receive-Side D4 Timing..................................................................................................................... 208  
Figure 35-2. Receive-Side ESF Timing................................................................................................................... 208  
Figure 35-3. Receive-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)................................................................... 209  
Figure 35-4. Receive-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled).................................................. 209  
Figure 35-5. Receive-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled).................................................. 210  
Figure 35-6. Transmit-Side D4 Timing................................................................................................................... 210  
Figure 35-7. Transmit-Side ESF Timing................................................................................................................. 211  
Figure 35-8. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing (with Elastic Store Disabled)......................................................... 211  
Figure 35-9. Transmit-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)................................................ 212  
Figure 35-10. Transmit-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled).............................................. 212  
Figure 35-11. Receive-Side Timing ........................................................................................................................ 213  
Figure 35-12. Receive-Side Boundary Timing (with Elastic Store Disabled)......................................................... 213  
Figure 35-13. Receive-Side Boundary Timing, RSYSCLK = 1.544MHz (Elastic Store Enabled) ........................ 214  
Figure 35-14. Receive-Side Boundary Timing, RSYSCLK = 2.048MHz (Elastic Store Enabled) ........................ 214  
Figure 35-15. Receive IBO Channel Interleave Mode Timing ............................................................................... 215  
Figure 35-16. Receive IBO Frame Interleave Mode Timing................................................................................... 216  
Figure 35-17. G.802 Timing, E1 Mode Only .......................................................................................................... 217  
Figure 35-18. Transmit-Side Timing....................................................................................................................... 217  
Figure 35-19. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)............................................................... 218  
Figure 35-20. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing, TSYSCLK = 1.544MHz (Elastic Store Enabled)...................... 218  
Figure 35-21. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing, TSYSCLK = 2.048MHz (Elastic Store Enabled)....................... 219  
Figure 35-22. Transmit IBO Channel Interleave Mode Timing.............................................................................. 220  
6 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 35-23. Transmit IBO Frame Interleave Mode Timing................................................................................. 221  
Figure 37-1. Intel Multiplexed Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 1).................................................................. 225  
Figure 37-2. Intel Multiplexed Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 1)................................................................. 225  
Figure 37-3. Motorola Multiplexed Bus Timing (BTS = 1/MUX = 1) ................................................................... 226  
Figure 37-4. Intel Nonmultiplexed Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 0) ........................................................... 228  
Figure 37-5. Intel Nonmultiplexed Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 0) .......................................................... 228  
Figure 37-6. Motorola Nonmultiplexed Bus Read Timing (BTS = 1/MUX = 0).................................................... 229  
Figure 37-7. Motorola Nonmultiplexed Bus Write Timing (BTS = 1/MUX = 0)................................................... 229  
Figure 37-8. Receive-Side Timing .......................................................................................................................... 231  
Figure 37-9. Receive-Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled ...................................................................................... 232  
Figure 37-10. Receive Line Interface Timing ......................................................................................................... 232  
Figure 37-11 Receive Timing Delay RCLK to BPCLK......................................................................................... 233  
Figure 37-12. Transmit-Side Timing....................................................................................................................... 235  
Figure 37-13. Transmit-Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled................................................................................... 236  
Figure 37-14. Transmit Line Interface Timing........................................................................................................ 236  
1.2 Table of Tables  
Table 4-A. Pin Description Sorted by Pin Number ................................................................................................... 30  
Table 5-A. Register Map Sorted by Address............................................................................................................. 33  
Table 9-A. T1 Alarm Criteria.................................................................................................................................... 54  
Table 10-A. E1 Sync/Resync Criteria ....................................................................................................................... 56  
Table 10-B. E1 Alarm Criteria .................................................................................................................................. 61  
Table 14-A. T1 Line Code Violation Counting Options ........................................................................................... 76  
Table 14-B. E1 Line-Code Violation Counting Options........................................................................................... 76  
Table 14-C. T1 Path Code Violation Counting Arrangements.................................................................................. 78  
Table 14-D. T1 Frames Out-of-Sync Counting Arrangements ................................................................................. 79  
Table 16-A. Time Slot Numbering Schemes............................................................................................................. 90  
Table 17-A. Idle-Code Array Address Mapping ....................................................................................................... 96  
Table 17-B. GRIC and GTIC Functions.................................................................................................................... 98  
Table 19-A. Elastic Store Delay After Initialization ............................................................................................... 108  
Table 23-A. HDLC Controller Registers................................................................................................................. 127  
Table 24-A. Component List (Software-Selected Termination, Metallic Protection)............................................. 156  
Table 24-B. Component List (Software-Selected Termination, Longitudinal Protection)...................................... 157  
Table 24-C. Transformer Specifications.................................................................................................................. 158  
Table 27-A. Transmit Error-Insertion Setup Sequence ........................................................................................... 180  
Table 27-B. Error Insertion Examples..................................................................................................................... 182  
Table 34-A. Instruction Codes for IEEE 1149.1 Architecture ................................................................................ 203  
Table 34-B. ID Code Structure................................................................................................................................ 204  
Table 34-C. Device ID Codes.................................................................................................................................. 204  
Table 34-D. Boundary Scan Control Bits................................................................................................................ 205  
7 of 238  
DS2155  
2. DATA SHEET REVISION HISTORY  
REVISION  
DESCRIPTION  
In Section 3: Line Interface and Section 3.1: Functional Description, corrected dB values  
for E1 and T1 (page 10 and page 13):  
E1: 0 to -43dB and 0 to -12dB  
080607  
T1: 0 to -15dB and 0 to -36dB  
040907  
041806  
011606  
100903  
Added Note 1 (GBD for cold temp) to Absolute Maximum Ratings (Section 36).  
Replaced Figure 24-3 and Figure 24-4, added Table 24-A and Table 24-B.  
Added lead-free packages to Ordering Information table on page 1.  
Add revision history table: The previous version of the DS2155 data sheet (12-06-02) did  
not incorporate a revision history table and did not describe new features added to B1  
revision of the DS2155.  
THE FOLLOWING WERE INADVERTENTLY REMOVED FROM THE  
PREVIOUS VERSION OF THE DS2155 DATA SHEET:  
Add CSBGA package information to Ordering Information table on front page  
Add CSBGA package thermal characteristics to Operating Parameters section  
Add Transmit Line Build Out Control register (TLBC) description  
Add Transmit Line Build Out Control register (TLBC) to Port Map  
Add Transmit Line Build Out Control register (TLBC) description to LIU TRANSMIT  
section  
THE FOLLOWING ARE CORRECTIONS TO ERRORS IN THE PREVIOUS  
VERSION OF THE DS2155 DATA SHEET:  
Correct Device ID in Device Identification Register  
Correct Device ID in JTAG ID Code table  
Correct minimum value for tDHW in AC CHARACTERISTICS: MULTIPLEXED  
PARALLEL PORT table. tDHW was changed from 5ns to 0ns  
Correct minimum value for tDDR in AC CHARACTERISTICS: MULTIPLEXED  
PARALLEL PORT table. tDDR was changed from unstated to 20ns  
Corrections to AC CHARACTERISTICS: TRANSMIT SIDE timing table.  
1. tCP, tCH, tCL, tLP, tLH, tLL, and tSP typical values have been restated to reflect various IBO  
modes.  
2. tCH, tCL, tLH, tLL minimum values have been changed from 75ns to 20ns.  
3. tSP, tLL minimum values have been changed from 50ns to 20ns.  
4. tD3 minimum values have been changed from 75ns to 22ns.  
Corrections to AC CHARACTERISTICS: RECEIVE SIDE timing table.  
1. tCP, tCH, tCL, tLP, tLH, tLL, and tSP typical values have been restated to reflect various IBO  
modes.  
2. tCH, tCL, minimum values have been changed from 75ns to 20ns.  
3. tSH, tSL minimum values have been changed from 50ns to 20ns.  
4. tSH, tSL typical values have been added.  
5. tD3, tD4 minimum values have been changed from 50ns to 22ns.  
Correct Transmit Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CCS Format) table in Transmit Signaling  
section  
8 of 238  
DS2155  
REVISION  
DESCRIPTION  
The definition of the EGL bit in the LIC1 register has been corrected for both T1 and E1  
mode.  
T1 Mode: EGL = 1 was changed from 15dB to –15dB  
E1 Mode: EGL = 0 was changed from –10dB to –12dB  
THE FOLLOWING ARE FORMAT CHANGES AND ADDED OR REMOVED  
TEXT, TABLES OR DIAGRAMS:  
Replace X* format for showing active low signals with X  
Remove redundant statements about “multiport configurations” in Interrupt Handling  
section  
Remove BASIC NETWORK CONNECTIONS figure in LINE INTERFACE UNIT  
section  
Add “Simplified Diagram of BERT in Network Direction” figure to BERT section  
Add “Simplified Diagram of BERT in Backplane Direction” figure to BERT section  
Add Receive Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CCS Format) table to Receive Signaling  
section  
Add GRIC and GTIC function table to IAAR register  
Changed Table of contents to include table of figures and table of tables.  
Add note for FASRC bit.  
Add T1 and E1 Transmit Flow Chart.  
Added RCLK to BPCLK timing diagram.  
THE FOLLOWING ARE NEW FEATURES AVAILABLE ON THE DS2155 REV  
B1 AND ARE EXPLAINED IN THE BODY OF THE DATA SHEET  
Add FRAS0, TCCS, RCCS and GRSRE bits to Signaling Control Register (SIGCR)  
Add section on AIS-CI and RAI-CI Generation and Detection  
Add RAIS-CI status bit to Status Register 4 (SR4) and Interrupt Mask Register 4 (IMR4)  
Add RAIS-CI status bit to Status Register 4 (SR4)  
Add TRAI-CI control bit to T1 Common Control Register 1 (TCCR1)  
Add TAIS-CI control bit to T1 Common Control Register 1 (TCCR1)  
Add Pseudorandom 2E9-1 pattern to PS0, PS1 and PS2 bit description in Bert Control  
Register 1 (BCR1)  
Add BD bit to Information Register 2 (INFO2)  
Add ILUT status bit to Status Register 1 (SR1) and Interrupt Mask Register 1 (IMR1)  
Add INTDIS and TMSS bits to Common Control Register 3 (CCR3)  
9 of 238  
DS2155  
3. MAIN FEATURES  
The DS2155 contains all of the features of the previous generation of Dallas Semiconductor’s T1 and E1 SCTs plus  
many new features.  
Transmitter power-down  
Transmitter 50mA short-circuit limiter with  
current-limit-exceeded indication  
General  
Programmable output clocks for fractional T1, E1,  
H0, and H12 applications  
Transmit open-circuit-detected indication  
Line interface function can be completely  
decoupled from the framer/formatter  
Interleaving PCM bus operation  
8-bit parallel control port, multiplexed or  
nonmultiplexed, Intel or Motorola  
IEEE 1149.1 JTAG-Boundary Scan  
3.3V supply with 5V tolerant inputs and outputs  
Pin compatible with DS2156, DS2152/DS2154,  
and DS21x5Y SCT family  
Clock Synthesizer  
Output frequencies include 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz,  
8.192MHz, and 16.384MHz  
Derived from recovered receive clock  
Signaling System 7 Support  
RAI-CI, AIS-CI support  
Jitter Attenuator  
100-pin LQFP (14mm x 14mm) (DS2155L)  
100-pin CSBGA (10mm x 10mm) (DS2155G)  
3.3V supply with 5V tolerant inputs and outputs  
Evaluation kits  
IEEE 1149.1 JTAG boundary scan  
Driver source code available from the factory  
32-bit or 128-bit crystal-less jitter attenuator  
Requires only a 2.048MHz master clock for both  
E1 and T1 operation with the option to use  
1.544MHz for T1 operation  
Can be placed in either the receive or transmit path  
or disabled  
Limit trip indication  
Line Interface  
Framer/Formatter  
Requires only a 2.048MHz master clock for both  
E1 and T1 operation with the option to use  
1.544MHz for T1 operation  
Fully independent transmit and receive  
functionality  
Fully software configurable  
Full receive and transmit path transparency  
T1 framing formats include D4 (SLC-96) and ESF  
Detailed alarm and status reporting with optional  
interrupt support  
Short-haul and long-haul applications  
Automatic receive sensitivity adjustments  
Ranges include 0 to -43dB or 0 to -12dB for E1  
applications and 0 to -15dB or 0 to -36dB for T1  
applications  
Receive level indication in 2.5dB steps from  
-42.5dB to -2.5dB  
Internal receive termination option for 75, 100,  
and 120lines  
Internal transmit termination option for 75, 100,  
and 120lines  
Monitor application gain settings of 20dB, 26dB,  
and 32dB  
G.703 receive synchronization-signal mode  
Flexible transmit waveform generation  
T1 DSX-1 line buildouts  
T1 CSU line buildouts of -7.5dB, -15dB, and  
-22.5dB  
Large path and line error counters for:  
T1: BPV, CV, CRC6, and framing bit errors  
E1: BPV, CV, CRC4, E-bit, and frame  
alignment errors  
Timed or manual update modes  
DS1 idle code generation on a per-channel basis in  
both transmit and receive paths  
User-defined  
Digital milliwatt  
ANSI T1.403-1998 Support  
RAI-CI detection and generation  
AIS-CI detection and generation  
E1ETS 300 011 RAI generation  
G.965 V5.2 link detect  
Ability to monitor one DS0 channel in both the  
transmit and receive paths  
E1 waveforms include G.703 waveshapes for  
both 75coax and 120twisted cables  
AIS generation independent of loopbacks  
Alternating ones and zeros generation  
Square-wave output  
In-band repeating pattern generators and detectors  
Three independent generators and detectors  
Patterns from 1 to 8 bits or 16 bits in length  
Open-drain output option  
NRZ format option  
RCL, RLOS, RRA, and RAIS alarms interrupt on  
change-of-state  
10 of 238  
DS2155  
Test and Diagnostics  
Flexible signaling support  
Programmable on-chip bit error-rate testing  
Pseudorandom patterns including QRSS  
User-defined repetitive patterns  
Daly pattern  
Software or hardware based  
Interrupt generated on change of signaling data  
Receive signaling freeze on loss-of-sync,  
carrier loss, or frame slip  
Error insertion single and continuous  
Total bit and errored bit counts  
Payload error insertion  
Addition of hardware pins to indicate carrier loss  
and signaling freeze  
Automatic RAI generation to ETS 300 011  
specifications  
Error insertion in the payload portion of the T1  
frame in the transmit path  
Access to Sa and Si bits  
Errors can be inserted over the entire frame or  
selected channels  
Option to extend carrier loss criteria to a 1ms  
period as per ETS 300 233  
Insertion options include continuous and absolute  
number with selectable insertion rates  
F-bit corruption for line testing  
Japanese J1 support  
Ability to calculate and check CRC6 according  
to the Japanese standard  
Loopbacks: remote, local, analog, and per-channel  
loopback  
Ability to generate Yellow Alarm according to  
the Japanese standard  
Extended System Information Bus  
TDM Bus  
Host can read interrupt and alarm status on up to 8  
ports with a single bus read  
Dual two-frame independent receive and transmit  
elastic stores  
Independent control and clocking  
User-Programmable Output Pins  
Controlled slip capability with status  
Minimum delay mode supported  
Four user-defined output pins for controlling  
external logic  
16.384MHz maximum backplane burst rate  
Supports T1 to CEPT (E1) conversion  
Programmable output clocks for fractional T1, E1,  
H0, and H12 applications  
Control Port  
8-bit parallel control port  
Multiplexed or nonmultiplexed buses  
Intel or Motorola formats  
Interleaving PCM bus operation  
Hardware signaling capability  
Supports polled or interrupt environments  
Software access to device ID and silicon revision  
Software reset supported  
Receive signaling reinsertion to a backplane  
multiframe sync  
Availability of signaling in a separate PCM  
data stream  
Automatic clear on power-up  
Hardware reset pin  
Signaling freezing  
Ability to pass the T1 F-bit position through the  
elastic stores in the 2.048MHz backplane mode  
Access to the data streams in between the  
framer/formatter and the elastic stores  
User-selectable synthesized clock output  
HDLC Controllers  
Two independent HDLC controllers  
Fast load and unload features for FIFOs  
SS7 support for FISU transmit and receive  
Independent 128-byte Rx and Tx buffers with  
interrupt support  
Access FDL, Sa, or single/multiple DS0 channels  
DS0 access includes Nx64 or Nx56  
Compatible with polled or interrupt driven  
environments  
Bit-oriented code (BOC) support  
11 of 238  
DS2155  
The DS2155 is compliant with the following standards:  
ANSI:  
AT&T:  
ITU:  
T1.403-1995, T1.231–1993, T1.408  
TR54016, TR62411  
G.703, G.704, G.706, G.736, G.775, G.823, G.932, I.431, O.151, Q.161  
ITU-T:  
Recommendation I.432–03/93 B-ISDN User-Network Interface—Physical Layer  
Specification  
ETSI:  
ETS 300 011, ETS 300 166, ETS 300 233, CTR12, CTR4  
JTG.703, JTI.431, JJ-20.11 (CMI Coding Only)  
Japanese:  
12 of 238  
DS2155  
3.1 Functional Description  
The DS2155 is a software-selectable T1, E1, or J1 single-chip transceiver (SCT) for short-haul and long-  
haul applications. The DS2155 is composed of an LIU, framer, HDLC controllers, and a TDM backplane  
interface, and is controlled by an 8-bit parallel port configured for Intel or Motorola bus operations. The  
DS2155 is pin and software compatible with the DS2156.  
The LIU is composed of transmit and receive interfaces and a jitter attenuator. The transmit interface is  
responsible for generating the necessary waveshapes for driving the network and providing the correct  
source impedance depending on the type of media used. T1 waveform generation includes DSX-1 line  
buildouts as well as CSU line buildouts of -7.5dB, -15dB, and -22.5dB. E1 waveform generation includes  
G.703 waveshapes for both 75coax and 120twisted cables. The receive interface provides network  
termination and recovers clock and data from the network. The receive sensitivity adjusts automatically to  
the incoming signal and can be programmed for 0 to -43dB or 0 to -12dB for E1 applications and  
0 to -15dB or 0 to -36dB for T1 applications. The jitter attenuator removes phase jitter from the  
transmitted or received signal. The crystal-less jitter attenuator requires only a 2.048MHz MCLK for both  
E1 and T1 applications (with the option of using a 1.544MHz MCLK in T1 applications) and can be  
placed in either transmit or receive data paths. An additional feature of the LIU is a CMI coder/decoder  
for interfacing to optical networks.  
On the transmit side, clock, data, and frame-sync signals are provided to the framer by the backplane  
interface section. The framer inserts the appropriate synchronization framing patterns, alarm information,  
calculates and inserts the CRC codes, and provides the B8ZS/HDB3 (zero code suppression) and AMI  
line coding. The receive-side framer decodes AMI, B8ZS, and HDB3 line coding, synchronizes to the  
data stream, reports alarm information, counts framing/coding/CRC errors, and provides clock/data and  
frame-sync signals to the backplane interface section.  
Both the transmit and receive path have two HDLC controllers. The HDLC controllers transmit and  
receive data through the framer block. The HDLC controllers can be assigned to any time slot, group of  
time slots, portion of a time slot or to FDL (T1) or Sa bits (E1). Each controller has 128-byte FIFOs, thus  
reducing the amount of processor overhead required to manage the flow of data. In addition, built-in  
support for reducing the processor time is required in SS7 applications.  
The backplane interface provides a versatile method of sending and receiving data from the host system.  
Elastic stores provide a method for interfacing to asynchronous systems, converting from a T1/E1  
network to a 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, or N x 64kHz system backplane. The elastic stores also  
manage slip conditions (asynchronous interface). An interleave bus option (IBO) is provided to allow up  
to eight transceivers to share a high-speed backplane.  
The parallel port provides access for control and configuration of the DS2155’s features. The extended  
system information bus (ESIB) function allows up to eight transceivers to be accessed by a single read for  
interrupt status or other user-selectable alarm status information. Diagnostic capabilities include  
loopbacks, PRBS pattern generation/detection, and 16-bit loop-up and loop-down code generation and  
detection.  
13 of 238  
DS2155  
Reader’s Note: This data sheet assumes a particular nomenclature of the T1 operating environment. In  
each 125µs frame there are 24 8-bit channels plus a framing bit. It is assumed that the framing bit is sent  
first followed by channel 1. Each channel is made up of eight bits that are numbered 1 to 8. Bit number 1  
is the MSB and is transmitted first. Bit number 8 is the LSB and is transmitted last. The term “locked” is  
used to refer to two clock signals that are phase- or frequency-locked or derived from a common clock  
(i.e., a 1.544MHz clock can be locked to a 2.048MHz clock if they share the same 8kHz component).  
Throughout this data sheet, the following abbreviations are used:  
B8ZS  
BOC  
CRC  
D4  
ESF  
FDL  
FPS  
Fs  
Ft  
HDLC  
Bipolar with 8 Zero Substitution  
Bit-Oriented Code  
Cyclical Redundancy Check  
Superframe (12 frames per multiframe) Multiframe Structure  
Extended Superframe (24 frames per multiframe) Multiframe Structure  
Facility Data Link  
Framing Pattern Sequence in ESF  
Signaling Framing Pattern in D4  
Terminal Framing Pattern in D4  
High-Level Data Link Control  
MF  
Multiframe  
SLC–96  
Subscriber Loop Carrier—96 Channels  
14 of 238  
DS2155  
3.2 Block Diagram  
Figure 3-1 shows a simplified block diagram featuring the major components of the DS2155. Details are  
shown in subsequent figures. The block diagram is divided into three functional blocks: LIU, FRAMER,  
and BACKPLANE INTERFACE.  
Figure 3-1. Block Diagram  
CLOCK  
EXTERNAL ACCESS  
CLOCK  
TO RECEIVE SIGNALS  
ADAPTER  
HDB3 / B8ZS  
SYNC  
SINGALING  
ALARM DET  
HDLCs  
BACKPLANE  
CLOCK SYNTH  
RX  
MUX  
LIU  
BACKPLANE  
INTERFACE  
CIRCUIT  
FRAMER  
SINGALING  
ALARM GEN  
HDLCs  
CRC GEN  
HDB3 / B8ZS  
TX  
MUX  
LIU  
EXTERNAL ACCESS  
LIU  
FRAMER  
BACKPLANE  
INTERFACE  
TO TRANSMIT SIGNALS  
JTAG HOST INTERFACE ESIB  
15 of 238  
 
DS2155  
Figure 3-2. Receive and Transmit LIU  
RCL  
VCO / PLL  
MUX  
32.768MHz  
JACLK  
RPOS  
RNEG  
RCLK  
RRING  
RTIP  
TRING  
TTIP  
TPOS  
TNEG  
TCLK  
MUX  
16 of 238  
 
DS2155  
Figure 3-3. Receive and Transmit Framer/HDLC  
REC  
REC  
HDLC #1  
HDLC #2  
128 Byte  
FIFO  
128 Byte  
FIFO  
MAPPER  
MAPPER  
DATA  
CLOCK  
SYNC  
DATA  
CLOCK  
SYNC  
SYNC  
CLOCK  
DATA  
RPOS  
RNEG  
RCLK  
RECEIVE  
FRAMER  
SYNC  
TPOS  
TNEG  
TCLK  
TRANSMIT  
FRAMER  
CLOCK  
DATA  
MAPPER  
MAPPER  
XMIT  
XMIT  
HDLC #1  
HDLC #2  
128 Byte  
FIFO  
128 Byte  
FIFO  
17 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 3-4. Backplane Interface  
Sa BIT/FDL  
RLINK  
RLCLK  
EXTRACTION  
RSIG  
RSIGFR  
SIGNALING  
BUFFER  
DATA  
CLOCK  
SYNC  
RSYSCLK  
RSER  
ELASTIC  
STORE  
RCLK  
RSYNC  
RMSYNC  
RFSYNC  
RDATA  
RCHCLK  
RCHBLK  
CHANNEL  
TIMING  
SYNC  
TSER  
SIGNALING  
BUFFER  
TSIG  
Sa/FDL  
INSERT  
ELASTIC  
STORE  
DATA  
TSSYNC  
TSYSCLK  
TSYNC  
CLOCK  
TESO  
TDATA  
TLCLK  
TLINK  
CHANNEL  
TIMING  
TCHCLK  
TCHBLK  
TCLK  
MUX  
TCLK  
JACLK  
18 of 238  
DS2155  
4. PIN FUNCTION DESCRIPTION  
4.1 Transmit Side  
Signal Name:  
TCLK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Clock  
Input  
A 1.544MHz (T1) or a 2.048MHz (E1) primary clock. Used to clock data through the transmit-side formatter.  
TCLK can be internally sourced from MCLK. This is the most flexible method and requires only a single clock  
signal for both T1 or E1. If internal sourcing is used, then the TCLK pin should be connected low.  
Signal Name:  
TSER  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Serial Data  
Input  
Transmit NRZ serial data. Sampled on the falling edge of TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled.  
Sampled on the falling edge of TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled.  
Signal Name:  
TCHCLK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Channel Clock  
Output  
A 192kHz (T1) or 256kHz (E1) clock that pulses high during the LSB of each channel. Can also be programmed to  
output a gated transmit bit clock on a per-channel basis. Synchronous with TCLK when the transmit-side elastic  
store is disabled. Synchronous with TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. Useful for parallel-  
to-serial conversion of channel data.  
Signal Name:  
TCHBLK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Channel Block  
Output  
A user-programmable output that can be forced high or low during any of the channels. Synchronous with TCLK  
when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled. Synchronous with TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is  
enabled. Useful for blocking clocks to a serial UART or LAPD controller in applications where not all channels are  
used such as Fractional T1, Fractional E1, 384kbps (H0), 768kbps, or ISDN–PRI. Also useful for locating  
individual channels in drop-and-insert applications, for external per-channel loopback, and for per-channel  
conditioning.  
Signal Name:  
TSYSCLK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit System Clock  
Input  
1.544MHz, 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, or 16.384MHz clock. Only used when the transmit-side elastic  
store function is enabled. Should be connected low in applications that do not use the transmit-side elastic store.  
See Section 28 for details on 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, and 16.384MHz operation using the IBO.  
Signal Name:  
TLCLK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Link Clock  
Output  
Demand clock for the transmit link data [TLINK] input.  
T1 Mode: A 4kHz or 2kHz (ZBTSI) clock.  
E1 Mode: A 4kHz to 20kHz clock.  
19 of 238  
 
DS2155  
Signal Name:  
TLINK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Link Data  
Input  
If enabled, this pin is sampled on the falling edge of TCLK for data insertion into either the FDL stream (ESF) or  
the Fs-bit position (D4), or the Z-bit position (ZBTSI) or any combination of the Sa-bit positions (E1).  
Signal Name:  
TSYNC  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Sync  
Input/Output  
A pulse at this pin establishes either frame or multiframe boundaries for the transmit side. Can be programmed to  
output either a frame or multiframe pulse. If this pin is set to output pulses at frame boundaries, it can also be set by  
IOCR1.3 to output double-wide pulses at signaling frames in T1 mode.  
Signal Name:  
TSSYNC  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit System Sync  
Input  
Only used when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. A pulse at this pin establishes either frame or multiframe  
boundaries for the transmit side. Should be connected low in applications that do not use the transmit-side elastic  
store.  
Signal Name:  
TSIG  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Signaling Input  
Input  
When enabled, this input samples signaling bits for insertion into outgoing PCM data stream. Sampled on the  
falling edge of TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled. Sampled on the falling edge of TSYSCLK  
when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled.  
Signal Name:  
TESO  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Elastic Store Data Output  
Output  
Updated on the rising edge of TCLK with data out of the transmit-side elastic store whether the elastic store is  
enabled or not. This pin is normally connected to TDATA.  
Signal Name:  
TDATA  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Data  
Input  
Sampled on the falling edge of TCLK with data to be clocked through the transmit-side formatter. This pin is  
normally connected to TESO.  
Signal Name:  
TPOSO  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Positive-Data Output  
Output  
Updated on the rising edge of TCLKO with the bipolar data out of the transmit-side formatter. Can be programmed  
to source NRZ data by the output data format (IOCR1.0) control bit. This pin is normally connected to TPOSI.  
Signal Name:  
TNEGO  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Negative-Data Output  
Output  
Updated on the rising edge of TCLKO with the bipolar data out of the transmit-side formatter. This pin is normally  
connected to TNEGI.  
Signal Name:  
TCLKO  
20 of 238  
DS2155  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Clock Output  
Output  
Buffered clock that is used to clock data through the transmit-side formatter (i.e., either TCLK or RCLKI). This pin  
is normally connected to TCLKI.  
Signal Name:  
TPOSI  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Positive-Data Input  
Input  
Sampled on the falling edge of TCLKI for data to be transmitted out onto the T1 line. Can be internally connected  
to TPOSO by connecting the LIUC pin high. TPOSI and TNEGI can be connected together in NRZ applications.  
Signal Name:  
TNEGI  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Negative-Data Input  
Input  
Sampled on the falling edge of TCLKI for data to be transmitted out onto the T1 line. Can be internally connected  
to TNEGO by connecting the LIUC pin high. TPOSI and TNEGI can be connected together in NRZ applications.  
Signal Name:  
TCLKI  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Clock Input  
Input  
Line interface transmit clock. Can be internally connected to TCLKO by connecting the LIUC pin high.  
4.2 Receive Side  
Signal Name:  
RLINK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Link Data  
Output  
T1 Mode: Updated with either FDL data (ESF) or Fs bits (D4) or Z bits (ZBTSI) one RCLK before the start of a  
frame.  
E1 Mode: Updated with the full E1 data stream on the rising edge of RCLK.  
Signal Name:  
RLCLK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Link Clock  
Output  
T1 Mode: A 4kHz or 2kHz (ZBTSI) clock for the RLINK output.  
E1 Mode: A 4kHz to 20kHz clock.  
Signal Name:  
RCLK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Clock  
Output  
1.544MHz (T1) or 2.048MHz (E1) clock that is used to clock data through the receive-side framer.  
Signal Name:  
RCHCLK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Channel Clock  
Output  
A 192kHz (T1) or 256kHz (E1) clock that pulses high during the LSB of each channel. Synchronous with RCLK  
when the receive-side elastic store is disabled. Synchronous with RSYSCLK when the receive-side elastic store is  
enabled. Useful for parallel-to-serial conversion of channel data.  
21 of 238  
DS2155  
Signal Name:  
RCHBLK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Channel Block  
Output  
A user-programmable output that can be forced high or low during any of the 24 T1 or 32 E1 channels.  
Synchronous with RCLK when the receive-side elastic store is disabled. Synchronous with RSYSCLK when the  
receive-side elastic store is enabled. Useful for blocking clocks to a serial UART or LAPD controller in  
applications where not all channels are used such as fractional service, 384kbps service, 768kbps, or ISDN–PRI.  
Also useful for locating individual channels in drop-and-insert applications, for external per-channel loopback, and  
for per-channel conditioning. See Section 18 for details.  
Signal Name:  
RSER  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Serial Data  
Output  
Received NRZ serial data. Updated on rising edges of RCLK when the receive-side elastic store is disabled.  
Updated on the rising edges of RSYSCLK when the receive-side elastic store is enabled.  
Signal Name:  
RSYNC  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Sync  
Input/Output  
An extracted pulse, one RCLK wide, is output at this pin that identifies either frame (IOCR1.5 = 0) or multiframe  
(IOCR1.5 = 1) boundaries. If set to output frame boundaries, then through IOCR1.6, RSYNC can also be set to  
output double-wide pulses on signaling frames in T1 mode. If the receive-side elastic store is enabled, then this pin  
can be enabled to be an input through IOCR1.4, at which a frame or multiframe boundary pulse is applied.  
Signal Name:  
RFSYNC  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Frame Sync  
Output  
An extracted 8kHz pulse, one RCLK wide, is output at this pin that identifies frame boundaries.  
Signal Name:  
RMSYNC  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Multiframe Sync  
Output  
An extracted pulse, one RCLK wide (elastic store disabled) or one RSYSCLK wide (elastic store enabled), is  
output at this pin that identifies multiframe boundaries.  
Signal Name:  
RDATA  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Data  
Output  
Updated on the rising edge of RCLK with the data out of the receive-side framer.  
Signal Name:  
RSYSCLK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive System Clock  
Input  
1.544MHz, 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, or 8.192MHz clock. Only used when the receive-side elastic store function is  
enabled. Should be connected low in applications that do not use the receive-side elastic store. See Section 28 for  
details on 4.096MHz and 8.192MHz operation using the IBO.  
Signal Name:  
RSIG  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Signaling Output  
Output  
Outputs signaling bits in a PCM format. Updated on rising edges of RCLK when the receive-side elastic store is  
disabled. Updated on the rising edges of RSYSCLK when the receive-side elastic store is enabled.  
22 of 238  
DS2155  
Signal Name:  
RLOS/LOTC  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Loss-of-Sync/Loss-of-Transmit Clock  
Output  
A dual function output that is controlled by the CCR1.0 control bit. This pin can be programmed to either toggle  
high when the synchronizer is searching for the frame and multiframe or to toggle high if the TCLK pin has not  
been toggled for 5µs.  
Signal Name:  
RCL  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Carrier Loss  
Output  
Set high when the line interface detects a carrier loss.  
Signal Name:  
RSIGF  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Signaling Freeze  
Output  
Set high when the signaling data is frozen by either automatic or manual intervention. Used to alert downstream  
equipment of the condition.  
Signal Name:  
BPCLK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Backplane Clock  
Output  
A user-selectable synthesized clock output that is referenced to the clock that is output at the RCLK pin.  
Signal Name:  
RPOSO  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Positive-Data Output  
Output  
Updated on the rising edge of RCLKO with bipolar data out of the line interface. This pin is normally connected to  
RPOSI.  
Signal Name:  
RNEGO  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Negative-Data Output  
Output  
Updated on the rising edge of RCLKO with the bipolar data out of the line interface. This pin is normally  
connected to RNEGI.  
Signal Name:  
RCLKO  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Clock Output  
Output  
Buffered recovered clock from the network. This pin is normally connected to RCLKI.  
Signal Name:  
RPOSI  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Positive-Data Input  
Input  
Sampled on the falling edge of RCLKI for data to be clocked through the receive-side framer. RPOSI and RNEGI  
can be connected together for an NRZ interface. Can be internally connected to RPOSO by connecting the LIUC  
pin high.  
Signal Name:  
RNEGI  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Negative-Data Input  
Input  
Sampled on the falling edge of RCLKI for data to be clocked through the receive-side framer. RPOSI and RNEGI  
can be connected together for an NRZ interface. Can be internally connected to RNEGO by connecting the LIUC  
pin high.  
23 of 238  
DS2155  
Signal Name:  
RCLKI  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Clock Input  
Input  
Clock used to clock data through the receive-side framer. This pin is normally connected to RCLKO. Can be  
internally connected to RCLKO by connecting the LIUC pin high.  
4.3 Parallel Control Port Pins  
INT  
Signal Name:  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Interrupt  
Output  
Flags host controller during conditions and events defined in the status registers. Active-low, open-drain output.  
Signal Name:  
TSTRST  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Tri-State Control and Device Reset  
Input  
A dual function pin. A 0-to-1 transition issues a hardware reset to the DS2155 register set. A reset clears all  
configuration registers. Configuration register contents are set to 0. Leaving TSTRST high tri-states all output and  
I/O pins (including the parallel control port). Set low for normal operation. Useful in board-level testing.  
Signal Name:  
MUX  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Bus Operation  
Input  
Set low to select nonmultiplexed bus operation. Set high to select multiplexed bus operation.  
Signal Name:  
AD0 to AD7  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Data Bus [D0 to D7] or Address/Data Bus  
Input/Output  
In nonmultiplexed bus operation (MUX = 0), these serve as the data bus. In multiplexed bus operation (MUX = 1),  
these pins serve as an 8-bit multiplexed address/data bus.  
Signal Name:  
A0 to A6  
Address Bus  
Input  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
In nonmultiplexed bus operation (MUX = 0), these serve as the address bus. In multiplexed bus operation  
(MUX = 1), these pins are not used and should be connected low.  
Signal Name:  
BTS  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Bus Type Select  
Input  
Strap high to select Motorola bus timing; strap low to select Intel bus timing. This pin controls the function of the  
RD (DS), ALE (AS), and WR (R/W) pins.  
If BTS = 1, then these pins assume the function listed in parentheses ().  
Signal Name:  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
RD (DS)  
Read Input, Data Strobe  
Input  
In Intel mode, RD determines when data is read from the device. In Motorola mode, DS is used to write to the  
device. See Bus Timing Diagrams.  
24 of 238  
DS2155  
Signal Name:  
CS  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Chip Select  
Input  
Must be low to read or write to the device. CS is an active-low signal.  
Signal Name:  
ALE(AS)/A7  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Address Latch Enable (Address Strobe) or A7  
Input  
In nonmultiplexed bus operation (MUX = 0), serves as the upper address bit. In multiplexed bus operation  
(MUX = 1), serves to demultiplex the bus on a positive-going edge.  
Signal Name:  
WR (R/W)  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Write Input(Read/Write)  
Input  
WR is an active-low signal.  
4.4 Extended System Information Bus  
Signal Name:  
ESIBS0  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Extended System Information Bus Select 0  
Input/Output  
Used to group two to eight DS2155s into a bus-sharing mode for alarm and status reporting. See Section 29 for  
more details.  
Signal Name:  
ESIBS1  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Extended System Information Bus Select 1  
Input/Output  
Used to group two to eight DS2155s into a bus-sharing mode for alarm and status reporting. See Section 29 for  
more details.  
Signal Name:  
ESIBRD  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Extended System Information Bus Read  
Input/Output  
Used to group two to eight DS2155s into a bus-sharing mode for alarm and status reporting. See Section 29 for  
more details.  
25 of 238  
DS2155  
4.5 User Output Port Pins  
Signal Name:  
UOP0  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
User Output Port 0  
Output  
This output port pin can be set low or high by the CCR4.0 control bit. This pin is forced low on power-up and after  
any device reset.  
Signal Name:  
UOP1  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
User Output Port 1  
Output  
This output port pin can be set low or high by the CCR4.1 control bit. This pin is forced low on power-up and after  
any device reset.  
Signal Name:  
UOP2  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
User Output Port 2  
Output  
This output port pin can be set low or high by the CCR4.2 control bit. This pin is forced low on power-up and after  
any device reset.  
Signal Name:  
UOP3  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
User Output Port 3  
Output  
This output port pin can be set low or high by the CCR4.3 control bit. This pin is forced low on power-up and after  
any device reset.  
26 of 238  
DS2155  
4.6 JTAG Test Access Port Pins  
Signal Name:  
JTRST  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
IEEE 1149.1 Test Reset  
Input  
JTRST is used to asynchronously reset the test access port controller. After power-up, JTRST must be toggled from  
low to high. This action sets the device into the JTAG DEVICE ID mode. Normal device operation is restored by  
pulling JTRST low. JTRST is pulled high internally by a 10kresistor operation.  
Signal Name:  
JTMS  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
IEEE 1149.1 Test Mode Select  
Input  
This pin is sampled on the rising edge of JTCLK and is used to place the test access port into the various defined  
IEEE 1149.1 states. This pin has a 10kpullup resistor.  
Signal Name:  
JTCLK  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
IEEE 1149.1 Test Clock Signal  
Input  
This signal is used to shift data into JTDI on the rising edge and out of JTDO on the falling edge.  
Signal Name:  
JTDI  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
IEEE 1149.1 Test Data Input  
Input  
Test instructions and data are clocked into this pin on the rising edge of JTCLK. This pin has a 10kpullup  
resistor.  
Signal Name:  
JTDO  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
IEEE 1149.1 Test Data Output  
Output  
Test instructions and data are clocked out of this pin on the falling edge of JTCLK. If not used, this pin should be  
left unconnected.  
27 of 238  
DS2155  
4.7 Line Interface Pins  
Signal Name:  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
MCLK  
Master Clock Input  
Input  
A (50ppm) clock source is applied at this pin. This clock is used internally for both clock/data recovery and for the  
jitter attenuator for T1 and E1 modes. A quartz crystal of 2.048MHz can be applied across MCLK and XTALD  
instead of the clock source. The clock rate can be 16.384MHz, 8.192MHz, 4.096MHz, or 2.048MHz. When using  
the DS2155 in T1-only operation, a 1.544MHz (50ppm) clock source can be used.  
Signal Name:  
XTALD  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Quartz Crystal Driver  
Output  
A quartz crystal of 2.048MHz (optional 1.544MHz in T1-only operation) can be applied across MCLK and  
XTALD instead of a clock source at MCLK. Leave open circuited if a clock source is applied at MCLK.  
Signal Name:  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
8XCLK  
Eight Times Clock (8x)  
Output  
An 8x clock that is locked to the recovered network clock provided from the clock/data recovery block (if  
the jitter attenuator is enabled on the receive side) or from the TCLKI pin (if the jitter attenuator is  
enabled on the transmit side).  
Signal Name:  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
LIUC  
Line Interface Connect  
Input  
Connect low to separate the line interface circuitry from the framer/formatter circuitry and activate the  
TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins. Connect high to connect the line interface circuitry to the  
framer/formatter circuitry and deactivate the TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins. When LIUC is  
connected high, the TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins should be connected low.  
Signal Name:  
RTIP and RRING  
Receive Tip and Ring  
Input  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Analog inputs for clock recovery circuitry. These pins connect through a 1:1 transformer to the network. See  
Section 24 for details.  
Signal Name:  
TTIP and TRING  
Transmit Tip and Ring  
Output  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Analog line driver outputs. These pins connect through a 1:2 step-up transformer to the network. See Section 24 for  
details.  
28 of 238  
DS2155  
4.8 Supply Pins  
Signal Name:  
DVDD  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Digital Positive Supply  
Supply  
3.3V ±5%. Should be connected to the RVDD and TVDD pins.  
Signal Name:  
RVDD  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Analog Positive Supply  
Supply  
3.3V ±5%. Should be connected to the DVDD and TVDD pins.  
Signal Name:  
TVDD  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Analog Positive Supply  
Supply  
3.3V ±5%. Should be connected to the RVDD and DVDD pins.  
Signal Name:  
DVSS  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Digital Signal Ground  
Supply  
Should be connected to the RVSS and TVSS pins.  
Signal Name:  
RVSS  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Receive Analog Signal Ground  
Supply  
0V. Should be connected to DVSS and TVSS.  
Signal Name:  
TVSS  
Signal Description:  
Signal Type:  
Transmit Analog Signal Ground  
Supply  
0V. Should be connected to DVSS and RVSS.  
29 of 238  
DS2155  
4.9 L and G Package Pinout  
The DS2155 is available in either a 100-pin LQFP (L) or 10mm CSBGA, 0.8mm pitch (G) package.  
Table 4-A. Pin Description Sorted by Pin Number  
PIN  
SYMBOL  
TYPE  
FUNCTION  
LQFP  
CSBGA  
1
A1  
RCHBLK  
JTMS  
O
I
Receive Channel Block  
IEEE 1149.1 Test Mode Select  
Backplane Clock  
IEEE 1149.1 Test Clock Signal  
IEEE 1149.1 Test Reset  
Receive Carrier Loss  
IEEE 1149.1 Test Data Input  
User Output 0  
2
B2  
3
C3  
BPCLK  
JTCLK  
JTRST  
RCL  
O
I
4
B1  
5
D4  
I
6
C2  
O
I
7
C1  
JTDI  
8
D3  
UOP0  
O
O
O
I
9
D2  
UOP1  
User Output 1  
10  
D1  
JTDO  
IEEE 1149.1 Test Data Output  
Bus Type Select  
Line Interface Connect  
Eight Times Clock  
11  
E3  
BTS  
12  
E2  
LIUC  
I
13  
E1  
8XCLK  
TSTRST  
UOP2  
O
I
14  
E4  
Test/Reset  
User Output 2  
15  
E5  
O
I
16  
F1  
RTIP  
Receive Analog Tip Input  
Receive Analog Ring Input  
Receive Analog Positive Supply  
Receive Analog Signal Ground  
Master Clock Input  
Quartz Crystal Driver  
User Output 3  
17  
F2  
RRING  
RVDD  
RVSS  
I
18  
F3  
I
19, 20, 24  
F4, G1, J1  
21  
G2  
MCLK  
XTALD  
UOP3  
22  
H1  
O
O
O
O
23  
G3  
25  
H2  
INT  
Interrupt  
26  
K1  
N.C.  
Reserved for Factory Test  
Reserved for Factory Test  
Transmit Analog Tip Output  
Transmit Analog Signal Ground  
Transmit Analog Positive Supply  
Transmit Analog Ring Output  
Transmit Channel Block  
Transmit Link Clock  
27, 28  
J2, H3  
N.C.  
29  
K2  
TTIP  
30  
G4  
TVSS  
31  
J3  
TVDD  
TRING  
TCHBLK  
TLCLK  
TLINK  
ESIBS0  
TSYNC  
TPOSI  
TNEGI  
TCLKI  
TCLKO  
TNEGO  
TPOSO  
DVDD  
DVSS  
TCLK  
TSER  
32  
K3  
O
O
O
I
33  
H4  
34  
J4  
35  
K4  
Transmit Link Data  
Extended System Information Bus 0  
Transmit Sync  
36  
H5  
I/O  
I/O  
I
I
I
O
O
O
I
37  
J5  
38  
K5  
Transmit Positive-Data Input  
Transmit Negative-Data Input  
Transmit Clock Input  
Transmit Clock Output  
Transmit Negative-Data Output  
Transmit Positive-Data Output  
Digital Positive Supply  
Digital Signal Ground  
Transmit Clock  
39  
G5  
40  
F5  
41  
K6  
42  
J6  
43  
H6  
44, 61, 81, 83  
K7, F8, B8, C7  
G6, G10, D7, B7  
45, 60, 80, 84  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
J7  
K8  
H7  
K9  
J8  
I
I
O
I
Transmit Serial Data  
TSIG  
Transmit Signaling Input  
Transmit Elastic Store Output  
Transmit Data  
TESO  
TDATA  
30 of 238  
DS2155  
PIN  
SYMBOL  
TYPE  
FUNCTION  
LQFP  
51  
52  
53  
54  
55  
56  
57  
58  
59  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
68  
69  
70  
71  
72  
73  
74  
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
82  
85  
86  
87  
88  
89  
90  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
97  
98  
99  
100  
CSBGA  
K10  
J9  
TSYSCLK  
TSSYNC  
TCHCLK  
ESIBS1  
MUX  
I
I
O
I/O  
I
Transmit System Clock  
Transmit System Sync  
Transmit Channel Clock  
Extended System Information Bus 1  
Bus Operation  
H8  
J10  
G7  
H9  
H10  
G8  
G9  
F9  
D0/AD0  
D1/AD1  
D2/AD2  
D3/AD3  
D4/AD4  
D5/AD5  
D6/AD6  
D7/AD7  
A0  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I
Data Bus Bit0/Address/Data Bus Bit 0  
Data Bus Bit1/Address/Data Bus Bit 1  
Data Bus Bit 2/Address/Data Bus 2  
Data Bus Bit 3/Address/Data Bus Bit 3  
Data Bus Bit4/Address/Data Bus Bit 4  
Data Bus Bit 5/Address/Data Bus Bit 5  
Data Bus Bit 6/Address/Data Bus Bit 6  
Data Bus Bit 7/Address/Data Bus Bit 7  
Address Bus Bit 0  
F10  
F7  
F6  
E10  
E9  
A1  
I
Address Bus Bit 1  
E8  
A2  
I
Address Bus Bit 2  
D10  
E7  
A3  
I
Address Bus Bit 3  
A4  
I
Address Bus Bit 4  
D9  
C10  
D8  
B10  
C9  
A5  
I
Address Bus Bit 5  
A6  
I
Address Bus Bit 6  
ALE (AS)/A7  
RD (DS)  
CS  
I
Address Latch Enable/Address Bus Bit 7  
Read Input (Data Strobe)  
Chip Select  
I
I
A10  
B9  
C8  
ESIBRD  
WR (R/W)  
RLINK  
RLCLK  
RCLK  
RDATA  
RPOSI  
RNEGI  
RCLKI  
RCLKO  
RNEGO  
RPOSO  
RCHCLK  
RSIGF  
RSIG  
RSER  
RMSYNC  
RFSYNC  
RSYNC  
RLOS/LOTC  
RSYSCLK  
I/O  
I
Extended System Information Bus Read  
Write Input (Read/Write)  
Receive Link Data  
O
O
O
O
I
I
I
A9  
A8  
A7  
C6  
Receive Link Clock  
Receive Clock  
Receive Data  
Receive Positive-Data Input  
Receive Negative-Data Input  
Receive Clock Input  
B6  
A6  
D6  
E6  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
I/O  
O
I
Receive Clock Output  
Receive Negative-Data Output  
Receive Positive-Data Output  
Receive Channel Clock  
A5  
B5  
C5  
A4  
D5  
B4  
A3  
C4  
A2  
B3  
Receive Signaling-Freeze Output  
Receive Signaling Output  
Receive Serial Data  
Receive Multiframe Sync  
Receive Frame Sync  
Receive Sync  
Receive Loss-of-Sync/Loss-of-Transmit Clock  
Receive System Clock  
31 of 238  
DS2155  
4.1010mm CSBGA Pin Configuration  
Figure 4-1. 10mm CSBGA Pin Configuration  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
A
B
C
D
E
F
RLOS/  
RCHBLK  
RFSYNC  
RSIG  
RPOSO  
RCLKI  
RDATA  
RCLK  
RLCLK  
ESIBRD  
LOTC  
WR  
(R/W)  
RD  
(DS)  
JTCLK  
JTDI  
JTMS  
RSYSCLK RMSYNC RCHCLK RNEGI  
DVSS  
DVDD  
DVSS  
A4  
DVDD  
RLINK  
RCL  
UOP1  
LIUC  
RRING  
MCLK  
INT  
BPCLK  
UOP0  
BTS  
RSYNC  
JTRST  
TSTRST  
RVSS  
RSIGF  
RSER  
UOP2  
TCLKI  
TNEGI  
RPOSI  
RCLKO  
RNEGO  
A6  
A3  
CS  
A5  
ALE(AS)/  
A7  
JTDO  
8XCLK  
RTIP  
A2  
A1  
A0  
RVDD  
UOP3  
N.C.  
D7/AD7 D6/AD6  
DVDD  
D4/AD4  
D3/AD3  
D0/AD0  
TSSYNC  
TESO  
D5/AD5  
DVSS  
D1/AD1  
ESIBS1  
TSYSCLK  
G
H
J
RVSS  
XTALD  
RVSS  
TUSEL  
TVSS  
DVSS  
MUX  
TSIG  
TCLK  
DVDD  
D2/AD2  
TCHCLK  
TDATA  
TSER  
TCHBLK  
TLCLK  
TLINK  
ESIBS0 TPOSO  
TSYNC TNEGO  
N.C.  
TVDD  
TRING  
K
TTIP  
TPOSI  
TCLKO  
TOP VIEW  
32 of 238  
DS2155  
5. PARALLEL PORT  
The SCT is controlled by either a nonmultiplexed (MUX = 0) or a multiplexed (MUX = 1) bus through an  
external microcontroller or microprocessor. The SCT can operate with either Intel or Motorola bus timing  
configurations. If the BTS pin is connected low, Intel timing is selected; if connected high, Motorola  
timing is selected. All Motorola bus signals are listed in parentheses (). See the timing diagrams in AC  
Electrical Characteristics in Section 37 for more details.  
5.1 Register Map  
Table 5-A. Register Map Sorted by Address  
ADDRESS  
R/W  
REGISTER NAME  
SYMBOL  
PAGE  
xxh  
00  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
0A  
0B  
0C  
0D  
0E  
0F  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
1A  
1B  
1C  
1D  
1E  
1F  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R
Master Mode Register  
MSTRREG  
IOCR1  
IOCR2  
T1RCR1  
T1RCR2  
T1TCR1  
T1TCR2  
T1CCR1  
SSIE1  
SSIE2  
SSIE3  
SSIE4  
T1RDMR1  
T1RDMR2  
T1RDMR3  
IDR  
40  
69  
I/O Configuration Register 1  
I/O Configuration Register 2  
T1 Receive Control Register 1  
T1 Receive Control Register 2  
T1 Transmit Control Register 1  
T1 Transmit Control Register 2  
T1 Common Control Register 1  
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 1  
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 2  
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 3  
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 4  
T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 1  
T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 2  
T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 3  
Device Identification Register  
Information Register 1  
70  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
93  
93  
94  
94  
52  
52  
52  
63  
R/W  
R
INFO1  
INFO2  
INFO3  
53  
Information Register 2  
153  
60  
R/W  
R
R
Information Register 3  
Unused  
Interrupt Information Register 1  
Interrupt Information Register 2  
Status Register 1  
IIR1  
42  
IIR2  
42  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
SR1  
154  
155  
63  
Interrupt Mask Register 1  
Status Register 2  
IMR1  
SR2  
Interrupt Mask Register 2  
Status Register 3  
IMR2  
64  
SR3  
65  
Interrupt Mask Register 3  
Status Register 4  
IMR3  
66  
SR4  
67  
Interrupt Mask Register 4  
Status Register 5  
IMR4  
68  
SR5  
106  
106  
135  
136  
135  
136  
112  
Interrupt Mask Register 5  
Status Register 6  
IMR5  
SR6  
Interrupt Mask Register 6  
Status Register 7  
IMR6  
SR7  
Interrupt Mask Register 7  
Status Register 8  
IMR7  
SR8  
33 of 238  
DS2155  
ADDRESS  
xxh  
25  
R/W  
REGISTER NAME  
SYMBOL  
PAGE  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
W
Interrupt Mask Register 8  
IMR8  
SR9  
112  
174  
175  
43  
26  
Status Register 9  
27  
Interrupt Mask Register 9  
IMR9  
28  
Per-Channel Pointer Register  
PCPR  
29  
Per-Channel Data Register 1  
PCDR1  
PCDR2  
PCDR3  
PCDR4  
INFO4  
INFO5  
INFO6  
INFO7  
H1RC  
44  
2A  
2B  
2C  
2D  
2E  
2F  
30  
W
Per-Channel Data Register 2  
44  
W
Per-Channel Data Register 3  
44  
W
Per-Channel Data Register 4  
44  
R/W  
R
Information Register 4  
137  
137  
137  
60  
Information Register 5  
R
R
Information Register 6  
Information Register 7  
31  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R
HDLC #1 Receive Control  
129  
129  
55  
32  
HDLC #2 Receive Control  
H2RC  
33  
E1 Receive Control Register 1  
E1RCR1  
E1RCR2  
E1TCR1  
E1TCR2  
BOCC  
34  
E1 Receive Control Register 2  
56  
35  
E1 Transmit Control Register 1  
E1 Transmit Control Register 2  
BOC Control Register  
57  
36  
58  
37  
111  
88  
38  
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Information 1  
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Information 2  
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Information 3  
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Information 4  
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Interrupt Enable 1  
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Interrupt Enable 2  
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Interrupt Enable 3  
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Interrupt Enable 4  
Signaling Control Register  
RSINFO1  
RSINFO2  
RSINFO3  
RSINFO4  
RSCSE1  
RSCSE2  
RSCSE3  
RSCSE4  
SIGCR  
ERCNT  
LCVCR1  
LCVCR2  
PCVCR1  
PCVCR2  
FOSCR1  
FOSCR2  
EBCR1  
EBCR2  
LBCR  
39  
88  
3A  
3B  
3C  
3D  
3E  
3F  
40  
88  
88  
88  
88  
88  
88  
85  
41  
Error Count Configuration Register  
Line Code Violation Count Register 1  
Line Code Violation Count Register 2  
Path Code Violation Count Register 1  
Path Code Violation Count Register 2  
Frames Out-of-Sync Count Register 1  
Frames Out-of-Sync Count Register 2  
E-Bit Count Register 1  
75  
42  
77  
43  
R
77  
44  
R
78  
45  
R
78  
46  
R
79  
47  
R
79  
48  
R
80  
49  
R
E-Bit Count Register 2  
Loopback Control Register  
80  
4A  
4B  
4C  
4D  
4E  
4F  
50  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
71  
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 1  
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 2  
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 3  
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 4  
Elastic Store Control Register  
PCLR1  
PCLR2  
PCLR3  
PCLR4  
ESCR  
73  
73  
74  
74  
105  
91  
Transmit Signaling Register 1  
TS1  
51  
Transmit Signaling Register 2  
TS2  
91  
52  
Transmit Signaling Register 3  
TS3  
91  
53  
Transmit Signaling Register 4  
TS4  
91  
34 of 238  
DS2155  
ADDRESS  
xxh  
54  
R/W  
REGISTER NAME  
SYMBOL  
PAGE  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R
Transmit Signaling Register 5  
TS5  
TS6  
91  
91  
91  
91  
91  
91  
91  
91  
91  
91  
91  
91  
86  
86  
86  
86  
86  
86  
86  
86  
86  
86  
86  
86  
86  
86  
86  
86  
62  
191  
192  
149  
81  
81  
82  
82  
147  
150  
151  
152  
149  
98  
98  
99  
99  
99  
55  
Transmit Signaling Register 6  
Transmit Signaling Register 7  
Transmit Signaling Register 8  
Transmit Signaling Register 9  
Transmit Signaling Register 10  
Transmit Signaling Register 11  
Transmit Signaling Register 12  
Transmit Signaling Register 13  
Transmit Signaling Register 14  
Transmit Signaling Register 15  
Transmit Signaling Register 16  
Receive Signaling Register 1  
Receive Signaling Register 2  
Receive Signaling Register 3  
Receive Signaling Register 4  
Receive Signaling Register 5  
Receive Signaling Register 6  
Receive Signaling Register 7  
Receive Signaling Register 8  
Receive Signaling Register 9  
Receive Signaling Register 10  
Receive Signaling Register 11  
Receive Signaling Register 12  
Receive Signaling Register 13  
Receive Signaling Register 14  
Receive Signaling Register 15  
Receive Signaling Register 16  
Common Control Register 1  
Common Control Register 2  
Common Control Register 3  
Common Control Register 4  
Transmit Channel Monitor Select  
Transmit DS0 Monitor Register  
Receive Channel Monitor Select  
Receive DS0 Monitor Register  
Line Interface Control 1  
56  
TS7  
57  
TS8  
58  
TS9  
59  
TS10  
TS11  
TS12  
TS13  
TS14  
TS15  
TS16  
RS1  
5A  
5B  
5C  
5D  
5E  
5F  
60  
61  
R
RS2  
62  
R
RS3  
63  
R
RS4  
64  
R
RS5  
65  
R
RS6  
66  
R
RS7  
67  
R
RS8  
68  
R
RS9  
69  
R
RS10  
RS11  
RS12  
RS13  
RS14  
RS15  
RS16  
CCR1  
CCR2  
CCR3  
CCR4  
TDS0SEL  
TDS0M  
RDS0SEL  
RDS0M  
LIC1  
LIC2  
LIC3  
LIC4  
6A  
6B  
6C  
6D  
6E  
6F  
70  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R
71  
72  
73  
74  
75  
76  
R/W  
R
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
W
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
77  
78  
79  
Line Interface Control 2  
7A  
7B  
7C  
7D  
7E  
7F  
80  
Line Interface Control 3  
Line Interface Control 4  
Unused  
Transmit Line Build-Out Control  
Idle Array Address Register  
Per-Channel Idle Code Value Register  
Transmit Idle Code Enable Register 1  
Transmit Idle Code Enable Register 2  
Transmit Idle Code Enable Register 3  
TLBC  
IAAR  
PCICR  
TCICE1  
TCICE2  
TCICE3  
81  
82  
35 of 238  
DS2155  
ADDRESS  
xxh  
83  
R/W  
REGISTER NAME  
SYMBOL  
PAGE  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R
Transmit Idle Code Enable Register 4  
Receive Idle Code Enable Register 1  
Receive Idle Code Enable Register 2  
Receive Idle Code Enable Register 3  
Receive Idle Code Enable Register 4  
Receive Channel Blocking Register 1  
Receive Channel Blocking Register 2  
Receive Channel Blocking Register 3  
Receive Channel Blocking Register 4  
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 1  
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 2  
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 3  
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 4  
HDLC #1 Transmit Control  
TCICE4  
RCICE1  
RCICE2  
RCICE3  
RCICE4  
RCBR1  
RCBR2  
RCBR3  
RCBR4  
TCBR1  
TCBR2  
TCBR3  
TCBR4  
H1TC  
99  
84  
100  
100  
100  
100  
101  
101  
102  
102  
103  
103  
103  
103  
128  
130  
131  
131  
131  
131  
132  
133  
133  
133  
133  
134  
138  
139  
139  
138  
128  
130  
131  
131  
131  
131  
132  
133  
133  
133  
133  
134  
138  
139  
139  
138  
188  
189  
85  
86  
87  
88  
89  
8A  
8B  
8C  
8D  
8E  
8F  
90  
91  
HDLC #1 FIFO Control  
H1FC  
92  
HDLC #1 Receive Channel Select 1  
HDLC #1 Receive Channel Select 2  
HDLC #1 Receive Channel Select 3  
HDLC #1 Receive Channel Select 4  
HDLC #1 Receive Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select  
HDLC #1 Transmit Channel Select1  
HDLC #1 Transmit Channel Select2  
HDLC #1 Transmit Channel Select3  
HDLC #1 Transmit Channel Select4  
HDLC #1 Transmit Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select  
HDLC #1 Receive Packet Bytes Available  
HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO  
H1RCS1  
H1RCS2  
H1RCS3  
H1RCS4  
H1RTSBS  
H1TCS1  
H1TCS2  
H1TCS3  
H1TCS4  
H1TTSBS  
H1RPBA  
H1TF  
93  
94  
95  
96  
97  
98  
99  
9A  
9B  
9C  
9D  
9E  
W
R
HDLC #1 Receive FIFO  
H1RF  
9F  
R
HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available  
HDLC #2 Transmit Control  
H1TFBA  
H2TC  
A0  
A1  
A2  
A3  
A4  
A5  
A6  
A7  
A8  
A9  
AA  
AB  
AC  
AD  
AE  
AF  
B0  
B1  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R
HDLC #2 FIFO Control  
H2FC  
HDLC #2 Receive Channel Select 1  
HDLC #2 Receive Channel Select 2  
HDLC #2 Receive Channel Select 3  
HDLC #2 Receive Channel Select 4  
HDLC #2 Receive Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select  
HDLC #2 Transmit Channel Select1  
HDLC #2 Transmit Channel Select2  
HDLC #2 Transmit Channel Select3  
HDLC #2 Transmit Channel Select4  
HDLC #2 Transmit Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select  
HDLC #2 Receive Packet Bytes Available  
HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO  
H2RCS1  
H2RCS2  
H2RCS3  
H2RCS4  
H2RTSBS  
H2TCS1  
H2TCS2  
H2TCS3  
H2TCS4  
H2TTSBS  
H2RPBA  
H2TF  
W
R
HDLC #2 Receive FIFO  
H2RF  
R
HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available  
Extend System Information Bus Control Register 1  
Extend System Information Bus Control Register 2  
H2TFBA  
ESIBCR1  
ESIBCR2  
R/W  
R/W  
36 of 238  
DS2155  
ADDRESS  
xxh  
B2  
R/W  
REGISTER NAME  
SYMBOL  
PAGE  
R
Extend System Information Bus Register 1  
Extend System Information Bus Register 2  
Extend System Information Bus Register 3  
Extend System Information Bus Register 4  
In-Band Code Control Register  
Transmit Code Definition Register 1  
Transmit Code Definition Register 2  
Receive Up Code Definition Register 1  
Receive Up Code Definition Register 2  
Receive Down Code Definition Register 1  
Receive Down Code Definition Register 2  
In-Band Receive Spare Control Register  
Receive Spare Code Definition Register 1  
Receive Spare Code Definition Register 2  
Receive FDL Register  
ESIB1  
ESIB2  
ESIB3  
ESIB4  
IBCC  
190  
190  
190  
190  
164  
165  
165  
166  
166  
167  
167  
168  
169  
169  
141  
142  
141  
141  
185  
114  
114  
116  
117  
117  
118  
118  
119  
119  
120  
115  
115  
120  
121  
121  
122  
122  
123  
123  
124  
125  
175  
176  
176  
176  
176  
172  
B3  
R
B4  
R
B5  
R
B6  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R
B7  
TCD1  
TCD2  
RUPCD1  
RUPCD2  
RDNCD1  
RDNCD2  
RSCC  
RSCD1  
RSCD2  
RFDL  
TFDL  
RFDLM1  
RFDLM2  
B8  
B9  
BA  
BB  
BC  
BD  
BE  
BF  
C0  
C1  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
Transmit FDL Register  
C2  
Receive FDL Match Register 1  
Receive FDL Match Register 2  
Unused  
C3  
C4  
C5  
R/W  
R
Interleave Bus Operation Control Register  
Receive Align Frame Register  
Receive Nonalign Frame Register  
Receive Si Align Frame  
IBOC  
RAF  
C6  
C7  
R
RNAF  
RSiAF  
RSiNAF  
RRA  
C8  
R
C9  
R
Receive Si Nonalign Frame  
CA  
CB  
CC  
CD  
CE  
CF  
D0  
D1  
D2  
D3  
D4  
D5  
D6  
D7  
D8  
D9  
DA  
DB  
DC  
DD  
DE  
DF  
E0  
R
Receive Remote Alarm Bits  
Receive Sa4 Bits  
R
RSa4  
R
Receive Sa5 Bits  
RSa5  
R
Receive Sa6 Bits  
RSa6  
R
Receive Sa7 Bits  
RSa7  
R
Receive Sa8 Bits  
RSa8  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
Transmit Align Frame Register  
Transmit Nonalign Frame Register  
Transmit Si Align Frame  
TAF  
TNAF  
TSiAF  
TSiNAF  
TRA  
Transmit Si Nonalign Frame  
Transmit Remote Alarm Bits  
Transmit Sa4 Bits  
TSa4  
Transmit Sa5 Bits  
TSa5  
Transmit Sa6 Bits  
TSa6  
Transmit Sa7 Bits  
TSa7  
Transmit Sa8 Bits  
TSa8  
Transmit Sa Bit Control Register  
BERT Alternating Word Count Rate  
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 1  
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 2  
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 3  
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 4  
BERT Control Register 1  
TSACR  
BAWC  
BRP1  
BRP2  
BRP3  
BRP4  
BC1  
37 of 238  
DS2155  
ADDRESS  
xxh  
E1  
R/W  
REGISTER NAME  
SYMBOL  
PAGE  
R/W  
R
BERT Control Register 2  
BC2  
173  
E2  
Unused  
E3  
BERT Bit Count Register 1  
BERT Bit Count Register 2  
BERT Bit Count Register 3  
BERT Bit Count Register 4  
BERT Error Count Register 1  
BERT Error Count Register 2  
BERT Error Count Register 3  
BERT Interface Control Register  
Error Rate Control Register  
Number-of-Errors 1  
BBC1  
BBC2  
BBC3  
BBC4  
BEC1  
BEC2  
BEC3  
BIC  
177  
177  
177  
177  
178  
178  
178  
179  
181  
182  
182  
183  
183  
E4  
R
E5  
R
E6  
R
E7  
R
E8  
R
E9  
R
EA  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R/W  
R
EB  
ERC  
EC  
NOE1  
NOE2  
NOEL1  
NOEL2  
TEST  
TEST  
TEST  
ED  
Number-of-Errors 2  
EE  
Number-of-Errors Left 1  
Number-of-Errors Left 2  
Test Register  
EF  
R
F0*  
F1–F9*  
Test Register  
Test Register  
FA–FF*  
*TEST1 to TEST16 registers are used only by the factory.  
38 of 238  
DS2155  
6. PROGRAMMING MODEL  
The DS2155 register map is divided into three groups: T1 specific features, E1 specific features, and  
common features. The typical programming sequence begins with issuing a reset to the DS2155, selecting  
T1 or E1 operation in the master mode register, enabling T1 or E1 functions and enabling the common  
functions. The act of resetting the DS2155 automatically clears all configuration and status registers.  
Therefore, it is not necessary to load unused registers with 0s.  
Figure 6-1. Programming Sequence  
POWER-ON  
ISSUE RESET  
SELECT T1 OR E1 OPERATION  
IN MASTER MODE REGISTER  
PROGRAM E1 SPECIFIC REGISTERS  
PROGRAM T1 SPECIFIC REGISTERS  
PROGRAM COMMON REGISTERS  
DS2155 OPERATIONAL  
39 of 238  
DS2155  
6.1 Power-Up Sequence  
The DS2155 contains an on-chip power-up reset function that automatically clears the writeable register  
space immediately after power is supplied to the DS2155. The user can issue a chip reset at any time.  
Issuing a reset disrupts traffic flowing through the DS2155 until the device is reprogrammed. The reset  
can be issued through hardware using the TSTRST pin or through software using the SFTRST function in  
the master mode register. The LIRST (LIC2.6) should be toggled from 0 to 1 to reset the line interface  
circuitry. (It takes the DS2155 about 40ms to recover from the LIRST bit being toggled.) Finally, after the  
TSYSCLK and RSYSCLK inputs are stable, the receive and transmit elastic stores should be reset (this  
step can be skipped if the elastic stores are disabled).  
6.1.1 Master Mode Register  
Register Name:  
MSTRREG  
Master Mode Register  
00h  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
TEST1  
0
2
TEST0  
0
1
T1/E1  
0
0
SFTRST  
0
Bit 0/Software-Issued Reset (SFTRST). A 0-to-1 transition causes the register space in the DS2155 to be cleared.  
A reset clears all configuration and status registers. The bit automatically clears itself when the reset has completed.  
Bit 1/DS2155 Operating Mode (T1/E1). Used to select the operating mode of the framer/formatter (digital)  
portion of the 2156. The operating mode of the LIU must also be programmed.  
0 = T1 operation  
1 = E1 operation  
Bits 2, 3/Test Mode Bits (TEST0, TEST1). Test modes are used to force the output pins of the DS2155 into  
known states. This can facilitate the checkout of assemblies during the manufacturing process and also be used to  
isolate devices from shared buses.  
TEST1 TEST0  
Effect On Output Pins  
0
0
Operate normally  
0
1
1
1
0
1
Force all output pins into tri-state (including all I/O pins and parallel port pins)  
Force all output pins low (including all I/O pins except parallel port pins)  
Force all output pins high (including all I/O pins except parallel port pins)  
Bits 4 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
40 of 238  
DS2155  
6.2 Interrupt Handling  
Various alarms, conditions, and events in the DS2155 can cause interrupts. For simplicity, these are all  
referred to as events in this explanation. All status registers can be programmed to produce interrupts.  
Each status register has an associated interrupt mask register. For example, SR1 (status register 1) has an  
interrupt control register called IMR1 (interrupt mask register 1). Status registers are the only sources of  
interrupts in the DS2155. On power-up, all writeable registers are automatically cleared. Since bits in the  
IMRx registers have to be set = 1 to allow a particular event to cause an interrupt, no interrupts can occur  
until the host selects which events are to product interrupts. Since there are potentially many sources of  
interrupts on the DS2155, several features are available to help sort out and identify which event is  
causing an interrupt. When an interrupt occurs, the host should first read the IIR1 and IIR2 registers  
(interrupt information registers) to identify which status register (or registers) is producing the interrupt.  
Once that is determined, the individual status register or registers can be examined to determine the exact  
source. In multiple port configurations, two to eight DS2155s can be connected together by the 3-wire  
ESIB feature. This allows multiple DS2155s to be interrogated by a single CPU port read cycle. The host  
can determine the synchronization status, or interrupt status of up to eight devices with a single read. The  
ESIB feature also allows the user to select from various events to be examined through this method. For  
more information, see Section 29.  
Once an interrupt has occurred, the interrupt handler routine should set the INTDIS bit (CCR3.6) to stop  
further activity on the interrupt pin. After all interrupts have been determined and processed, the interrupt  
hander routine should re-enable interrupts by setting the INTDIS bit = 0.  
6.3 Status Registers  
When a particular event or condition has occurred (or is still occurring in the case of conditions), the  
appropriate bit in a status register is set to a 1. All of the status registers operate in a latched fashion. This  
means that if an event or condition occurs a bit is set to a 1. It remains set until the user reads that bit. An  
event bit is cleared when it is read and it is not set again until the event has occurred again. Condition bits  
such as RBL, RLOS, etc., remain set if the alarm is still present.  
The user always proceeds a read of any of the status registers with a write. The byte written to the register  
informs the DS2155 which bits the user wishes to read and have cleared. The user writes a byte to one of  
these registers, with a 1 in the bit positions the user wishes to read and a 0 in the bit positions the user  
does not wish to obtain the latest information on. When a 1 is written to a bit location, the read register is  
updated with the latest information. When a 0 is written to a bit position, the read register is not updated  
and the previous value is held. A write to the status registers is immediately followed by a read of the  
same register. This write-read scheme allows an external microcontroller or microprocessor to  
individually poll certain bits without disturbing the other bits in the register. This operation is key in  
controlling the DS2155 with higher order languages.  
Status register bits are divided into two groups, condition bits and event bits. Condition bits are typically  
network conditions such as loss-of-sync or all-ones detect. Event bits are typically markers such as the  
one-second timer, elastic store slip, etc. Each status register bit is labeled as a condition or event bit.  
Some of the status registers have bits for both the detection of a condition and the clearance of the  
condition. For example, SR2 has a bit that is set when the device goes into a loss-of-sync state (SR2.0, a  
condition bit) and a bit that is set (SR2.4, an event bit) when the loss-of-sync condition clears (goes in  
sync). Some of the status register bits (condition bits) do not have a separate bit for the “condition clear”  
event but rather the status bit can produce interrupts on both edges, setting and clearing. These bits are  
marked as double interrupt bits. An interrupt is produced when the condition occurs and when it clears.  
41 of 238  
 
 
DS2155  
6.4 Information Registers  
Information registers operate the same as status registers except they cannot cause interrupts. They are all  
latched except for INFO7 and some of the bits in INFO5 and INFO6. INFO7 register is a read-only  
register. It reports the status of the E1 synchronizer in real time. INFO7 and some of the bits in INFO6  
and INFO5 are not latched and it is not necessary to precede a read of these bits with a write.  
6.5 Interrupt Information Registers  
The interrupt information registers provide an indication of which status registers (SR1 through SR9) are  
generating an interrupt. When an interrupt occurs, the host can read IIR1 and IIR2 to quickly identify  
which of the nine status registers are causing the interrupt.  
Register Name:  
IIR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Interrupt Information Register 1  
14h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
SR8  
0
6
SR7  
0
5
SR6  
0
4
SR5  
0
3
SR4  
0
2
SR3  
0
1
SR2  
0
0
SR1  
0
Register Name:  
IIR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Interrupt Information Register 2  
15h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
U_RSR  
0
0
SR9  
0
42 of 238  
DS2155  
7. SPECIAL PER-CHANNEL REGISTER OPERATION  
Some of the features described in the data sheet that operate on a per-channel basis use a special method  
for channel selection. There are five registers involved: per-channel pointer register (PCPR) and per-  
channel data registers 1–4 (PCDR1–4). The user selects which function or functions are to be applied on a  
per-channel basis by setting the appropriate bit(s) in the PCPR register. The user then writes to the PCDR  
registers to select the channels for that function. The following is an example of mapping the transmit and  
receive BERT function to channels 9–12, 20, and 21.  
Write 11h to PCPR  
Write 00h to PCDR1  
Write 0fh to PCDR2  
Write 18h to PCDR3  
Write 00h to PCDR4  
The user may write to the PCDR1-4 with muliple functions in the PCPR register selected, but can only  
read the values from the PCDR1-4 registers for a single function at a time. More information about how  
to use these per-channel features can be found in their respective sections in the data sheet.  
Register Name:  
PCPR  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Per-Channel Pointer Register  
28h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
BRCS  
0
3
2
1
TFCS  
0
0
BTCS  
0
RSAOICS RSRCS RFCS  
THSCS PEICS  
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Bert Transmit Channel Select (BTCS)  
Bit 1/Transmit Fractional Channel Select (TFCS)  
Bit 2/Payload Error Insert Channel Select (PEICS)  
Bit 3/Transmit Hardware Signaling Channel Select (THSCS)  
Bit 4/Bert Receive Channel Select (BRCS)  
Bit 5/Receive Fractional Channel Select (RFCS)  
Bit 6/Receive Signaling Reinsertion Channel Select (RSRCS)  
Bit 7/Receive Signaling All-Ones Insertion Channel Select (RSAOICS)  
43 of 238  
 
DS2155  
Register Name:  
PCDR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Per-Channel Data Register 1  
29h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
CH3  
1
0
CH8  
CH7  
CH6  
CH5  
CH4  
CH2  
CH1  
Register Name:  
PCDR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Per-Channel Data Register 2  
2Ah  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
CH11  
1
CH10  
0
CH16  
CH15  
CH14  
CH13  
CH12  
CH9  
Register Name:  
PCDR3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Per-Channel Data Register 3  
2Bh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
CH19  
1
CH18  
0
CH24  
CH23  
CH22  
CH21  
CH20  
CH17  
Register Name:  
PCDR4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Per-Channel Data Register 4  
2Ch  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
CH27  
1
CH26  
0
CH32  
CH31  
CH30  
CH29  
CH28  
CH25  
44 of 238  
DS2155  
8. CLOCK MAP  
Figure 8-1 shows the clock map of the DS2155. The routing for the transmit and receive clocks are shown  
for the various loopback modes and jitter attenuator positions. Although there is only one jitter attenuator,  
which can be placed in the receive or transmit path, two are shown for simplification and clarity.  
Figure 8-1. Clock Map  
MCLK  
TSYSCLK  
MCLKS = 0  
MCLKS = 1  
LIC4.MPS0  
PRE-SCALER  
LIC4.MPS1  
2.048 TO 1.544  
SYNTHESIZER  
LIC2.3  
DJA = 1  
DJA = 0  
8 x PLL  
8XCLK  
LOCAL  
JITTER ATTENUATOR  
LOOPBACK  
SEE LIC1 REGISTER  
REMOTE  
FRAMER  
PAYLOAD  
LOOPBACK  
LOOPBACK  
LOOPBACK  
(SEE NOTES)  
RCL = 1  
JAS = 0  
AND  
BPCLK  
SYNTH  
LLB = 0  
LLB = 1  
BPCLK  
RCLK  
DJA = 0  
FLB = 0  
FLB = 1  
LTCA  
RXCLK  
RECEIVE  
FRAMER  
RCL = 0  
JAS = 1  
OR  
TO  
JAS = 0  
DJA = 1  
LIU  
OR  
DJA = 1  
RLB = 1  
RLB = 0  
PLB = 1  
PLB = 0  
TXCLK  
LTCA  
TRANSMIT  
FORMATTER  
JAS = 1  
AND  
DJA = 0  
TCLK  
MUX  
A
B
C
TCLK  
The TCLK MUX is dependent on the state of the TCSS0 and TCSS1 bits in the CCR1 register and the  
state of the TCLK pin.  
TCSS1  
TCSS0  
Transmit Clock Source  
0
0
0
1
The TCLK pin (C) is always the source of transmit clock.  
Switch to the recovered clock (B) when the signal at the TCLK pin  
fails to transition after one channel time.  
Use the scaled signal (A) derived from MCLK as the transmit clock.  
The TCLK pin is ignored.  
1
1
0
1
Use the recovered clock (B) as the transmit clock. The TCLK pin is  
ignored.  
45 of 238  
 
DS2155  
9. T1 FRAMER/FORMATTER CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS  
The T1 framer portion of the DS2155 is configured through a set of nine control registers. Typically, the  
control registers are only accessed when the system is first powered up. Once the DS2155 has been  
initialized, the control registers only need to be accessed when there is a change in the system  
configuration. There are two receive control registers (T1RCR1 and T1RCR2), two transmit control  
registers (T1TCR1 and T1TCR2), and a common control register (T1CCR1). Each of these registers is  
described in this section.  
9.1 T1 Control Registers  
Register Name:  
T1RCR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
T1 Receive Control Register 1  
03h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
ARC  
0
5
OOF1  
0
4
OOF2  
0
3
SYNCC  
0
2
1
0
SYNCT SYNCE RESYNC  
0
0
0
Bit 0/Resynchronize (RESYNC). When toggled from low to high, a resynchronization of the receive-side framer  
is initiated. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent resync.  
Bit 1/Sync Enable (SYNCE)  
0 = auto resync enabled  
1 = auto resync disabled  
Bit 2/Sync Time (SYNCT)  
0 = qualify 10 bits  
1 = qualify 24 bits  
Bit 3/Sync Criteria (SYNCC)  
In D4 Framing Mode:  
0 = search for Ft pattern, then search for Fs pattern  
1 = cross couple Ft and Fs pattern  
In ESF Framing Mode:  
0 = search for FPS pattern only  
1 = search for FPS and verify with CRC6  
Bits 4, 5/Out-of-Frame Select Bits (OOF2, OOF1)  
OOF2  
OOF1  
Out-Of-Frame Criteria  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
2/4 frame bits in error  
2/5 frame bits in error  
2/6 frame bits in error  
2/6 frame bits in error  
Bit 6/Auto Resync Criteria (ARC)  
0 = resync on OOF or RCL event  
1 = resync on OOF only  
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
46 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
T1RCR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
T1 Receive Control Register 2  
04h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
RFM  
0
5
RB8ZS  
0
4
RSLC96  
0
3
RZSE  
0
2
RZBTSI  
0
1
RJC  
0
0
RD4YM  
0
Bit 0/Receive-Side D4 Yellow Alarm Select (RD4YM)  
0 = 0s in bit 2 of all channels  
1 = a 1 in the S-bit position of frame 12 (J1 Yellow Alarm Mode)  
Bit 1/Receive Japanese CRC6 Enable (RJC)  
0 = use ANSI/AT&T/ITU CRC6 calculation (normal operation)  
1 = use Japanese standard JT–G704 CRC6 calculation  
Bit 2/Receive-Side ZBTSI Support Enable (RZBTSI). Allows ZBTSI information to be output on RLINK pin.  
0 = ZBTSI disabled  
1 = ZBTSI enabled  
Bit 3/Receive FDL Zero-Destuffer Enable (RZSE). Set this bit to 0 if using the internal HDLC/BOC controller  
instead of the legacy support for the FDL. See Section 23.5 for details.  
0 = zero destuffer disabled  
1 = zero destuffer enabled  
Bit 4/Receive SLC-96 Enable (RSLC96). Only set this bit to a 1 in D4/SLC-96 framing applications. See Section  
23.6 for details.  
0 = SLC-96 disabled  
1 = SLC-96 enabled  
Bit 5/Receive B8ZS Enable (RB8ZS)  
0 = B8ZS disabled  
1 = B8ZS enabled  
Bit 6/Receive Frame Mode Select (RFM)  
0 = D4 framing mode  
1 = ESF framing mode  
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
47 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
T1TCR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
T1 Transmit Control Register 1  
05h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
TJC  
0
6
TFPT  
0
5
TCPT  
0
4
TSSE  
0
3
GB7S  
0
2
TFDLS  
0
1
TBL  
0
0
TYEL  
0
Bit 0/Transmit Yellow Alarm (TYEL)  
0 = do not transmit yellow alarm  
1 = transmit yellow alarm  
Bit 1/Transmit Blue Alarm (TBL)  
0 = transmit data normally  
1 = transmit an unframed all-ones code at TPOS and TNEG  
Bit 2/TFDL Register Select (TFDLS)  
0 = source FDL or Fs-bits from the internal TFDL register (legacy FDL support mode)  
1 = source FDL or Fs-bits from the internal HDLC controller or the TLINK pin  
Bit 3/Global Bit 7 Stuffing (GB7S)  
0 = allow the SSIEx registers to determine which channels containing all 0s are to be bit 7 stuffed  
1 = force bit 7 stuffing in all 0-byte channels regardless of how the SSIEx registers are programmed  
Bit 4/Transmit Software Signaling Enable (TSSE).  
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers regardless of the SSIEx registers. The SSIEx  
registers still define which channels are to have B7 stuffing preformed.  
1 = source signaling data as enabled by the SSIEx registers  
Bit 5/Transmit CRC Pass-Through (TCPT)  
0 = source CRC6 bits internally  
1 = CRC6 bits sampled at TSER during F-bit time  
Bit 6/Transmit F-Bit Pass-Through (TFPT)  
0 = F bits sourced internally  
1 = F bits sampled at TSER  
Bit 7/Transmit Japanese CRC6 Enable (TJC)  
0 = use ANSI/AT&T/ITU CRC6 calculation (normal operation)  
1 = use Japanese standard JT–G704 CRC6 calculation  
48 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
T1TCR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
T1 Transmit Control Register 2  
06h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
TZSE  
0
4
3
2
1
0
TB8ZS TSLC96  
FBCT2 FBCT1 TD4YM TZBTSI TB7ZS  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit-Side Bit 7 Zero-Suppression Enable (TB7ZS)  
0 = no stuffing occurs  
1 = bit 7 forced to a 1 in channels with all 0s  
Bit 1/Transmit-Side ZBTSI Support Enable (TZBTSI). Allows ZBTSI information to be input on TLINK pin.  
0 = ZBTSI disabled  
1 = ZBTSI enabled  
Bit 2/Transmit-Side D4 Yellow Alarm Select (TD4YM)  
0 = 0s in bit 2 of all channels  
1 = a 1 in the S-bit position of frame 12  
Bit 3/F-Bit Corruption Type 1 (FBCT1). A low-to-high transition of this bit causes the next three consecutive Ft  
(D4 framing mode) or FPS (ESF framing mode) bits to be corrupted causing the remote end to experience a loss of  
synchronization.  
Bit 4/F-Bit Corruption Type 2 (FBCT2). Setting this bit high enables the corruption of one Ft (D4 framing mode)  
or FPS (ESF framing mode) bit in every 128 Ft or FPS bits as long as the bit remains set.  
Bit 5/Transmit FDL Zero-Stuffer Enable (TZSE). Set this bit to 0 if using the internal HDLC controller instead  
of the legacy support for the FDL. See Section 15 for details.  
0 = zero stuffer disabled  
1 = zero stuffer enabled  
Bit 6/Transmit SLC-96/Fs-Bit Insertion Enable (TSLC96). Only set this bit to a 1 in D4 framing applications.  
Must be set to 1 to source the Fs pattern from the TFDL register. See Section 23.6 for details.  
0 = SLC-96/Fs-bit insertion disabled  
1 = SLC-96/Fs-bit insertion enabled  
Bit 7/Transmit B8ZS Enable (TB8ZS)  
0 = B8ZS disabled  
1 = B8ZS enabled  
49 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
T1CCR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
T1 Common Control Register 1  
07h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
3
2
TFM  
0
1
PDE  
0
0
TLOOP  
0
TRAI-CI TAIS-CI  
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit Loop-Code Enable (TLOOP). See Section 25 for details.  
0 = transmit data normally  
1 = replace normal transmitted data with repeating code as defined in registers TCD1 and TCD2  
Bit 1/Pulse Density Enforcer Enable (PDE). The framer always examines the transmit and receive data streams  
for violations of these, which are required by ANSI T1.403: No more than 15 consecutive 0s and at least N 1s in  
each and every time window of 8 x (N + 1) bits, where N = 1 through 23. Violations for the transmit and receive  
data streams are reported in the INFO1.6 and INFO1.7 bits, respectively. When this bit is set to 1, the DS2155  
forces the transmitted stream to meet this requirement no matter the content of the transmitted stream. When  
running B8ZS, this bit should be set to 0 since B8ZS encoded data streams cannot violate the pulse density  
requirements.  
0 = disable transmit pulse density enforcer  
1 = enable transmit pulse density enforcer  
Bit 2/Transmit Frame Mode Select (TFM)  
0 = D4 framing mode  
1 = ESF framing mode  
Bit 3/Transmit AIS-CI Enable (TAIS-CI). Setting this bit and the TBL bit (T1TCR1.1) causes the AIS-CI code  
to be transmitted at TPOSO and TNEGO, as defined in ANSI T1.403.  
0 = do not transmit the AIS-CI code  
1 = transmit the AIS-CI code (T1TCR1.1 must also be set = 1)  
Bit 4/Transmit RAI-CI Enable (TRAI-CI). Setting this bit causes the ESF RAI-CI code to be transmitted in the  
FDL bit position.  
0 = do not transmit the ESF RAI-CI code  
1 = transmit the ESF RAI-CI code  
Bits 5 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
50 of 238  
DS2155  
9.2 T1 Transmit Transparency  
The software signaling insertion-enable registers, SSIE1–SSIE4, can be used to select signaling insertion  
from the transmit signaling registers, TS1–TS12, on a per-channel basis. Setting a bit in the SSIEx  
register allows signaling data to be sourced from the signaling registers for that channel.  
In transparent mode, bit 7 stuffing and/or robbed-bit signaling is prevented from overwriting the data in  
the channels. If a DS0 is programmed to be clear, no robbed-bit signaling is inserted nor does the channel  
have bit 7 stuffing performed. However, in the D4 framing mode, bit 2 is overwritten by a 0 when a  
Yellow Alarm is transmitted. Also, the user has the option to globally override the SSIEx registers from  
determining which channels are to have bit 7 stuffing performed. If the T1TCR1.3 and T1TCR2.0 bits are  
set to 1, then all 24 T1 channels have bit 7 stuffing performed on them, regardless of how the SSIEx  
registers are programmed. In this manner, the SSIEx registers are only affecting the channels that are to  
have robbed-bit signaling inserted into them.  
9.3 AIS-CI and RAI-CI Generation and Detection  
The DS2155 can transmit and detect the RAI-CI and AIS-CI codes in T1 mode. These codes are  
compatible with and do not interfere with the standard RAI (Yellow) and AIS (Blue) alarms. These codes  
are defined in ANSI T1.403.  
The AIS-CI code (alarm indication signal-customer installation) is the same for both ESF and D4  
operation. Setting the TAIS-CI bit in the T1CCR1 register and the TBL bit in the T1TCR1 register causes  
the DS2155 to transmit the AIS-CI code. The RAIS-CI status bit in the SR4 register indicates the  
reception of an AIS-CI signal.  
The RAI-CI (remote alarm indication-customer installation) code for T1 ESF operation is a special form  
of the ESF Yellow Alarm (an unscheduled message). Setting the RAIS-CI bit in the T1CCR1 register  
causes the DS2155 to transmit the RAI-CI code. The RAI-CI code causes a standard Yellow Alarm to be  
detected by the receiver. When the host processor detects a Yellow Alarm, it can then test the alarm for  
the RAI-CI state by checking the BOC detector for the RAI-CI flag. That flag is a 011111 code in the 6-  
bit BOC message.  
The RAI-CI code for T1 D4 operation is a 10001011 flag in all 24 time slots. To transmit the RAI-CI  
code the host sets all 24 channels to idle with a 10001011 idle code. Since this code meets the  
requirements for a standard T1 D4 Yellow Alarm, the host can use the receive channel monitor function  
to detect the 100001011 code whenever a standard Yellow Alarm is detected.  
51 of 238  
DS2155  
9.4 T1 Receive-Side Digital-Milliwatt Code Generation  
Receive-side digital-milliwatt code generation involves using the receive digital-milliwatt registers  
(T1RDMR1/2/3) to determine which of the 24 T1 channels of the T1 line going to the backplane should  
be overwritten with a digital-milliwatt pattern. The digital-milliwatt code is an 8-byte repeating pattern  
that represents a 1kHz sine wave (1E/0B/0B/1E/9E/8B/8B/9E). Each bit in the T1RDMRx registers  
represents a particular channel. If a bit is set to a 1, then the receive data in that channel is replaced with  
the digital-milliwatt code. If a bit is set to 0, no replacement occurs.  
Register Name:  
T1RDMR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
T1 Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable Register 1  
0Ch  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH8  
0
6
CH7  
0
5
CH6  
0
4
CH5  
0
3
CH4  
0
2
CH3  
0
1
CH2  
0
0
CH1  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable for Channels 1 to 8 (CH1 to CH8)  
0 = do not affect the receive data associated with this channel  
1 = replace the receive data associated with this channel with digital-milliwatt code  
Register Name:  
T1RDMR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
T1 Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable Register 2  
0Dh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH16  
0
6
CH15  
0
5
CH14  
0
4
CH13  
0
3
CH12  
0
2
CH11  
0
1
CH10  
0
0
CH9  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable for Channels 9 to 16 (CH9 to CH16)  
0 = do not affect the receive data associated with this channel  
1 = replace the receive data associated with this channel with digital-milliwatt code  
Register Name:  
T1RDMR3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
T1 Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable Register 3  
0Eh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH24  
0
6
CH23  
0
5
CH22  
0
4
CH21  
0
3
CH20  
0
2
CH19  
0
1
CH18  
0
0
CH17  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Digital-Milliwatt Enable for Channels 17 to 24 (CH17 to CH24)  
0 = do not affect the receive data associated with this channel  
1 = replace the receive data associated with this channel with digital-milliwatt code  
52 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
INFO1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Information Register 1  
10h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
RPDV  
0
6
TPDV  
0
5
COFA  
0
4
8ZD  
0
3
16ZD  
0
2
SEFE  
0
1
B8ZS  
0
0
FBE  
0
Bit 0/Frame Bit-Error Event (FBE). Set when an Ft (D4) or FPS (ESF) framing bit is received in error.  
Bit 1/B8ZS Codeword Detect Event (B8ZS). Set when a B8ZS codeword is detected at RPOS and RNEG  
independent of whether the B8ZS mode is selected or not by T1TCR2.7. Useful for automatically setting the line  
coding.  
Bit 2/Severely Errored Framing Event (SEFE). Set when two out of six framing bits (Ft or FPS) are received in  
error.  
Bit 3/Sixteen Zero-Detect Event (16ZD). Set when a string of at least 16 consecutive 0s (regardless of the length  
of the string) have been received at RPOSI and RNEGI.  
Bit 4/Eight Zero-Detect Event (8ZD). Set when a string of at least eight consecutive 0s (regardless of the length  
of the string) have been received at RPOSI and RNEGI.  
Bit 5/Change-of-Frame Alignment Event (COFA). Set when the last resync resulted in a change-of-frame or  
multiframe alignment.  
Bit 6/Transmit Pulse-Density Violation Event (TPDV). Set when the transmit data stream does not meet the  
ANSI T1.403 requirements for pulse density.  
Bit 7/Receive Pulse-Density Violation Event (RPDV). Set when the receive data stream does not meet the ANSI  
T1.403 requirements for pulse density.  
53 of 238  
DS2155  
Table 9-A. T1 Alarm Criteria  
ALARM  
SET CRITERIA  
CLEAR CRITERIA  
Blue Alarm (AIS)  
When over a 3ms window, five or  
When over a 3ms window, six or  
(Note 1)  
fewer 0s are received  
more 0s are received  
Yellow Alarm (RAI)  
D4 Bit 2 Mode  
(T1RCR2.0 = 0)  
When bit 2 of 256 consecutive  
channels is set to 0 for at least 254  
occurrences  
When bit 2 of 256 consecutive  
channels is set to 0 for fewer than  
254 occurrences  
D4 12th F-Bit Mode  
When the 12th framing bit is set to 1 When the 12th framing bit is set to  
(T1RCR2.0 = 1; this mode is also  
referred to as the “Japanese Yellow  
Alarm”)  
for two consecutive occurrences  
0 for two consecutive occurrences  
ESF Mode  
When 16 consecutive patterns of  
00FF appear in the FDL  
When 14 or fewer patterns of 00FF  
hex out of 16 possible appear in the  
FDL  
Red Alarm (LRCL)  
When 192 consecutive 0s are  
received  
When 14 or more 1s out of 112  
possible bit positions are received  
(Also referred to as loss of signal)  
Note 1: The definition of Blue Alarm (or AIS) is an unframed all-ones signal. Blue Alarm detectors should be able to operate properly in the  
presence of a 10E-3 error rate and they should not falsely trigger on a framed all-1s signal. Blue Alarm criteria in the DS2155 has been  
set to achieve this performance. It is recommended that the RBL bit be qualified with the RLOS bit.  
Note 2: ANSI specifications use a different nomenclature than the DS2155 does. The following terms are equivalent:  
RBL = AIS  
RCL = LOS  
RLOS = LOF  
RYEL = RAI  
54 of 238  
DS2155  
10. E1 FRAMER/FORMATTER CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS  
The E1 framer portion of the DS2155 is configured by a set of four control registers. Typically, the  
control registers are only accessed when the system is first powered up. Once the DS2155 has been  
initialized, the control registers need only to be accessed when there is a change in the system  
configuration. There are two receive control registers (E1RCR1 and E1RCR2) and two transmit control  
registers (E1TCR1 and E1TCR2). There are also four status and information registers. Each of these eight  
registers is described in this section.  
10.1E1 Control Registers  
Register Name:  
E1RCR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
E1 Receive Control Register 1  
33h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
FRC  
0
1
0
RSERC RSIGM RHDB3 RG802 RCRC4  
SYNCE RESYNC  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Resync (RESYNC). When toggled from low to high, a resync is initiated. Must be cleared and set again for a  
subsequent resync.  
Bit 1/Sync Enable (SYNCE)  
0 = auto resync enabled  
1 = auto resync disabled  
Bit 2/Frame Resync Criteria (FRC)  
0 = resync if FAS received in error three consecutive times  
1 = resync if FAS or bit 2 of non-FAS is received in error three consecutive times  
Bit 3/Receive CRC4 Enable (RCRC4)  
0 = CRC4 disabled  
1 = CRC4 enabled  
Bit 4/Receive G.802 Enable (RG802). See Section 17 for details.  
0 = do not force RCHBLK high during bit 1 of time slot 26  
1 = force RCHBLK high during bit 1 of time slot 26  
Bit 5/Receive HDB3 Enable (RHDB3)  
0 = HDB3 disabled  
1 = HDB3 enabled  
Bit 6/Receive Signaling Mode Select (RSIGM)  
0 = CAS signaling mode  
1 = CCS signaling mode  
Bit 7/RSER Control (RSERC)  
0 = allow RSER to output data as received under all conditions  
1 = force RSER to 1 under loss-of-frame alignment conditions  
55 of 238  
DS2155  
Table 10-A. E1 Sync/Resync Criteria  
FRAME OR  
MULTIFRAME  
LEVEL  
SYNC CRITERIA  
RESYNC CRITERIA  
ITU SPEC.  
Three consecutive incorrect  
FAS received  
FAS present in frame N and  
N + 2; FAS not present in  
frame N + 1  
G.706  
4.1.1  
4.1.2  
FAS  
Alternate: (E1RCR1.2 = 1) The  
above criteria is met or three  
consecutive incorrect bit 2 of  
non-FAS received  
915 or more CRC4 codewords  
out of 1000 received in error  
Two valid MF alignment  
words found within 8ms  
Valid MF alignment word  
found and previous time slot  
16 contains code other than  
all 0s  
G.706  
CRC4  
CAS  
4.2 and 4.3.2  
Two consecutive MF  
alignment words received in  
error  
G.732  
5.2  
Register Name:  
E1RCR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
E1 Receive Control Register 2  
34h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
Sa8S  
0
6
Sa7S  
0
5
Sa6S  
0
4
Sa5S  
0
3
Sa4S  
0
2
0
1
0
0
RCLA  
0
Bit 0/Receive Carrier-Loss (RCL) Alternate Criteria (RCLA). Defines the criteria for a receive carrier-loss  
condition for both the framer and LIU.  
0 = RCL declared upon 255 consecutive 0s (125µs)  
1 = RCL declared upon 2048 consecutive 0s (1ms)  
Bits 1, 2/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
Bit 3/Sa4 Bit Select (Sa4S). Set to 1 to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa4 bit position; set to 0 to force RLCLK low  
during Sa4 bit position. See Section 35 for details.  
Bit 4/Sa5 Bit Select (Sa5S). Set to 1 to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa5 bit position; set to 0 to force RLCLK low  
during Sa5 bit position. See Section 35 for details.  
Bit 5/Sa6 Bit Select (Sa6S). Set to 1 to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa6 bit position; set to 0 to force RLCLK low  
during Sa6 bit position. See Section 35 for details.  
Bit 6/Sa7 Bit Select (Sa7S). Set to 1 to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa7 bit position; set to 0 to force RLCLK low  
during Sa7 bit position. See Section 35 for details.  
Bit 7/Sa8 Bit Select (Sa8S). Set to 1 to have RLCLK pulse at the Sa8 bit position; set to 0 to force RLCLK low  
during Sa8 bit position. See Section 35 for details.  
56 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
E1TCR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
E1 Transmit Control Register 1  
35h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
TFPT  
0
6
T16S  
0
5
TUA1  
0
4
TSiS  
0
3
TSA1  
0
2
1
0
TCRC4  
0
THDB3 TG802  
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit CRC4 Enable (TCRC4)  
0 = CRC4 disabled  
1 = CRC4 enabled  
Bit 1/Transmit G.802 Enable (TG802). See Section 35 for details.  
0 = do not force TCHBLK high during bit 1 of time slot 26  
1 = force TCHBLK high during bit 1 of time slot 26  
Bit 2/Transmit HDB3 Enable (THDB3)  
0 = HDB3 disabled  
1 = HDB3 enabled  
Bit 3/Transmit Signaling All Ones (TSA1)  
0 = normal operation  
1 = force time slot 16 in every frame to all ones  
Bit 4/Transmit International Bit Select (TSiS)  
0 = sample Si bits at TSER pin  
1 = source Si bits from TAF and TNAF registers (in this mode, E1TCR1.7 must be set to 0)  
Bit 5/Transmit Unframed All Ones (TUA1)  
0 = transmit data normally  
1 = transmit an unframed all-ones code at TPOSO and TNEGO  
Bit 6/Transmit Time Slot 16 Data Select (T16S). See Section 16.2 for details.  
0 = time slot 16 determined by the SSIEx registers and the THSCS function in the PCPR register  
1 = source time slot 16 from TS1 to TS16 registers  
Bit 7/Transmit Time Slot 0 Pass-Through (TFPT)  
0 = FAS bits/Sa bits/remote alarm sourced internally from the TAF and TNAF registers  
1 = FAS bits/Sa bits/remote alarm sourced from TSER  
57 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
E1TCR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
E1 Transmit Control Register 2  
36h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
Sa8S  
0
6
Sa7S  
0
5
Sa6S  
0
4
Sa5S  
0
3
Sa4S  
0
2
AEBE  
0
1
AAIS  
0
0
ARA  
0
Bit 0/Automatic Remote Alarm Generation (ARA)  
0 = disabled  
1 = enabled  
Bit 1/Automatic AIS Generation (AAIS)  
0 = disabled  
1 = enabled  
Bit 2/Automatic E-Bit Enable (AEBE)  
0 = E-bits not automatically set in the transmit direction  
1 = E-bits automatically set in the transmit direction  
Bit 3/Sa4 Bit Select (Sa4S). Set to 1 to source the Sa4 bit from the TLINK pin; set to 0 to not source the Sa4 bit.  
See Section 35 for details.  
Bit 4/Sa5 Bit Select (Sa5S). Set to 1 to source the Sa5 bit from the TLINK pin; set to 0 to not source the Sa5 bit.  
See Section 35 for details.  
Bit 5/Sa6 Bit Select (Sa6S). Set to 1 to source the Sa6 bit from the TLINK pin; set to 0 to not source the Sa6 bit.  
See Section 35 for details.  
Bit 6/Sa7 Bit Select (Sa7S). Set to 1 to source the Sa7 bit from the TLINK pin; set to 0 to not source the Sa7 bit.  
See Section 35 for details.  
Bit 7/Sa8 Bit Select (Sa8S). Set to 1 to source the Sa8 bit from the TLINK pin; set to 0 to not source the Sa8 bit.  
See Section 35 for details.  
58 of 238  
DS2155  
10.2Automatic Alarm Generation  
The device can be programmed to automatically transmit AIS or remote alarm. When automatic AIS  
generation is enabled (E1TCR2.1 = 1), the device monitors the receive-side framer to determine if any of  
the following conditions are present: loss-of-receive frame synchronization, AIS alarm (all ones)  
reception, or loss-of-receive carrier (or signal). The framer forces either an AIS or remote alarm if any  
one or more of these conditions is present.  
When automatic RAI generation is enabled (E1TCR2.0 = 1), the framer monitors the receive side to  
determine if any of the following conditions are present: loss-of-receive-frame synchronization, AIS  
alarm (all ones) reception, loss-of-receive carrier (or signal), or if CRC4 multiframe synchronization  
cannot be found within 128ms of FAS synchronization (if CRC4 is enabled). If any one or more of these  
conditions is present, then the framer transmits an RAI alarm. RAI generation conforms to ETS 300 011  
specifications and a constant remote alarm is transmitted if the DS2155 cannot find CRC4 multiframe  
synchronization within 400ms as per G.706.  
Note: It is an invalid state to have both automatic AIS generation and automatic remote alarm generation  
enabled at the same time.  
59 of 238  
DS2155  
10.3E1 Information Registers  
Register Name:  
INFO3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Information Register 3  
12h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
1
0
CRCRC FASRC CASRC  
0
0
0
Bit 0/CAS Resync Criteria Met Event (CASRC). Set when two consecutive CAS MF alignment words are  
received in error.  
Bit 1/FAS Resync Criteria Met Event (FASRC). Set when three consecutive FAS words are received in error.  
Note: During a CRC resync the FAS synchronizer is brought online to verify the FAS alignment. If during this  
process an FAS emulator exists, the FAS synchronizer may temporarily align to the emulator. The FASRC will go  
active indicating a search for a valid FAS has been activated.  
Bit 2/CRC Resync Criteria Met Event (CRCRC). Set when 915/1000 codewords are received in error.  
Register Name:  
INFO7  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Information Register 7 (Real-Time, Non-Latched Register)  
30h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CSC5  
0
6
CSC4  
0
5
CSC3  
0
4
CSC2  
0
3
CSC0  
0
2
1
0
FASSA CASSA CRC4SA  
0
0
0
Bit 0/CRC4 MF Sync Active (CRC4SA). Set while the synchronizer is searching for the CRC4 MF alignment  
word. This is a read-only, non-latched, real-time bit. It is not necessary to precede the read of this bit with a write.  
Bit 1/CAS MF Sync Active (CASSA). Set while the synchronizer is searching for the CAS MF alignment word.  
This is a read-only, non-latched, real-time bit. It is not necessary to precede the read of this bit with a write.  
Bit 2/FAS Sync Active (FASSA). Set while the synchronizer is searching for alignment at the FAS level. This is a  
read-only, non-latched, real-time bit. It is not necessary to precede the read of this bit with a write.  
Bits 3 to 7/CRC4 Sync Counter Bits (CSC0, CSC2 to CSC4). The CRC4 sync counter increments each time the  
8ms CRC4 multiframe search times out. The counter is cleared when the framer has successfully obtained  
synchronization at the CRC4 level. The counter can also be cleared by disabling the CRC4 mode (E1RCR1.3 = 0).  
This counter is useful for determining the amount of time the framer has been searching for synchronization at the  
CRC4 level. ITU G.706 suggests that if synchronization at the CRC4 level cannot be obtained within 400ms, then  
the search should be abandoned and proper action taken. The CRC4 sync counter rolls over. CSC0 is the LSB of  
the 6-bit counter. (Note: The bit next to LSB is not accessible. CSC1 is omitted to allow resolution to >400ms  
using 5 bits.) These are read-only, non-latched, real-time bits. It is not necessary to precede the read of these bits  
with a write.  
60 of 238  
DS2155  
Table 10-B. E1 Alarm Criteria  
ITU  
ALARM  
SET CRITERIA  
CLEAR CRITERIA  
SPECIFICATION  
An RLOS condition exists on power-up  
prior to initial synchronization, when a  
resync criteria has been met, or when a  
manual resync has been initiated by  
E1RCR1.0  
RLOS  
RCL  
255 or 2048 consecutive 0s received as  
determined by E1RCR2.0  
At least 32 1s in 255-bit times  
are received  
G.775/G.962  
Bit 3 of nonalign frame set to  
0 for three consecutive  
occasions  
Bit 3 of nonalign frame set to 1 for three  
consecutive occasions  
O.162  
2.1.4  
RRA  
Fewer than three 0s in two frames (512  
bits)  
Bit 6 of time slot 16 in frame 0 has been set  
for two consecutive multiframes  
More than two 0s in two  
frames (512 bits)  
O.162  
RUA1  
1.6.1.2  
RDMA  
V52LNK Two out of three Sa7 bits are 0  
G.965  
61 of 238  
DS2155  
11. COMMON CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS  
Register Name:  
CCR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Common Control Register 1  
70h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
SIE  
0
4
ODM  
0
3
DICAI  
0
2
TCSS1  
0
1
TCSS0  
0
0
RLOSF  
0
MCLKS CRC4R  
0
0
Bit 0/Function of the RLOS/LOTC Output (RLOSF)  
0 = receive loss of sync (RLOS)  
1 = loss-of-transmit clock (LOTC)  
Bit 1/Transmit Clock Source Select Bit 0 (TCSS0)  
Bit 2/Transmit Clock Source Select Bit 0 (TCSS1)  
TCSS1  
TCSS0  
Transmit Clock Source  
0
0
The TCLK pin is always the source of transmit clock.  
Switch to the clock present at RCLK when the signal at the TCLK pin  
0
1
1
1
0
1
fails to transition after 1 channel time.  
Use the scaled signal present at MCLK as the transmit clock. The  
TCLK pin is ignored.  
Use the signal present at RCLK as the transmit clock. The TCLK pin is  
ignored.  
Bit 3/Disable Idle Code Auto Increment (DICAI). Selects/deselects the auto-increment feature for the transmit  
and receive idle code array address register. See Section 17.  
0 = addresses in IAAR register automatically increment on every read/write operation to the PCICR  
register  
1 = addresses in IAAR register do not automatically increment  
Bit 4/Output Data Mode (ODM)  
0 = pulses at TPOSO and TNEGO are one full TCLKO period wide  
1 = pulses at TPOSO and TNEGO are one-half TCLKO period wide  
Bit 5/Signaling Integration Enable (SIE)  
0 = signaling changes of state reported on any change in selected channels  
1 = signaling must be stable for three multiframes in order for a change of state to be reported  
Bit 6/CRC-4 Recalculate (CRC4R)  
0 = transmit CRC-4 generation and insertion operates in normal mode  
1 = transmit CRC-4 generation operates according to G.706 intermediate path recalculation method  
Bit 7/MCLK Source (MCLKS). Selects the source of MCLK  
0 = MCLK is source from the MCLK pin  
1 = MCLK is source from the TSYSCLK pin  
62 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
IDR  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Device Identification Register  
0Fh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
ID7  
1
6
ID6  
0
5
ID5  
1
4
ID4  
1
3
ID3  
X
2
ID2  
X
1
ID1  
X
0
ID0  
X
Bits 0 to 3/Chip Revision Bits (ID0 to ID3). The lower four bits of the IDR are used to display the die revision of  
the chip. IDO is the LSB of a decimal code that represents the chip revision.  
Bits 4 to 7/Device ID (ID4 to ID7). The upper four bits of the IDR are used to display the DS2155 ID.  
11.1T1/E1 Status Registers  
Register Name:  
SR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Status Register 2  
18h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
RUA1  
0
1
FRCL  
0
0
RLOS  
0
RYELC RUA1C FRCLC RLOSC RYEL  
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Loss-of-Sync Condition (RLOS). Set when the DS2155 is not synchronized to the received data  
stream.  
Bit 1/Framer Receive Carrier-Loss Condition (FRCL). Set when 255 (or 2048 if E1RCR2.0 = 1) E1 mode or  
192 T1 mode consecutive 0s have been detected at RPOSI and RNEGI.  
Bit 2/Receive Unframed All-Ones (T1 Blue Alarm, E1 AIS) Condition (RUA1). Set when an unframed all 1s  
code is received at RPOSI and RNEGI.  
Bit 3/Receive Yellow Alarm Condition (RYEL) (T1 Only). Set when a Yellow Alarm is received at RPOSI and  
RNEGI.  
Bit 4/Receive Loss-of-Sync Clear Event (RLOSC). Set when the framer achieves synchronization; remains set  
until read.  
Bit 5/Framer Receive Carrier-Loss Clear Event (FRCLC). Set when the carrier loss condition at RPOSI and  
RNEGI is no longer detected.  
Bit 6/Receive Unframed All-Ones Clear Event (RUA1C). Set when the unframed all 1s condition is no longer  
detected.  
Bit 7/Receive Yellow Alarm Clear Event (RYELC) (T1 Only). Set when the receive Yellow Alarm condition is  
no longer detected.  
63 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
IMR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Interrupt Mask Register 2  
19h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
RYEL  
0
2
RUA1  
0
1
FRCL  
0
0
RLOS  
0
RYELC RUA1C FRCLC RLOSC  
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Loss-of-Sync Condition (RLOS)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only  
Bit 1/Framer Receive Carrier Loss Condition (FRCL)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only  
Bit 2/Receive Unframed All-Ones (Blue Alarm) Condition (RUA1)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only  
Bit 3/Receive Yellow Alarm Condition (RYEL)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only  
Bit 4/Receive Loss-of-Sync Clear Event (RLOSC)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 5/Framer Receive Carrier Loss Condition Clear (FRCLC)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 6/Receive Unframed All-Ones Condition Clear Event (RUA1C)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 7/Receive Yellow Alarm Clear Event (RYELC)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
64 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
SR3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Status Register 3  
1Ah  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
LSPARE  
0
6
LDN  
0
5
LUP  
0
4
LOTC  
0
3
LORC  
0
2
1
0
RRA  
0
V52LNK RDMA  
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Remote Alarm Condition (RRA) (E1 Only). Set when a remote alarm is received at RPOSI and  
RNEGI. This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.  
Bit 1/Receive Distant MF Alarm Condition (RDMA) (E1 Only). Set when bit 6 of time slot 16 in frame 0 has  
been set for two consecutive multiframes. This alarm is not disabled in the CCS signaling mode. This is a double  
interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.  
Bit 2/V5.2 Link Detected Condition (V52LNK) (E1 Only). Set on detection of a V5.2 link identification signal  
(G.965). This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.  
Bit 3/Loss-of-Receive Clock Condition (LORC). Set when the RCLKI pin has not transitioned for one channel  
time. This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.  
Bit 4/Loss-of-Transmit Clock Condition (LOTC). Set when the TCLK pin has not transitioned for one channel  
time. Forces the LOTC pin high if enabled by CCR1.0. This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.  
Bit 5/Loop-Up Code Detected Condition (LUP) (T1 Only). Set when the loop-up code as defined in the  
RUPCD1/2 register is being received. See Section 25 for details. This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.  
Bit 6/Loop-Down Code Detected Condition (LDN) (T1 Only). Set when the loop down code as defined in the  
RDNCD1/2 register is being received. See Section 25 for details. This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.  
Bit 7/Spare Code Detected Condition (LSPARE) (T1 Only). Set when the spare code as defined in the RSCD1/2  
registers is being received. See Section 25 for details. This is a double interrupt bit. See Section 6.3.  
65 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
IMR3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Interrupt Mask Register 3  
1Bh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
LSPARE  
0
6
LDN  
0
5
LUP  
0
4
LOTC  
0
3
LORC  
0
2
1
0
RRA  
0
V52LNK RDMA  
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Remote Alarm Condition (RRA)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 1/Receive Distant MF Alarm Condition (RDMA)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 2/V5.2 Link Detected Condition (V52LNK)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 3/Loss-of-Receive Clock Condition (LORC)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 4/Loss-of-Transmit Clock Condition (LOTC)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 5/Loop-Up Code-Detected Condition (LUP)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 6/Loop-Down Code-Detected Condition (LDN)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 7/Spare Code Detected Condition (LSPARE)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges  
66 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
SR4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Status Register 4  
1Ch  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
RSAZ  
0
4
TMF  
0
3
TAF  
0
2
RMF  
0
1
RCMF  
0
0
RAF  
0
RAIS-CI RSAO  
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Align Frame Event (RAF) (E1 Only). Set every 250µs at the beginning of align frames. Used to  
alert the host that Si and Sa bits are available in the RAF and RNAF registers.  
Bit 1/Receive CRC4 Multiframe Event (RCMF) (E1 Only). Set on CRC4 multiframe boundaries; continues to  
set every 2ms on an arbitrary boundary if CRC4 is disabled.  
Bit 2/Receive Multiframe Event (RMF)  
E1 Mode: Set every 2ms (regardless if CAS signaling is enabled or not) on receive multiframe boundaries.  
Used to alert the host that signaling data is available.  
T1 Mode: Set every 1.5ms on D4 MF boundaries or every 3ms on ESF MF boundaries.  
Bit 3/Transmit Align Frame Event (TAF) (E1 Only). Set every 250µs at the beginning of align frames. Used to  
alert the host that the TAF and TNAF registers need to be updated.  
Bit 4/Transmit Multiframe Event (TMF)  
E1 Mode: Set every 2ms (regardless if CRC4 is enabled) on transmit multiframe boundaries. Used to alert  
the host that signaling data needs to be updated.  
T1 Mode: Set every 1.5ms on D4 MF boundaries or every 3ms on ESF MF boundaries.  
Bit 5/Receive Signaling All-Zeros Event (RSAZ) (E1 Only). Set when over a full MF, time slot 16 contains  
all 0s.  
Bit 6/Receive Signaling All-Ones Event (RSAO) (E1 Only). Set when the contents of time slot 16 contains fewer  
than three 0s over 16 consecutive frames. This alarm is not disabled in the CCS signaling mode.  
Bit 7/Receive AIS-CI Event (RAIS-CI) (T1 Only). Set when the receiver detects the AIS-CI pattern as defined in  
ANSI T1.403.  
67 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
IMR4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Interrupt Mask Register 4  
1Dh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
RSAZ  
0
4
TMF  
0
3
TAF  
0
2
RMF  
0
1
RCMF  
0
0
RAF  
0
RAIS-CI RSAO  
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Align Frame Event (RAF)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 1/Receive CRC4 Multiframe Event (RCMF)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 2/Receive Multiframe Event (RMF)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 3/Transmit Align Frame Event (TAF)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 4/Transmit Multiframe Event (TMF)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 5/Receive Signaling All-Zeros Event (RSAZ)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 6/Receive Signaling All-Ones Event (RSAO)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 7/Receive AIS-CI Event (RAIS-CI)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
68 of 238  
DS2155  
12. I/O PIN CONFIGURATION OPTIONS  
Register Name:  
IOCR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
I/O Configuration Register 1  
01h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
RSMS  
0
6
5
4
RSIO  
0
3
TSDW  
0
2
TSM  
0
1
TSIO  
0
0
ODF  
0
RSMS2 RSMS1  
0
0
Bit 0/Output Data Format (ODF)  
0 = bipolar data at TPOSO and TNEGO  
1 = NRZ data at TPOSO; TNEGO = 0  
Bit 1/TSYNC I/O Select (TSIO)  
0 = TSYNC is an input  
1 = TSYNC is an output  
Bit 2/TSYNC Mode Select (TSM). Selects frame or multiframe mode for the TSYNC pin. See the timing  
diagrams in Section 35.  
0 = frame mode  
1 = multiframe mode  
Bit 3/TSYNC Double-Wide (TSDW). (Note: This bit must be set to 0 when IOCR1.2 = 1 or when IOCR1.1 = 0.)  
0 = do not pulse double-wide in signaling frames  
1 = do pulse double-wide in signaling frames  
Bit 4/RSYNC I/O Select (RSIO). (Note: This bit must be set to 0 when ESCR.0 = 0.)  
0 = RSYNC is an output  
1 = RSYNC is an input (only valid if elastic store enabled)  
Bit 5/RSYNC Mode Select 1(RSMS1). Selects frame or multiframe pulse when RSYNC pin is in output mode. In  
input mode (elastic store must be enabled), multiframe mode is only useful when receive signaling reinsertion is  
enabled. See the timing diagrams in Section 35.  
0 = frame mode  
1 = multiframe mode  
Bit 6/RSYNC Mode Select 2 (RSMS2)  
T1 Mode: RSYNC pin must be programmed in the output frame mode (IOCR1.5 = 0, IOCR1.4 = 0).  
0 = do not pulse double-wide in signaling frames  
1 = do pulse double-wide in signaling frames  
E1 Mode: RSYNC pin must be programmed in the output multiframe mode (IOCR1.5 = 1, IOCR1.4 = 0).  
0 = RSYNC outputs CAS multiframe boundaries  
1 = RSYNC outputs CRC4 multiframe boundaries  
Bit 7/RSYNC Multiframe Skip Control (RSMS). Useful in framing format conversions from D4 to ESF. This  
function is not available when the receive-side elastic store is enabled. RSYNC must be set to output multiframe  
pulses (IOCR1.5 = 1 and IOCR1.4 = 0).  
0 = RSYNC outputs a pulse at every multiframe  
1 = RSYNC outputs a pulse at every other multiframe  
69 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
IOCR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
I/O Configuration Register 2  
02h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RCLKINV TCLKINV RSYNCINV TSYNCINV TSSYNCINV H100EN TSCLKM RSCLKM  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/RSYSCLK Mode Select (RSCLKM)  
0 = if RSYSCLK is 1.544MHz  
1 = if RSYSCLK is 2.048MHz or IBO enabled (See Section 28 for details on IBO function.)  
Bit 1/TSYSCLK Mode Select (TSCLKM)  
0 = if TSYSCLK is 1.544MHz  
1 = if TSYSCLK is 2.048MHz or IBO enabled (See Section 28 for details on IBO function.)  
Bit 2/H.100 SYNC Mode (H100EN)  
0 = normal operation  
1 = SYNC shift  
Bit 3/TSSYNC Invert (TSSYNCINV)  
0 = no inversion  
1 = invert  
Bit 4/TSYNC Invert (TSYNCINV)  
0 = no inversion  
1 = invert  
Bit 5/RSYNC Invert (RSYNCINV)  
0 = no inversion  
1 = invert  
Bit 6/TCLK Invert (TCLKINV)  
0 = no inversion  
1 = invert  
Bit 7/RCLK Invert (RCLKINV)  
0 = no inversion  
1 = invert  
70 of 238  
DS2155  
13. LOOPBACK CONFIGURATION  
Register Name:  
LBCR  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Loopback Control Register  
4Ah  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
LIUC  
0
3
LLB  
0
2
RLB  
0
1
PLB  
0
0
FLB  
0
Bit 0/Framer Loopback (FLB). This loopback is useful in testing and debugging applications. In FLB, the  
DS2155 loops data from the transmit side back to the receive side. When FLB is enabled, the following occurs:  
1) T1 Mode: An unframed all-ones code is transmitted at TPOSO and TNEGO.  
E1 Mode: Normal data is transmitted at TPOSO and TNEGO.  
2) Data at RPOSI and RNEGI is ignored.  
3) All receive-side signals take on timing synchronous with TCLK instead of RCLKI.  
Please note that it is not acceptable to have RCLK connected to TCLK during this loopback because this  
causes an unstable condition.  
0 = loopback disabled  
1 = loopback enabled  
Bit 1/Payload Loopback (PLB). When PLB is enabled, the following occurs:  
1) Data is transmitted from the TPOSO and TNEGO pins synchronous with RCLK instead of TCLK.  
2) All the receive side signals continue to operate normally.  
3) Data at the TSER, TDATA, and TSIG pins is ignored.  
4) The TLCLK signal becomes synchronous with RCLK instead of TCLK.  
0 = loopback disabled  
1 = loopback enabled  
T1 Mode. Normally, this loopback is only enabled when ESF framing is being performed but can also be  
enabled in D4 framing applications. In a PLB situation, the DS2155 loops the 192 bits of payload data  
(with BPVs corrected) from the receive section back to the transmit section. The FPS framing pattern,  
CRC6 calculation, and the FDL bits are not looped back; they are reinserted by the DS2155.  
E1 Mode. In a PLB situation, the DS2155 loops the 248 bits of payload data (with BPVs corrected) from  
the receive section back to the transmit section. The transmit section modifies the payload as if it was input  
at TSER. The FAS word; Si, Sa, and E bits; and CRC4 are not looped back; they are reinserted by the  
DS2155.  
Bit 2/Remote Loopback (RLB). In this loopback, data input by the RPOSI and RNEGI pins is transmitted back to  
the TPOSO and TNEGO pins. Data continues to pass through the receive-side framer of the DS2155 as it would  
normally. Data from the transmit-side formatter is ignored. See Figure 3-1 for more details.  
0 = loopback disabled  
1 = loopback enabled  
71 of 238  
DS2155  
Bit 3/Local Loopback (LLB). In this loopback, data continues to be transmitted as normal through the transmit  
side of the SCT. Data being received at RTIP and RRING are replaced with the data being transmitted. Data in this  
loopback passes through the jitter attenuator. See Figure 3-2 for more details.  
0 = loopback disabled  
1 = loopback enabled  
Bit 4/Line Interface Unit Mux Control (LIUC). This is a software version of the LIUC pin. When the LIUC pin  
is connected high, the LIUC bit has control. When the LIUC pin is connected low, the framer and LIU are  
separated and the LIUC bit has no effect  
0 = if LIUC pin connected high, LIU internally connected to framer block and deactivate the  
TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins  
1 = if LIUC pin connected high, disconnect LIU from framer block and activate the  
TPOSI/TNEGI/TCLKI/RPOSI/RNEGI/RCLKI pins  
LIUC Pin  
LIUC Bit  
Condition  
0
0
1
0
1
0
LIU and framer separated  
LIU and framer separated  
LIU and framer connected  
LIU and framer separated  
1
1
Bits 5 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
72 of 238  
DS2155  
13.1Per-Channel Loopback  
The per-channel loopback registers (PCLRs) determine which channels (if any) from the backplane  
should be replaced with the data from the receive side or, i.e., off of the T1 or E1 line. If this loopback is  
enabled, then transmit and receive clocks and frame syncs must be synchronized. One method to  
accomplish this is to connect RCLK to TCLK and RFSYNC to TSYNC. There are no restrictions on  
which channels can be looped back or on how many channels can be looped back.  
Each of the bit positions in the per-channel loopback registers (PCLR1/PCLR2/PCLR3/PCLR4)  
represents a DS0 channel in the outgoing frame. When these bits are set to a 1, data from the  
corresponding receive channel replaces the data on TSER for that channel.  
Register Name:  
PCLR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 1  
4Bh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH8  
0
6
CH7  
0
5
CH6  
0
4
CH5  
0
3
CH4  
0
2
CH3  
0
1
CH2  
0
0
CH1  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Loopback Enable for Channels 1 to 8 (CH1 to CH8)  
0 = loopback disabled  
1 = enable loopback; source data from the corresponding receive channel  
Register Name:  
PCLR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 2  
4Ch  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH16  
0
6
CH15  
0
5
CH14  
0
4
CH13  
0
3
CH12  
0
2
CH11  
0
1
CH10  
0
0
CH9  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Loopback Enable for Channels 9 to 16 (CH9 to CH16)  
0 = loopback disabled  
1 = enable loopback; source data from the corresponding receive channel  
73 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
PCLR3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 3  
4Dh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH24  
0
6
CH23  
0
5
CH22  
0
4
CH21  
0
3
CH20  
0
2
CH19  
0
1
CH18  
0
0
CH17  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Loopback Enable for Channels 17 to 24 (CH17 to CH24)  
0 = loopback disabled  
1 = enable loopback; source data from the corresponding receive channel  
Register Name:  
PCLR4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 4  
4Eh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH32  
0
6
CH31  
0
5
CH30  
0
4
CH29  
0
3
CH28  
0
2
CH27  
0
1
CH26  
0
0
CH25  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Loopback Enable for Channels 25 to 32 (CH25 to CH32)  
0 = loopback disabled  
1 = enable loopback; source data from the corresponding receive channel  
74 of 238  
DS2155  
14. ERROR COUNT REGISTERS  
The DS2155 contains four counters that are used to accumulate line-coding errors, path errors, and  
synchronization errors. Counter update options include one-second boundaries, 42ms (T1 mode only),  
62ms (E1 mode only), or manual. See Error-Counter Configuration Register (ERCNT). When updated  
automatically, the user can use the interrupt from the timer to determine when to read these registers. All  
four counters saturate at their respective maximum counts, and they do not roll over. Note: Only the line-  
code violation count register has the potential to overflow, but the bit error would have to exceed 10E-2  
before this would occur.  
Register Name:  
ERCNT  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Error-Counter Configuration Register  
41h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
MECU  
0
5
ECUS  
0
4
EAMS  
0
3
VCRFS  
0
2
FSBE  
0
1
0
MOSCRF LCVCRF  
0
0
Bit 0/T1 Line-Code Violation Count Register Function Select (LCVCRF)  
0 = do not count excessive 0s  
1 = count excessive 0s  
Bit 1/Multiframe Out-of-Sync Count Register Function Select (MOSCRF)  
0 = count errors in the framing bit position  
1 = count the number of multiframes out-of-sync  
Bit 2/PCVCR Fs-Bit Error-Report Enable (FSBE)  
0 = do not report bit errors in Fs-bit position; only Ft-bit position  
1 = report bit errors in Fs-bit position as well as Ft-bit position  
Bit 3/E1 Line-Code Violation Count Register Function Select (VCRFS)  
0 = count bipolar violations (BPVs)  
1 = count code violations (CVs)  
Bit 4/Error-Accumulation Mode Select (EAMS)  
0 = ERCNT.5 determines accumulation time  
1 = ERCNT.6 determines accumulation time  
Bit 5/Error-Counter Update Select (ECUS)  
T1 Mode:  
0 = update error counters once a second  
1 = update error counters every 42ms (333 frames)  
E1 Mode:  
0 = update error counters once a second  
1 = update error counters every 62.5ms (500 frames)  
Bit 6/Manual Error-Counter Update (MECU). When enabled by ERCNT.4, the changing of this bit from a 0 to  
a 1 allows the next clock cycle to load the error-counter registers with the latest counts and reset the counters. The  
user must wait a minimum of 1.5 RCLK clock periods before reading the error count registers to allow for proper  
update.  
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
75 of 238  
DS2155  
14.1Line-Code Violation Count Register (LCVCR)  
14.1.1 T1 Operation  
T1 code violations are defined as bipolar violations (BPVs) or excessive 0s. If the B8ZS mode is set for  
the receive side, then B8ZS codewords are not counted. This counter is always enabled; it is not disabled  
during receive loss-of-synchronization (RLOS = 1) conditions. Table 14-A shows what the LCVCRs  
count.  
Table 14-A. T1 Line Code Violation Counting Options  
COUNT EXCESSIVE  
B8ZS ENABLED?  
ZEROS?  
(ERCNT.0)  
No  
COUNTED IN THE LCVCRs  
(T1RCR2.5)  
No  
No  
BPVs  
Yes  
No  
BPVs + 16 consecutive 0s  
Yes  
Yes  
BPVs (B8ZS codewords not counted)  
BPVs + 8 consecutive 0s  
Yes  
14.1.2 E1 Operation  
Either bipolar violations or code violations can be counted. Bipolar violations are defined as consecutive  
marks of the same polarity. In this mode, if the HDB3 mode is set for the receive side, then HDB3  
codewords are not counted as BPVs. If ERCNT.3 is set, then the LVC counts code violations as defined  
in ITU O.161. Code violations are defined as consecutive bipolar violations of the same polarity. In most  
applications, the framer should be programmed to count BPVs when receiving AMI code and to count  
CVs when receiving HDB3 code. This counter increments at all times and is not disabled by loss-of-sync  
conditions. The counter saturates at 65,535 and does not roll over. The bit-error rate on an E1 line would  
have to be greater than 10-2 before the VCR would saturate (Table 14-B).  
Table 14-B. E1 Line-Code Violation Counting Options  
E1 CODE VIOLATION SELECT  
COUNTED IN THE LCVCRs  
(ERCNT.3)  
0
1
BPVs  
CVs  
76 of 238  
 
 
DS2155  
Register Name:  
LCVCR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Line-Code Violation Count Register 1  
42h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
LCVC15 LCVC14 LCVC13 LCVC12 LCVC11 LCVC10 LCVC9 LCCV8  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Line-Code Violation Counter Bits 8 to 15 (LCVC8 to LCVC15). LCV15 is the MSB of the 16-bit  
code violation count.  
Register Name:  
LCVCR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Line-Code Violation Count Register 2  
43h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
LCVC0  
0
LCVC7 LCVC6 LCVC5 LCVC4 LCVC3 LCVC2 LCVC1  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Line-Code Violation Counter Bits 0 to 7 (LCVC0 to LCVC7). LCV0 is the LSB of the 16-bit code  
violation count.  
77 of 238  
DS2155  
14.2Path Code Violation Count Register (PCVCR)  
14.2.1 T1 Operation  
The path code violation count register records Ft, Fs, or CRC6 errors in T1 frames. When the receive side  
of a framer is set to operate in the T1 ESF framing mode, PCVCR records errors in the CRC6 codewords.  
When set to operate in the T1 D4 framing mode, PCVCR counts errors in the Ft framing bit position.  
Through the ERCNT.2 bit, a framer can be programmed to also report errors in the Fs framing bit  
position. The PCVCR is disabled during receive loss-of-synchronization (RLOS = 1) conditions.  
Table 14-C shows what errors the PCVCR counts.  
Table 14-C. T1 Path Code Violation Counting Arrangements  
COUNTED  
FRAMING MODE  
COUNT Fs ERRORS?  
IN THE PCVCRs  
D4  
D4  
ESF  
No  
Yes  
Don’t Care  
Errors in the Ft pattern  
Errors in both the Ft and Fs patterns  
Errors in the CRC6 codewords  
14.2.2 E1 Operation  
The path code violation-count register records CRC4 errors. Since the maximum CRC4 count in a one-  
second period is 1000, this counter cannot saturate. The counter is disabled during loss-of-sync at either  
the FAS or CRC4 level; it continues to count if loss-of-multiframe sync occurs at the CAS level.  
Path code violation-count register 1 (PCVCR1) is the most significant word and PCVCR2 is the least  
significant word of a 16-bit counter that records path violations (PVs).  
Register Name:  
PCVCR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Path Code Violation Count Register 1  
44h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PCVC15 PCVC14 PCVC13 PCVC12 PCVC11 PCVC10 PCVC9 PCVC8  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Path Code Violation Counter Bits 8 to 15 (PCVC8 to PCVC15). PCVC15 is the MSB of the 16-bit  
path code violation count.  
Register Name:  
PCVCR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Path Code Violation Count Register 2  
45h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PCVC0  
0
PCVC7 PCVC6 PCVC5 PCVC4 PCVC3 PCVC2 PCVC1  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Path Code Violation Counter Bits 0 to 7 (PCVC0 to PCVC7). PCVC0 is the LSB of the 16-bit path  
code violation count.  
78 of 238  
 
DS2155  
14.3Frames Out-of-Sync Count Register (FOSCR)  
14.3.1 T1 Operation  
The FOSCR is used to count the number of multiframes that the receive synchronizer is out of sync. This  
number is useful in ESF applications needing to measure the parameters loss-of-frame count (LOFC) and  
ESF error events as described in AT&T publication TR54016. When the FOSCR is operated in this  
mode, it is not disabled during receive loss-of-synchronization (RLOS = 1) conditions. The FOSCR has  
an alternate operating mode whereby it counts either errors in the Ft framing pattern (in the D4 mode) or  
errors in the FPS framing pattern (in the ESF mode). When the FOSCR is operated in this mode, it is  
disabled during receive loss-of-synchronization (RLOS = 1) conditions. Table 14-D shows what the  
FOSCR is capable of counting.  
Table 14-D. T1 Frames Out-of-Sync Counting Arrangements  
COUNT MOS OR  
FRAMING MODE  
F-BIT ERRORS  
(ERCNT.1)  
MOS  
COUNTED IN THE FOSCRs  
(T1RCR1.3)  
D4  
D4  
Number of multiframes out-of-sync  
Errors in the Ft pattern  
Number of multiframes out-of-sync  
Errors in the FPS pattern  
F-Bit  
MOS  
ESF  
ESF  
F-Bit  
14.3.2 E1 Operation  
The FOSCR counts word errors in the FAS in time slot 0. This counter is disabled when RLOS is high.  
FAS errors are not counted when the framer is searching for FAS alignment and/or synchronization at  
either the CAS or CRC4 multiframe level. Since the maximum FAS word error count in a one-second  
period is 4000, this counter cannot saturate.  
The frames out-of-sync count register 1 (FOSCR1) is the most significant word and FOSCR2 is the least  
significant word of a 16-bit counter that records frames out-of-sync.  
Register Name:  
FOSCR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Frames Out-of-Sync Count Register 1  
46h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
FOS15  
0
6
FOS14  
0
5
FOS13  
0
4
FOS12  
0
3
2
1
FOS9  
0
0
FOS8  
0
FOS11 FOS10  
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Frames Out-of-Sync Counter Bits 8 to 15 (FOS8 to FOS15). FOS15 is the MSB of the 16-bit frames  
out-of-sync count.  
Register Name:  
FOSCR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Frames Out-of-Sync Count Register 2  
47h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
FOS7  
0
6
FOS6  
0
5
FOS5  
0
4
FOS4  
0
3
FOS3  
0
2
FOS2  
0
1
FOS1  
0
0
FOS0  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Frames Out-of-Sync Counter Bits 0 to 7 (FOS0 to FOS7). FOS0 is the LSB of the 16-bit frames out-  
of-sync count.  
79 of 238  
 
DS2155  
14.4E-Bit Counter (EBCR)  
This counter is only available in E1 mode. E-bit count register 1 (EBCR1) is the most significant word  
and EBCR2 is the least significant word of a 16-bit counter that records far-end block errors (FEBE) as  
reported in the first bit of frames 13 and 15 on E1 lines running with CRC4 multiframe. These count  
registers increment once each time the received E-bit is set to 0. Since the maximum E-bit count in a one-  
second period is 1000, this counter cannot saturate. The counter is disabled during loss-of-sync at either  
the FAS or CRC4 level; it continues to count if loss-of-multiframe sync occurs at the CAS level.  
Register Name:  
EBCR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
E-Bit Count Register 1  
48h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
EB15  
0
6
EB14  
0
5
EB13  
0
4
EB12  
0
3
EB11  
0
2
EB10  
0
1
EB9  
0
0
EB8  
0
Bits 0 to 7/E-Bit Counter Bits 8 to 15 (EB8 to EB15). EB15 is the MSB of the 16-bit E-bit count.  
Register Name:  
EBCR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
E-Bit Count Register 2  
49h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
EB7  
0
6
EB6  
0
5
EB5  
0
4
EB4  
0
3
EB3  
0
2
EB2  
0
1
EB1  
0
0
EB0  
0
Bits 0 to 7/E-Bit Counter Bits 0 to 7 (EB0 to EB7). EB0 is the LSB of the 16-bit E-bit count.  
80 of 238  
DS2155  
15. DS0 MONITORING FUNCTION  
The DS2155 has the ability to monitor one DS0 64kbps channel in the transmit direction and one DS0  
channel in the receive direction at the same time. In the transmit direction, the user determines which  
channel is to be monitored by properly setting the TCM0 to TCM4 bits in the TDS0SEL register. In the  
receive direction, the RCM0 to RCM4 bits in the RDS0SEL register need to be properly set. The DS0  
channel pointed to by the TCM0 to TCM4 bits appear in the transmit DS0 monitor (TDS0M) register.  
The DS0 channel pointed to by the RCM0 to RCM4 bits appear in the receive DS0 (RDS0M) register.  
The TCM4 to TCM0 and RCM4 to RCM0 bits should be programmed with the decimal decode of the  
appropriate T1or E1 channel. T1 channels 1 through 24 map to register values 0 through 23. E1 channels  
1 through 32 map to register values 0 through 31. For example, if DS0 channel 6 in the transmit direction  
and DS0 channel 15 in the receive direction needed to be monitored, then the following values would be  
programmed into TDS0SEL and RDS0SEL:  
TCM4 = 0  
TCM3 = 0  
TCM2 = 1  
TCM1 = 0  
TCM0 = 1  
RCM4 = 0  
RCM3 = 1  
RCM2 = 1  
RCM1 = 1  
RCM0 = 0  
Register Name:  
TDS0SEL  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Channel Monitor Select  
74h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
TCM4  
0
3
TCM3  
0
2
TCM2  
0
1
TCM1  
0
0
TCM0  
0
Bits 0 to 4/Transmit Channel Monitor Bits (TCM0 to TCM4). TCM0 is the LSB of a 5-bit channel select that  
determines which transmit channel data appear in the TDS0M register.  
Bits 5 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
Register Name:  
TDS0M  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit DS0 Monitor Register  
75h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
B1  
0
6
B2  
0
5
B3  
0
4
B4  
0
3
B5  
0
2
B6  
0
1
B7  
0
0
B8  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit DS0 Channel Bits (B1 to B8). Transmit channel data that has been selected by the transmit  
channel monitor select register. B8 is the LSB of the DS0 channel (last bit to be transmitted).  
81 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RDS0SEL  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Channel Monitor Select  
76h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
RCM4  
0
3
2
1
RCM1  
0
0
RCM0  
0
RCM3 RCM2  
0
0
Bits 0 to 4/Receive Channel Monitor Bits (RCM0 to RCM4). RCM0 is the LSB of a 5-bit channel select that  
determines which receive DS0 channel data appear in the RDS0M register.  
Bits 5 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
Register Name:  
RDS0M  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive DS0 Monitor Register  
77h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
B1  
0
6
B2  
0
5
B3  
0
4
B4  
0
3
B5  
0
2
B6  
0
1
B7  
0
0
B8  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive DS0 Channel Bits (B1 to B8). Receive channel data that has been selected by the receive  
channel monitor select register. B8 is the LSB of the DS0 channel (last bit to be received).  
82 of 238  
DS2155  
16. SIGNALING OPERATION  
There are two methods to access receive signaling data and provide transmit signaling data, processor-  
based (software-based) or hardware-based. Processor-based refers to access through the transmit and  
receive signaling registers RS1–RS16 and TS1–TS16. Hardware-based refers to the TSIG and RSIG pins.  
Both methods can be used simultaneously.  
16.1Receive Signaling  
Figure 16-1. Simplified Diagram of Receive Signaling Path  
PER-CHANNEL  
CONTROL  
T1/E1 DATA STREAM  
ALL-ONES  
RSER  
SIGNALING  
EXTRACTION  
RECEIVE SIGNALING  
REGISTERS  
REINSERTION  
RSYNC  
RSIG  
CONTROL  
SIGNALING  
BUFFERS  
CHANGE-OF-STATE  
INDICATION  
REGISTERS  
16.1.1 Processor-Based Signaling  
The robbed-bit signaling (T1) or TS16 CAS signaling (E1) is sampled in the receive data stream and  
copied into the receive signaling registers, RS1–RS16. In T1 mode, only RS1–RS12 are used. The  
signaling information in these registers is always updated on multiframe boundaries. This function is  
always enabled.  
16.1.1.1 Change-of-State  
To avoid constant monitoring of the receive signaling registers, the DS2155 can be programmed to alert  
the host when any specific channel or channels undergo a change of their signaling state.  
RSCSE1–RSCSE4 for E1 and RSCSE1–RSCSE3 for T1 are used to select which channels can cause a  
change-of-state indication. The change-of-state is indicated in status register 5 (SR1.5). If signaling  
integration (CCR1.5) is enabled, then the new signaling state must be constant for three multiframes  
before a change-of-state is indicated. The user can enable the INT pin to toggle low upon detection of a  
change in signaling by setting the IMR1.5 bit. The signaling integration mode is global and cannot be  
enabled on a channel-by-channel basis.  
The user can identity which channels have undergone a signaling change-of-state by reading the  
RSINFO1–RSINFO4 registers. The information from these registers inform the user which RSx register  
to read for the new signaling data. All changes are indicated in the RSINFO1–RSINFO4 registers  
regardless of the RSCSE1–RSCSE4 registers.  
83 of 238  
DS2155  
16.1.2 Hardware-Based Receive Signaling  
In hardware-based signaling the signaling data can be obtained from the RSER pin or the RSIG pin.  
RSIG is a signaling PCM stream output on a channel-by-channel basis from the signaling buffer. The  
signaling data, T1 robbed bit or E1 TS16, is still present in the original data stream at RSER. The  
signaling buffer provides signaling data to the RSIG pin and also allows signaling data to be reinserted  
into the original data stream in a different alignment that is determined by a multiframe signal from the  
RSYNC pin. In this mode, the receive elastic store can be enabled or disabled. If the receive elastic store  
is enabled, then the backplane clock (RSYSCLK) can be either 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. In the ESF  
framing mode, the ABCD signaling bits are output on RSIG in the lower nibble of each channel. The  
RSIG data is updated once a multiframe (3ms) unless a freeze is in effect. In the D4 framing mode, the  
AB signaling bits are output twice on RSIG in the lower nibble of each channel. Hence, bits 5 and 6  
contain the same data as bits 7 and 8, respectively, in each channel. The RSIG data is updated once a  
multiframe (1.5ms) unless a freeze is in effect. See the timing diagrams in Section 35 for some examples.  
16.1.2.1 Receive Signaling Reinsertion at RSER  
In this mode, the user provides a multiframe sync at the RSYNC pin and the signaling data is reinserted  
based on this alignment. In T1 mode, this results in two copies of the signaling data in the RSER data  
stream, the original signaling data and the realigned data. This is of little consequence in voice channels.  
Reinsertion can be avoided in data channels since this feature is activated on a per-channel basis. In this  
mode, the elastic store must be enabled; however, the backplane clock can be either 1.544MHz or  
2.048MHz.  
Signaling reinsertion can be enabled on a per-channel basis by setting the RSRCS bit high in the PCPR  
register. The channels that will have signaling reinserted are selected by writing to the PCDR1–PCDR3  
registers for T1 mode and PCDR1–PCDR4 registers for E1 mode. In E1 mode, the user generally selects  
all channels or none for reinsertion. In E1 mode, signaling reinsertion on all channels can be enabled with  
a single bit, SIGCR.7 (GRSRE). This bit allows the user to reinsert all signaling channels without having  
to program all channels through the per-channel function.  
16.1.2.2 Force Receive Signaling All Ones  
In T1 mode, the user can, on a per-channel basis, force the robbed-bit signaling bit positions to a 1 by  
using the per-channel register (Section 7). The user sets the BTCS bit in the PCPR register. The channels  
that will be forced to 1 are selected by writing to the PCDR1–PCDR3 registers.  
16.1.2.3 Receive Signaling Freeze  
The signaling data in the four multiframe signaling buffers is frozen in a known good state upon either a  
loss of synchronization (OOF event), carrier loss, or frame slip. This action meets the requirements of  
BellCore TR–TSY–000170 for signaling freezing. To allow this freeze action to occur, the RFE control  
bit (SIGCR.4) should be set high. The user can force a freeze by setting the RFF control bit (SIGCR.3)  
high. The RSIGF output pin provides a hardware indication that a freeze is in effect. The four-multiframe  
buffer provides a three-multiframe delay in the signaling bits provided at the RSIG pin (and at the RSER  
pin if receive signaling reinsertion is enabled). When freezing is enabled (RFE = 1), the signaling data is  
held in the last-known good state until the corrupting error condition subsides. When the error condition  
subsides, the signaling data is held in the old state for at least an additional 9ms (or 4.5ms in D4 framing  
mode) before updating with new signaling data.  
84 of 238  
 
DS2155  
Register Name:  
SIGCR  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Signaling Control Register  
40h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
GRSRE  
0
6
0
5
0
4
RFE  
0
3
RFF  
0
2
RCCS  
0
1
TCCS  
0
0
FRSAO  
0
Bit 0/Force Receive Signaling All Ones (FRSAO). In T1 mode, this bit forces all signaling data at the RSIG and  
RSER pin to all ones. This bit has no effect in E1 mode.  
0 = normal signaling data at RSIG and RSER  
1 = force signaling data at RSIG and RSER to all ones  
Bit 1/Transmit Time Slot Control for CAS Signaling (TCCS). Controls the order that signaling is transmitted  
from the transmit signaling registers. This bit should be set = 0 in T1 mode.  
0 = signaling data is CAS format  
1 = signaling data is CCS format  
Bit 2/Receive Time Slot Control for CAS Signaling (RCCS). Controls the order that signaling is placed into the  
receive signaling registers. This bit should be set = 0 in T1 mode.  
0 = signaling data is CAS format  
1 = signaling data is CCS format  
Bit 3/Receive Force Freeze (RFF). Freezes receive-side signaling at RSIG (and RSER if receive signaling  
reinsertion is enabled); overrides receive freeze enable (RFE). See Section 16.1.2.3 for details.  
0 = do not force a freeze event  
1 = force a freeze event  
Bit 4/Receive Freeze Enable (RFE). See Section 16.1.2.3 for details.  
0 = no freezing of receive signaling data occurs  
1 = allow freezing of receive signaling data at RSIG (and RSER if receive signaling reinsertion is enabled)  
Bits 5, 6/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
Bit 7/Global Receive Signaling Reinsertion Enable (GRSRE). This bit allows the user to reinsert all signaling  
channels without programming all channels through the per-channel function.  
0 = do not reinsert all signaling  
1 = reinsert all signaling  
85 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RS1 to RS12  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Signaling Registers (T1 Mode, ESF Format)  
60h to 6Bh  
(MSB)  
(LSB)  
CH2-A  
CH4-A  
CH6-A  
CH8-A  
CH2-B  
CH4-B  
CH6-B  
CH8-B  
CH2-C  
CH4-C  
CH6-C  
CH8-C  
CH2-D  
CH4-D  
CH6-D  
CH8-D  
CH1-A  
CH3-A  
CH5-A  
CH7-A  
CH1-B  
CH3-B  
CH5-B  
CH7-B  
CH9-B  
CH1-C  
CH3-C  
CH5-C  
CH7-C  
CH9-C  
CH1-D  
CH3-D  
CH5-D  
CH7-D  
CH9-D  
RS1  
RS2  
RS3  
RS4  
RS5  
CH10-A CH10-B CH10-C CH10-D CH9-A  
CH12-A CH12-B CH12-C CH12-D CH11-A CH11-B CH11-C CH11-D RS6  
CH14-A CH14-B CH14-C CH14-D CH13-A CH13-B CH13-C CH13-D RS7  
CH16-A CH16-B CH16-C CH16-D CH15-A CH15-B CH15-C CH15-D RS8  
CH18-A CH18-B CH18-C CH18-D CH17-A CH17-B CH17-C CH17-D RS9  
CH20-A CH20-B CH20-C CH20-D CH19-A CH19-B CH19-C CH19-D RS10  
CH22-A CH22-B CH22-C CH22-D CH21-A CH21-B CH21-C CH21-D RS11  
CH24-A CH24-B CH24-C CH24-D CH23-A CH23-B CH23-C CH23-D RS12  
Register Name:  
RS1 to RS12  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Signaling Registers (T1 Mode, D4 Format)  
60h to 6Bh  
(MSB)  
(LSB)  
CH1-B  
CH3-B  
CH5-B  
CH7-B  
CH9-B  
CH2-A  
CH4-A  
CH6-A  
CH8-A  
CH2-B  
CH4-B  
CH6-B  
CH8-B  
CH2-A  
CH4-A  
CH6-A  
CH8-A  
CH2-B  
CH4-B  
CH6-B  
CH8-B  
CH1-A  
CH3-A  
CH5-A  
CH7-A  
CH1-B  
CH3-B  
CH5-B  
CH7-B  
CH9-B  
CH1-A  
CH3-A  
CH5-A  
CH7-A  
CH9-A  
RS1  
RS2  
RS3  
RS4  
RS5  
CH10-A CH10-B CH10-A  
CH12-A CH12-B CH12-A  
CH14-A CH14-B CH14-A  
CH16-A CH16-B CH16-A  
CH18-A CH18-B CH18-A  
CH20-A CH20-B CH20-A  
CH22-A CH22-B CH22-A  
CH24-A CH24-B CH24-A  
CH10-B CH9-A  
CH12-B CH11-A CH11-B  
CH14-B CH13-A CH13-B  
CH16-B CH15-A CH15-B  
CH18-B CH17-A CH17-B  
CH20-B CH19-A CH19-B  
CH22-B CH21-A CH21-B  
CH24-B CH23-A CH23-B  
CH11-A CH11-B RS6  
CH13-A CH13-B RS7  
CH15-A CH15-B RS8  
CH17-A CH17-B RS9  
CH19-A CH19-B RS10  
CH21-A CH21-B RS11  
CH23-A CH23-B RS12  
Note: In D4 format, TS1–TS12 contain signaling data for two frames. Bold type indicates data for second frame.  
86 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RS1 to RS16  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CAS Format)  
60h to 6Fh  
(MSB)  
(LSB)  
0
0
0
0
X
Y
X
X
RS1  
RS2  
RS3  
RS4  
RS5  
RS6  
CH2-A  
CH4-A  
CH6-A  
CH8-A  
CH2-B  
CH4-B  
CH6-B  
CH8-B  
CH2-C  
CH4-C  
CH6-C  
CH8-C  
CH2-D  
CH4-D  
CH6-D  
CH8-D  
CH1-A  
CH3-A  
CH5-A  
CH7-A  
CH1-B  
CH3-B  
CH5-B  
CH7-B  
CH9-B  
CH1-C  
CH3-C  
CH5-C  
CH7-C  
CH9-C  
CH1-D  
CH3-D  
CH5-D  
CH7-D  
CH9-D  
CH10-A CH10-B CH10-C CH10-D CH9-A  
CH12-A CH12-B CH12-C CH12-D CH11-A CH11-B CH11-C CH11-D RS7  
CH14-A CH14-B CH14-C CH14-D CH13-A CH13-B CH13-C CH13-D RS8  
CH16-A CH16-B CH16-C CH16-D CH15-A CH15-B CH15-C CH15-D RS9  
CH18-A CH18-B CH18-C CH18-D CH17-A CH17-B CH17-C CH17-D RS10  
CH20-A CH20-B CH20-C CH20-D CH19-A CH19-B CH19-C CH19-D RS11  
CH22-A CH22-B CH22-C CH22-D CH21-A CH21-B CH21-C CH21-D RS12  
CH24-A CH24-B CH24-C CH24-D CH23-A CH23-B CH23-C CH23-D RS13  
CH26-A CH26-B CH26-C CH26-D CH25-A CH25-B CH25-C CH25-D RS14  
CH28-A CH28-B CH28-C CH28-D CH27-A CH27-B CH27-C CH27-D RS15  
CH30-A CH30-B CH30-C CH30-D CH29-A CH29-B CH29-C CH29-D RS16  
Register Name:  
RS1 to RS16  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CCS Format)  
60h to 6Fh  
(MSB)  
(LSB)  
1
9
2
10  
18  
26  
34  
42  
50  
58  
66  
74  
82  
90  
98  
106  
114  
122  
3
11  
19  
27  
35  
43  
51  
59  
67  
75  
83  
91  
99  
107  
115  
123  
4
5
6
7
8
RS1  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
RS2  
17  
25  
33  
41  
49  
57  
65  
73  
81  
89  
97  
105  
113  
121  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
RS3  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
RS4  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
RS5  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
RS6  
52  
53  
54  
55  
56  
RS7  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
RS8  
68  
69  
70  
71  
72  
RS9  
76  
77  
78  
79  
80  
RS10  
RS11  
RS12  
RS13  
RS14  
RS15  
RS16  
84  
85  
86  
87  
88  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
100  
108  
116  
124  
101  
109  
117  
125  
102  
110  
118  
126  
103  
111  
119  
127  
104  
112  
120  
128  
87 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RSCSE1, RSCSE2, RSCSE3, RSCSE4  
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Interrupt Enable  
3Ch, 3Dh, 3Eh, 3Fh  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
(MSB)  
(LSB)  
CH8  
CH7  
CH15  
CH23  
CH6  
CH5  
CH4  
CH3  
CH2  
CH1  
RSCSE1  
RSCSE2  
RSCSE3  
RSCSE4  
CH16  
CH24  
CH14  
CH22  
CH30  
CH13  
CH21  
CH29  
CH12  
CH20  
CH28  
CH11  
CH19  
CH27  
CH10  
CH18  
CH26  
CH9  
CH17  
CH25  
Setting any of the CH1–CH30 bits in the RSCSE1–RSCSE4 registers causes an interrupt when that channel’s  
signaling data changes state.  
Register Name:  
RSINFO1, RSINFO2, RSINFO3, RSINFO4  
Receive Signaling Change-of-State Information  
38h, 39h, 3Ah, 3Bh  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
(MSB)  
(LSB)  
CH1  
CH8  
CH7  
CH15  
CH23  
CH6  
CH5  
CH4  
CH3  
CH2  
RSINFO1  
RSINFO2  
RSINFO3  
RSINFO4  
CH16  
CH24  
CH14  
CH22  
CH30  
CH13  
CH21  
CH29  
CH12  
CH20  
CH28  
CH11  
CH19  
CH27  
CH10  
CH18  
CH26  
CH9  
CH17  
CH25  
When a channel’s signaling data changes state, the respective bit in registers RSINFO1–4 is set. An interrupt is  
generated if the channel was also enabled as an interrupt source by setting the appropriate bit in RSCSE1–4. The  
bit remains set until read.  
88 of 238  
DS2155  
16.2Transmit Signaling  
Figure 16-2. Simplified Diagram of Transmit Signaling Path  
TRANSMIT  
SIGNALING  
REGISTERS  
1
0
1
0
1
TSER  
TSIG  
T1/E1 DATA  
STREAM  
0
B7  
SIGNALING  
BUFFERS  
T1TCR1.4  
PER-CHANNEL  
CONTROL  
PER-CHANNEL  
CONTROL  
SSIE1 - SSIE4  
PCPR.3  
ONLY APPLIES TO T1 MODE  
16.2.1 Processor-Based Mode  
In processor-based mode, signaling data is loaded into the transmit signaling registers (TS1–TS16) by the  
host interface. On multiframe boundaries, the contents of these registers are loaded into a shift register for  
placement in the appropriate bit position in the outgoing data stream. The user can employ the transmit  
multiframe interrupt in status register 4 (SR4.4) to know when to update the signaling bits. The user need  
not update any transmit signaling register for which there is no change-of-state for that register.  
Each transmit signaling register contains the robbed-bit signaling (T1) or TS16 CAS signaling (E1) for  
two time slots that are inserted into the outgoing stream, if enabled to do so through T1TCR1.4 (T1  
mode) or E1TCR1.6 (E1 mode). In T1 mode, only TS1–TS12 are used.  
Signaling data can be sourced from the TS registers on a per-channel basis by using the software  
signaling insertion enable registers, SSIE1–SSIE4.  
16.2.1.1 T1 Mode  
In T1 ESF framing mode, there are four signaling bits per channel (A, B, C, and D). TS1–TS12 contain a  
full multiframe of signaling data. In T1 D4 framing mode, there are only two signaling bits per channel  
(A and B). In T1 D4 framing mode, the framer uses the C and D bit positions as the A and B bit positions  
for the next multiframe. In D4 mode, two multiframes of signaling data can be loaded into TS1–TS12.  
The framer loads the contents of TS1–TS12 into the outgoing shift register every other D4 multiframe. In  
D4 mode, the host should load new contents into TS1–TS12 on every other multiframe boundary and no  
later than 120µs after the boundary.  
89 of 238  
DS2155  
16.2.1.2 E1 Mode  
In E1 mode, TS16 carries the signaling information. This information can be in either CCS (common  
channel signaling) or CAS (channel associated signaling) format. The 32 time slots are referenced by two  
different channel number schemes in E1. In “Channel” numbering, TS0–TS31 are labeled channels 1  
through 32. In “Phone Channel” numbering, TS1–TS15 are labeled channel 1 through channel 15 and  
TS17–TS31 are labeled channel 15 through channel 30.  
Table 16-A. Time Slot Numbering Schemes  
TS  
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10111213141516171819202122232425262728293031  
Channel 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1011121314151617181920212223242526272829303132  
Phone  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 101112131415 161718192021222324252627282930  
Channel  
90 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
TS1 to TS16  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CAS Format)  
50h to 5Fh  
(MSB)  
(LSB)  
0
0
0
0
X
Y
X
X
TS1  
TS2  
TS3  
TS4  
TS5  
TS6  
CH2-A  
CH4-A  
CH6-A  
CH8-A  
CH2-B  
CH4-B  
CH6-B  
CH8-B  
CH2-C  
CH4-C  
CH6-C  
CH8-C  
CH2-D  
CH4-D  
CH6-D  
CH8-D  
CH1-A  
CH3-A  
CH5-A  
CH7-A  
CH1-B  
CH3-B  
CH5-B  
CH7-B  
CH9-B  
CH1-C  
CH3-C  
CH5-C  
CH7-C  
CH9-C  
CH1-D  
CH3-D  
CH5-D  
CH7-D  
CH9-D  
CH10-A CH10-B CH10-C CH10-D CH9-A  
CH12-A CH12-B CH12-C CH12-D CH11-A CH11-B CH11-C CH11-D TS7  
CH14-A CH14-B CH14-C CH14-D CH13-A CH13-B CH13-C CH13-D TS8  
CH16-A CH16-B CH16-C CH16-D CH15-A CH15-B CH15-C CH15-D TS9  
CH18-A CH18-B CH18-C CH18-D CH17-A CH17-B CH17-C CH17-D TS10  
CH20-A CH20-B CH20-C CH20-D CH19-A CH19-B CH19-C CH19-D TS11  
CH22-A CH22-B CH22-C CH22-D CH21-A CH21-B CH21-C CH21-D TS12  
CH24-A CH24-B CH24-C CH24-D CH23-A CH23-B CH23-C CH23-D TS13  
CH26-A CH26-B CH26-C CH26-D CH25-A CH25-B CH25-C CH25-D TS14  
CH28-A CH28-B CH28-C CH28-D CH27-A CH27-B CH27-C CH27-D TS15  
CH30-A CH30-B CH30-C CH30-D CH29-A CH29-B CH29-C CH29-D TS16  
Register Name:  
TS1 to TS16  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Signaling Registers (E1 Mode, CCS Format)  
50h to 5Fh  
(MSB)  
(LSB)  
1
9
2
10  
18  
26  
34  
42  
50  
58  
66  
74  
82  
90  
98  
106  
114  
122  
3
11  
19  
27  
35  
43  
51  
59  
67  
75  
83  
91  
99  
107  
115  
123  
4
5
6
7
8
TS1  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
24  
TS2  
17  
25  
33  
41  
49  
57  
65  
73  
81  
89  
97  
105  
113  
121  
20  
21  
22  
23  
TS3  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
TS4  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
TS5  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
TS6  
52  
53  
54  
55  
56  
TS7  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
TS8  
68  
69  
70  
71  
72  
TS9  
76  
77  
78  
79  
80  
TS10  
TS11  
TS12  
TS13  
TS14  
TS15  
TS16  
84  
85  
86  
87  
88  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
100  
108  
116  
124  
101  
109  
117  
125  
102  
110  
118  
126  
103  
111  
119  
127  
104  
112  
120  
128  
91 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
TS1 to TS12  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Signaling Registers (T1 Mode, ESF Format)  
50h to 5Bh  
(MSB)  
(LSB)  
CH2-A  
CH4-A  
CH6-A  
CH8-A  
CH2-B  
CH4-B  
CH6-B  
CH8-B  
CH2-C  
CH4-C  
CH6-C  
CH8-C  
CH2-D  
CH4-D  
CH6-D  
CH8-D  
CH1-A  
CH3-A  
CH5-A  
CH7-A  
CH1-B  
CH3-B  
CH5-B  
CH7-B  
CH9-B  
CH1-C  
CH3-C  
CH5-C  
CH7-C  
CH9-C  
CH1-D  
CH3-D  
CH5-D  
CH7-D  
CH9-D  
TS1  
TS2  
TS3  
TS4  
TS5  
CH10-A CH10-B CH10-C CH10-D CH9-A  
CH12-A CH12-B CH12-C CH12-D CH11-A CH11-B CH11-C CH11-D TS6  
CH14-A CH14-B CH14-C CH14-D CH13-A CH13-B CH13-C CH13-D TS7  
CH16-A CH16-B CH16-C CH16-D CH15-A CH15-B CH15-C CH15-D TS8  
CH18-A CH18-B CH18-C CH18-D CH17-A CH17-B CH17-C CH17-D TS9  
CH20-A CH20-B CH20-C CH20-D CH19-A CH19-B CH19-C CH19-D TS10  
CH22-A CH22-B CH22-C CH22-D CH21-A CH21-B CH21-C CH21-D TS11  
CH24-A CH24-B CH24-C CH24-D CH23-A CH23-B CH23-C CH23-D TS12  
Register Name:  
TS1 to TS12  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Signaling Registers (T1 Mode, D4 Format)  
50h to 5Bh  
(MSB)  
(LSB)  
CH1-B  
CH3-B  
CH5-B  
CH7-B  
CH9-B  
CH2-A  
CH4-A  
CH6-A  
CH8-A  
CH2-B  
CH4-B  
CH6-B  
CH8-B  
CH2-A  
CH4-A  
CH6-A  
CH8-A  
CH2-B  
CH4-B  
CH6-B  
CH8-B  
CH1-A  
CH3-A  
CH5-A  
CH7-A  
CH1-B  
CH3-B  
CH5-B  
CH7-B  
CH9-B  
CH1-A  
CH3-A  
CH5-A  
CH7-A  
CH9-A  
TS1  
TS2  
TS3  
TS4  
TS5  
CH10-A CH10-B  
CH12-A CH12-B  
CH14-A CH14-B  
CH16-A CH16-B  
CH18-A CH18-B  
CH20-A CH20-B  
CH22-A CH22-B  
CH24-A CH24-B  
CH10-A CH10-B CH9-A  
CH12-A CH12-B CH11-A CH11-B  
CH14-A CH14-B CH13-A CH13-B  
CH16-A CH16-B CH15-A CH15-B  
CH18-A CH18-B CH17-A CH17-B  
CH20-A CH20-B CH19-A CH19-B  
CH22-A CH22-B CH21-A CH21-B  
CH24-A CH24-B CH23-A CH23-B  
CH11-A CH11-B TS6  
CH13-A CH13-B TS7  
CH15-A CH15-B TS8  
CH17-A CH17-B TS9  
CH19-A CH19-B TS10  
CH21-A CH21-B TS11  
CH23-A CH23-B TS12  
Note: In D4 format, TS1–TS12 contain signaling data for two frames. Bold type indicates data for second frame.  
92 of 238  
DS2155  
16.2.2 Software Signaling Insertion-Enable Registers, E1 CAS Mode  
In E1 CAS mode, the CAS signaling alignment/alarm byte can be sourced from the transmit signaling  
registers along with the signaling data.  
Register Name:  
SSIE1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 1  
08h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH7  
0
6
CH6  
0
5
CH5  
0
4
CH4  
0
3
CH3  
0
2
CH2  
0
1
CH1  
0
0
UCAW  
0
Bit 0/Upper CAS Align/Alarm Word (UCAW). Selects the upper CAS align/alarm pattern (0000) to be sourced  
from the upper 4 bits of the TS1 register.  
0 = do not source the upper CAS align/alarm pattern from the TS1 register  
1 = source the upper CAS align/alarm pattern from the TS1 register  
Bits 1 to 7/Software Signaling-Insertion Enable for Channels 1 to 7 (CH1 to CH7). These bits determine  
which channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.  
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
Register Name:  
SSIE2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 2  
09h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH15  
0
6
CH14  
0
5
CH13  
0
4
CH12  
0
3
CH11  
0
2
CH10  
0
1
CH9  
0
0
CH8  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 8 to 15 (CH8 to CH15). These bits determine  
which channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.  
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
93 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
SSIE3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 3  
0Ah  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH22  
0
6
CH21  
0
5
CH20  
0
4
CH19  
0
3
CH18  
0
2
CH17  
0
1
CH16  
0
0
LCAW  
0
Bit 0/Lower CAS Align/Alarm Word (LCAW). Selects the lower CAS align/alarm bits (xyxx) to be sourced  
from the lower 4 bits of the TS1 register.  
0 = do not source the lower CAS align/alarm bits from the TS1 register  
1 = source the lower CAS alarm align/bits from the TS1 register  
Bits 1 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for LCAW and Channels 16 to 22 (CH16 to CH22). These  
bits determine which channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.  
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
Register Name:  
SSIE4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 4  
0Bh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH30  
0
6
CH29  
0
5
CH28  
0
4
CH27  
0
3
CH26  
0
2
CH25  
0
1
CH24  
0
0
CH23  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 22 to 30 (CH23 to CH30). These bits determine  
which channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.  
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
94 of 238  
DS2155  
16.2.3 Software Signaling Insertion-Enable Registers, T1 Mode  
In T1 mode, only registers SSIE1–SSIE3 are used since there are only 24 channels in a T1 frame.  
Register Name:  
SSIE1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Software Signaling Insertion Enable 1  
08h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH8  
0
6
CH7  
0
5
CH6  
0
4
CH5  
0
3
CH4  
0
2
CH3  
0
1
CH2  
0
0
CH1  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 1 to 8 (CH1 to CH8). These bits determine which  
channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.  
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
Register Name:  
SSIE2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Software Signaling-Insertion Enable 2  
09h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH16  
0
6
CH15  
0
5
CH14  
0
4
CH13  
0
3
CH12  
0
2
CH11  
0
1
CH10  
0
0
CH9  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 9 to 16 (CH9 to CH16). These bits determine  
which channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.  
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
Register Name:  
SSIE3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Software Signaling-Insertion Enable 3  
0Ah  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH24  
0
6
CH23  
0
5
CH22  
0
4
CH21  
0
3
CH20  
0
2
CH19  
0
1
CH18  
0
0
CH17  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Software Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 17 to 24 (CH17 to CH24). These bits determine  
which channels are to have signaling inserted from the transmit signaling registers.  
0 = do not source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
1 = source signaling data from the TSx registers for this channel  
16.2.4 Hardware-Based Mode  
In hardware-based mode, signaling data is input through the TSIG pin. This signaling PCM stream is  
buffered and inserted to the data stream being input at the TSER pin.  
Signaling data can be inserted on a per-channel basis by the transmit hardware-signaling channel-select  
(THSCS) function. The user has the ability to control which channels are to have signaling data from the  
TSIG pin inserted into them on a per-channel basis. See Section 7 for details on using this per-channel  
(THSCS) feature. The signaling insertion capabilities of the framer are available whether the transmit-  
side elastic store is enabled or disabled. If the elastic store is enabled, the backplane clock (TSYSCLK)  
can be either 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. Also, if the elastic is enabled in conjunction with transmit  
hardware signaling, CCR3.7 must be set = 0.  
95 of 238  
DS2155  
17. PER-CHANNEL IDLE CODE GENERATION  
Channel data can be replaced by an idle code on a per-channel basis in the transmit and receive  
directions. When operated in the T1 mode, only the first 24 channels are used by the DS2155, the  
remaining channels, CH25–CH32, are not used.  
The DS2155 contains a 64-byte idle code array accessed by the idle array address register (IAAR) and the  
per-channel idle code register (PCICR). The contents of the array contain the idle codes to be substituted  
into the appropriate transmit or receive channels. This substitution can be enabled and disabled on a per-  
channel basis by the transmit-channel idle code-enable registers (TCICE1–4) and receive-channel idle  
code-enable registers (RCICE1–4).  
To program idle codes, first select a channel by writing to the IAAR register. Then write the idle code to  
the PCICR register. For successive writes there is no need to load the IAAR with the next consecutive  
address. The IAAR register automatically increments after a write to the PCICR register. The auto  
increment feature can be used for read operations as well. Bits 6 and 7 of the IAAR register can be used  
to block write a common idle code to all transmit or receive positions in the array with a single write to  
the PCICR register. Bits 6 and 7 of the IAAR register should not be used for read operations. TCICE1–4  
and RCICE1–4 are used to enable idle code replacement on a per-channel basis.  
Table 17-A. Idle-Code Array Address Mapping  
BITS 0 to 5 OF IAAR  
MAPS TO CHANNEL  
REGISTER  
0
Transmit Channel 1  
Transmit Channel 2  
Transmit Channel 3  
1
2
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
62  
63  
Transmit Channel 31  
Transmit Channel 32  
Receive Channel 1  
Receive Channel 2  
Receive Channel 3  
Receive Channel 31  
Receive Channel 32  
96 of 238  
 
DS2155  
17.1Idle-Code Programming Examples  
Example 1  
Sets transmit channel 3 idle code to 7Eh.  
Write IAAR = 02h ;select channel 3 in the array  
Write PCICR = 7Eh ;set idle code to 7Eh  
Example 2  
Sets transmit channels 3, 4, 5, and 6 idle code to 7Eh and enables transmission of idle codes for those channels.  
Write IAAR = 02h  
Write PCICR = 7Eh  
Write PCICR = 7Eh  
Write PCICR = 7Eh  
Write PCICR = 7Eh  
Write TCICE1 = 3Ch  
;select channel 3 in the array  
;set channel 3 idle code to 7Eh  
;set channel 4 idle code to 7Eh  
;set channel 5 idle code to 7Eh  
;set channel 6 idle code to 7Eh  
;enable transmission of idle codes for channels 3,4,5, and 6  
Example 3  
Sets transmit channels 3, 4, 5, and 6 idle code to 7Eh, EEh, FFh, and 7Eh, respectively.  
Write IAAR = 02h  
Write PCICR = 7Eh  
Write PCICR = EEh  
Write PCICR = FFh  
Write PCICR = 7Eh  
Example 4  
Sets all transmit idle codes to 7Eh.  
Write IAAR = 4xh  
Write PCICR = 7Eh  
Example 5  
Sets all receive and transmit idle codes to 7Eh and enables idle code substitution in all E1 transmit and receive  
channels.  
Write IAAR = Cxh  
Write PCICR = 7Eh  
;enable block write to all transmit and receive positions in the array  
;7Eh is idle code  
Write TCICE1 = FEh ;enable idle code substitution for transmit channels 2 through 8  
;Although an idle code was programmed for channel 1 by the block write  
;function above, enabling it for channel 1 would step on the frame  
;alignment, alarms, and Sa bits  
Write TCICE2 = FFh ;enable idle code substitution for transmit channels 9 through 16  
Write TCICE3 = FEh ;enable idle code substitution for transmit channels 18 through 24  
;Although an idle code was programmed for channel 17 by the block write  
;function above, enabling it for channel 17 would step on the CAS frame  
;alignment, and signaling information  
Write TCICE4 = FFh ;enable idle code substitution for transmit channels 25 through 32  
Write RCICE1 = FEh ;enable idle code substitution for receive channels 2 through 8  
Write RCICE2 = FFh ;enable idle code substitution for receive channels 9 through 16  
Write RCICE3 = FEh ;enable idle code substitution for receive channels 18 through 24  
Write RCICE4 = FFh ;enable idle code substitution for receive channels 25 through 32  
97 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
IAAR  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Idle Array Address Register  
7Eh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
GRIC  
0
6
GTIC  
0
5
IAA5  
0
4
IAA4  
0
3
IAA3  
0
2
IAA2  
0
1
IAA1  
0
0
IAA0  
0
Bits 0 to 5/Channel Pointer Address Bits (IAA0 to IAA5). These bits select the channel to be programmed with  
the idle code defined in the PCICR register. IAA0 is the LSB of the 5-bit channel code. Channel 1 is 01h.  
Bit 6/Global Transmit-Idle Code (GTIC). Setting this bit causes all transmit channels to be set to the idle code  
written to the PCICR register. This bit must be set = 0 for read operations. The value in bits IAA0–IAA5 must be a  
valid transmit channel (01h to 20h for E1 mode; 01h to 18h for T1 mode).  
Bit 7/Global Receive-Idle Code (GRIC). Setting this bit causes all receive channels to be set to the idle code  
written to the PCICR register. This bit must be set = 0 for read operations. The value in bits IAA0–IAA5 must be a  
valid transmit channel (01h to 20h for E1 mode; 01h to 18h for T1 mode).  
Table 17-B. GRIC and GTIC Functions  
GRIC GTIC  
FUNCTION  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Updates a single transmit or receive channel  
Updates all transmit channels  
Updates all receive channels  
Updates all transmit and receive channels  
Register Name:  
PCICR  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Per-Channel Idle Code Register  
7Fh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
C7  
0
6
C6  
0
5
C5  
0
4
C4  
0
3
C3  
0
2
C2  
0
1
C1  
0
0
C0  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Per-Channel Idle-Code Bits (C0 to C7). This register defines the idle code to be programmed in the  
channel selected by the IAAR register. C0 is the LSB of the idle code (this bit is transmitted last).  
98 of 238  
DS2155  
The transmit-channel idle-code enable registers (TCICE1/2/3/4) are used to determine which of the 24 T1 or 32 E1  
channels from the backplane to the T1 or E1 line should be overwritten with the code placed in the per-channel  
code array.  
Register Name:  
TCICE1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 1  
80h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH8  
0
6
CH7  
0
5
CH6  
0
4
CH5  
0
3
CH4  
0
2
CH3  
0
1
CH2  
0
0
CH1  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 1 to 8 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH1 to CH8)  
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the transmit data stream  
1 = insert data from the idle-code array into the transmit data stream  
Register Name:  
TCICE2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 2  
81h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH16  
0
6
CH15  
0
5
CH14  
0
4
CH13  
0
3
CH12  
0
2
CH11  
0
1
CH10  
0
0
CH9  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 9 to 16 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH9 to CH16)  
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the transmit data stream  
1 = insert data from the idle code-array into the transmit data stream  
Register Name:  
TCICE3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 3  
82h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH24  
0
6
CH23  
0
5
CH22  
0
4
CH21  
0
3
CH20  
0
2
CH19  
0
1
CH18  
0
0
CH17  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 17 to 24 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH17 to CH24)  
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the transmit data stream  
1 = insert data from the idle code-array into the transmit data stream  
Register Name:  
TCICE4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 4  
83h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH32  
0
6
CH31  
0
5
CH30  
0
4
CH29  
0
3
CH28  
0
2
CH27  
0
1
CH26  
0
0
CH25  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 25 to 32 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH25 to CH32)  
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the transmit data stream  
1 = insert data from the idle-code array into the transmit data stream  
99 of 238  
DS2155  
The receive-channel idle-code enable registers (RCICE1/2/3/4) are used to determine which of the 24 T1 or 32 E1  
channels from the backplane to the T1 or E1 line should be overwritten with the code placed in the per-channel  
code array.  
Register Name:  
RCICE1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 1  
84h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH8  
0
6
CH7  
0
5
CH6  
0
4
CH5  
0
3
CH4  
0
2
CH3  
0
1
CH2  
0
0
CH1  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 1 to 8 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH1 to CH8)  
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream  
1 = insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream  
Register Name:  
RCICE2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 2  
85h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH16  
0
6
CH15  
0
5
CH14  
0
4
CH13  
0
3
CH12  
0
2
CH11  
0
1
CH10  
0
0
CH9  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 9 to 16 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH9 to CH16)  
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream  
1 = insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream  
Register Name:  
RCICE3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 3  
86h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH24  
0
6
CH23  
0
5
CH22  
0
4
CH21  
0
3
CH20  
0
2
CH19  
0
1
CH18  
0
0
CH17  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 17 to 24 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH17 to CH24)  
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream  
1 = insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream  
Register Name:  
RCICE4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive-Channel Idle-Code Enable Register 4  
87h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH32  
0
6
CH31  
0
5
CH30  
0
4
CH29  
0
3
CH28  
0
2
CH27  
0
1
CH26  
0
0
CH25  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 25 to 32 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH25 to CH32)  
0 = do not insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream  
1 = insert data from the idle-code array into the receive data stream  
100 of 238  
DS2155  
18. CHANNEL BLOCKING REGISTERS  
The receive channel blocking registers (RCBR1/RCBR2/RCBR3/RCBR4) and the transmit channel  
blocking registers (TCBR1/TCBR2/TCBR3/TCBR4) control RCHBLK and TCHBLK pins, respectively.  
The RCHBLK and TCHBLK pins are user-programmable outputs that can be forced either high or low  
during individual channels. These outputs can be used to block clocks to a USART or LAPD controller in  
ISDN-PRI applications. When the appropriate bits are set to a 1, the RCHBLK and TCHBLK pins are  
held high during the entire corresponding channel time. Channels 25 through 32 are ignored when the  
DS2155 is operated in the T1 mode.  
Register Name:  
RCBR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Channel Blocking Register 1  
88h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH8  
0
6
CH7  
0
5
CH6  
0
4
CH5  
0
3
CH4  
0
2
CH3  
0
1
CH2  
0
0
CH1  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 1 to 8 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH1 to CH8)  
0 = force the RCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time  
1 = force the RCHBLK pin high during this channel time  
Register Name:  
RCBR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Channel Blocking Register 2  
89h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH16  
0
6
CH15  
0
5
CH14  
0
4
CH13  
0
3
CH12  
0
2
CH11  
0
1
CH10  
0
0
CH9  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 9 to 16 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH9 to CH16)  
0 = force the RCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time  
1 = force the RCHBLK pin high during this channel time  
101 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RCBR3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Channel Blocking Register 3  
8Ah  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH24  
0
6
CH23  
0
5
CH22  
0
4
CH21  
0
3
CH20  
0
2
CH19  
0
1
CH18  
0
0
CH17  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 17 to 24 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH17 to CH24)  
0 = force the RCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time  
1 = force the RCHBLK pin high during this channel time  
Register Name:  
RCBR4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Channel Blocking Register 4  
8Bh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH32  
0
6
CH31  
0
5
CH30  
0
4
CH29  
0
3
CH28  
0
2
CH27  
0
1
CH26  
0
0
CH25  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Receive Channels 25 to 32 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH25 to CH32)  
0 = force the RCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time  
1 = force the RCHBLK pin high during this channel time  
102 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
TCBR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 1  
8Ch  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH8  
0
6
CH7  
0
5
CH6  
0
4
CH5  
0
3
CH4  
0
2
CH3  
0
1
CH2  
0
0
CH1  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 1 to 8 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH1 to CH8)  
0 = force the TCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time  
1 = force the TCHBLK pin high during this channel time  
Register Name:  
TCBR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 2  
8Dh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH16  
0
6
CH15  
0
5
CH14  
0
4
CH13  
0
3
CH12  
0
2
CH11  
0
1
CH10  
0
0
CH9  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 9 to 16 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH9 to CH16)  
0 = force the TCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time  
1 = force the TCHBLK pin high during this channel time  
Register Name:  
TCBR3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 3  
8Eh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH24  
0
6
CH23  
0
5
CH22  
0
4
CH21  
0
3
CH20  
0
2
CH19  
0
1
CH18  
0
0
CH17  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 17 to 24 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH17 to CH24)  
0 = force the TCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time  
1 = force the TCHBLK pin high during this channel time  
Register Name:  
TCBR4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 4  
8Fh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CH32  
0
6
CH31  
0
5
CH30  
0
4
CH29  
0
3
CH28  
0
2
CH27  
0
1
CH26  
0
0
CH25  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit Channels 25 to 32 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH25 to CH32)  
0 = force the TCHBLK pin to remain low during this channel time  
1 = force the TCHBLK pin high during this channel time  
103 of 238  
DS2155  
19. ELASTIC STORES OPERATION  
The DS2155 contains dual two-frame elastic stores, one for the receive direction and one for the transmit  
direction. Both elastic stores are fully independent. The transmit and receive-side elastic stores can be  
enabled/disabled independently of each other. Also, each elastic store can interface to either a 1.544MHz  
or 2.048MHz/4.096MHz/8.192MHz/16.384MHz backplane without regard to the backplane rate the other  
elastic store is interfacing to.  
The elastic stores have two main purposes. Firstly, they can be used for rate conversion. When the  
DS2155 is in the T1 mode, the elastic stores can rate-convert the T1 data stream to a 2.048MHz  
backplane. In E1 mode, the elastic store can rate-convert the E1 data stream to a 1.544MHz backplane.  
Secondly, they can be used to absorb the differences in frequency and phase between the T1 or E1 data  
stream and an asynchronous (i.e., not locked) backplane clock, which can be 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. In  
this mode, the elastic stores manage the rate difference and perform controlled slips, deleting or repeating  
frames of data in order to manage the difference between the network and the backplane.  
The elastic stores can also be used to multiplex T1 or E1 data streams into higher backplane rates, which  
is the IBO discussed in Section 28.  
104 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
ESCR  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Elastic Store Control Register  
4Fh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TESALGN TESR TESMDM TESE RESALGN RESR RESMDM RESE  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Elastic Store Enable (RESE)  
0 = elastic store is bypassed  
1 = elastic store is enabled  
Bit 1/Receive Elastic Store Minimum-Delay Mode (RESMDM). See Section 19.4 for details.  
0 = elastic stores operate at full two-frame depth  
1 = elastic stores operate at 32-bit depth  
Bit 2/Receive Elastic Store Reset (RESR). Setting this bit from a 0 to a 1 forces the read and write pointers into  
opposite frames, maximizing the delay through the receive elastic store. It should be toggled after RSYSCLK has  
been applied and is stable. See Section 19.3 for details. Do not leave this bit set HIGH.  
Bit 3/Receive Elastic Store Align (RESALGN). Setting this bit from a 0 to a 1 forces the receive elastic store’s  
write/read pointers to a minimum separation of half a frame. No action is taken if the pointer separation is already  
greater or equal to half a frame. If pointer separation is less than half a frame, the command is executed and the  
data is disrupted. It should be toggled after RSYSCLK has been applied and is stable. Must be cleared and set again  
for a subsequent align. See Section 19.3 for details.  
Bit 4/Transmit Elastic Store Enable (TESE)  
0 = elastic store is bypassed  
1 = elastic store is enabled  
Bit 5/Transmit Elastic Store Minimum-Delay Mode (TESMDM). See Section 19.4 for details.  
0 = elastic stores operate at full two-frame depth  
1 = elastic stores operate at 32-bit depth  
Bit 6/Transmit Elastic Store Reset (TESR). Setting this bit from a 0 to a 1 forces the read and write pointers into  
opposite frames, maximizing the delay through the transmit elastic store. Transmit data is lost during the reset. It  
should be toggled after TSYSCLK has been applied and is stable. See Section 19.3 for details. Do not leave this bit  
set HIGH.  
Bit 7/Transmit Elastic Store Align (TESALGN). Setting this bit from a 0 to a 1 forces the transmit elastic store’s  
write/read pointers to a minimum separation of half a frame. No action is taken if the pointer separation is already  
greater or equal to half a frame. If pointer separation is less than half a frame, the command is executed and the  
data is disrupted. It should be toggled after TSYSCLK has been applied and is stable. It must be cleared and set  
again for a subsequent align. See Section 19.3 for details.  
105 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
SR5  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Status Register 5  
1Eh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
TESF  
0
4
TESEM  
0
3
TSLIP  
0
2
RESF  
0
1
RESEM  
0
0
RSLIP  
0
Bit 0/Receive Elastic Store Slip-Occurrence Event (RSLIP). Set when the receive elastic store has either  
repeated or deleted a frame.  
Bit 1/Receive Elastic Store Empty Event (RESEM). Set when the receive elastic store buffer empties and a  
frame is repeated.  
Bit 2/Receive Elastic Store Full Event (RESF). Set when the receive elastic store buffer fills and a frame is  
deleted.  
Bit 3/Transmit Elastic Store Slip-Occurrence Event (TSLIP). Set when the transmit elastic store has either  
repeated or deleted a frame.  
Bit 4/Transmit Elastic Store Empty Event (TESEM). Set when the transmit elastic store buffer empties and a  
frame is repeated.  
Bit 5/Transmit Elastic Store Full Event (TESF). Set when the transmit elastic store buffer fills and a frame is  
deleted.  
Register Name:  
IMR5  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Interrupt Mask Register 5  
1Fh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
TESF  
0
4
TESEM  
0
3
TSLIP  
0
2
RESF  
0
1
RESEM  
0
0
RSLIP  
0
Bit 0/Receive Elastic Store Slip-Occurrence Event (RSLIP)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 1/Receive Elastic Store Empty Event (RESEM)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 2/Receive Elastic Store Full Event (RESF)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 3/Transmit Elastic Store Slip-Occurrence Event (TSLIP)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 4/Transmit Elastic Store Empty Event (TESEM)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 5/Transmit Elastic Store Full Event (TESF)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
106 of 238  
DS2155  
19.1Receive Side  
See the IOCR1 and IOCR2 registers for information about clock and I/O configurations.  
If the receive-side elastic store is enabled, then the user must provide either a 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz  
clock at the RSYSCLK pin. For higher rate system clock applications, see the Interleaved PCM Bus  
Operation in Section 28. The user has the option of either providing a frame/multiframe sync at the  
RSYNC pin or having the RSYNC pin provide a pulse on frame/multiframe boundaries. If signaling  
reinsertion is enabled, signaling data in TS16 is realigned to the multiframe sync input on RSYNC.  
Otherwise, a multiframe sync input on RSYNC is treated as a simple frame boundary by the elastic store.  
The framer always indicates frame boundaries on the network side of the elastic store by the RFSYNC  
output, whether the elastic store is enabled or not. Multiframe boundaries are always indicated by the  
RMSYNC output. If the elastic store is enabled, then RMSYNC outputs the multiframe boundary on the  
backplane side of the elastic store.  
19.1.1 T1 Mode  
If the user selects to apply a 2.048MHz clock to the RSYSCLK pin, then the data output at RSER is  
forced to all 1s every fourth channel and the F-bit is passed into the MSB of TS0. Hence, channels 1 (bits  
1–7), 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 [time slots 0 (bits 1–7), 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, 24, and 28] are forced to a 1.  
Also, in 2.048MHz applications, the RCHBLK output is forced high during the same channels as the  
RSER pin. This is useful in T1-to-E1 conversion applications. If the two-frame elastic buffer either fills  
or empties, a controlled slip occurs. If the buffer empties, then a full frame of data is repeated at RSER,  
and the SR5.0 and SR5.1 bits are set to a 1. If the buffer fills, then a full frame of data is deleted, and the  
SR5.0 and SR5.2 bits are set to a 1.  
19.1.2 E1 Mode  
If the elastic store is enabled, then either CAS or CRC4 multiframe boundaries are indicated through the  
RMSYNC output. If the user selects to apply a 1.544MHz clock to the RSYSCLK pin, then every fourth  
channel of the received E1 data is deleted and an F-bit position, which is forced to 1, is inserted. Hence,  
channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 (time slots 0, 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, 24, and 28) are deleted from the  
received E1 data stream. Also, in 1.544MHz applications, the RCHBLK output is not active in channels  
25 through 32 (i.e., RCBR4 is not active). If the two-frame elastic buffer either fills or empties, a  
controlled slip occurs. If the buffer empties, then a full frame of data is repeated at RSER, and the SR5.0  
and SR5.1 bits are set to a 1. If the buffer fills, then a full frame of data is deleted, and the SR5.0 and  
SR5.2 bits are set to a 1.  
19.2Transmit Side  
See the IOCR1 and IOCR2 registers for information about clock and I/O configurations.  
The operation of the transmit elastic store is very similar to the receive side. If the transmit-side elastic  
store is enabled, a 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz clock can be applied to the TSYSCLK input. For higher rate  
system clock applications, see Interleaved PCM Bus Operation in Section 28. Controlled slips in the  
transmit elastic store are reported in the SR5.3 bit, and the direction of the slip is reported in the SR5.4  
and SR5.5 bits. If hardware signaling insertion is not enabled, CCR3.7 should be set = 1.  
107 of 238  
DS2155  
19.2.1 T1 Mode  
If the user selects to apply a 2.048MHz clock to the TSYSCLK pin, then the data input at TSER is  
ignored every fourth channel. Therefore channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 (time slots 0, 4, 8, 12, 16,  
20, 24, and 28) are ignored. The user can supply frame or multiframe sync pulse to the TSSYNC input.  
Also, in 2.048MHz applications, the TCHBLK output is forced high during the channels ignored by the  
framer.  
19.2.2 E1 Mode  
A 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz clock can be applied to the TSYSCLK input. The user must supply a frame  
sync pulse or a multiframe sync pulse to the TSSYNC input.  
19.3Elastic Stores Initialization  
There are two elastic store initializations that can be used to improve performance in certain applications,  
elastic store reset and elastic store align. Both of these involve the manipulation of the elastic store’s read  
and write pointers and are useful primarily in synchronous applications (RSYSCLK/TSYSCLK are  
locked to RCLK/TCLK, respectively) (Table 19-A).  
Table 19-A. Elastic Store Delay After Initialization  
INITIALIZATION  
REGISTER BIT  
DELAY  
Receive Elastic Store Reset  
Transmit Elastic Store Reset  
Receive Elastic Store Align  
Transmit Elastic Store Align  
ESCR.2  
ESCR.6  
ESCR.3  
ESCR.7  
8 Clocks < Delay < 1 Frame  
1 Frame < Delay < 2 Frames  
½ Frame < Delay < 1 ½ Frames  
½ Frame < Delay < 1 ½ Frames  
19.4Minimum Delay Mode  
Elastic store minimum delay mode can be used when the elastic store’s system clock is locked to its  
network clock (i.e., RCLK locked to RSYSCLK for the receive side and TCLK locked to TSYSCLK for  
the transmit side). ESCR.5 and ESCR.1 enable the transmit and receive elastic store minimum delay  
modes. When enabled, the elastic stores are forced to a maximum depth of 32 bits instead of the normal  
two-frame depth. This feature is useful primarily in applications that interface to a 2.048MHz bus.  
Certain restrictions apply when minimum delay mode is used. In addition to the restriction mentioned  
above, RSYNC must be configured as an output when the receive elastic store is in minimum delay  
mode; TSYNC must be configured as an output when transmit minimum delay mode is enabled. In a  
typical application, RSYSCLK and TSYSCLK are locked to RCLK, and RSYNC (frame output mode) is  
connected to TSSYNC (frame input mode). All of the slip contention logic in the framer is disabled (since  
slips cannot occur). On power-up, after the RSYSCLK and TSYSCLK signals have locked to their  
respective network clock signals, the elastic store reset bits (ESCR.2 and ESCR.6) should be toggled  
from a 0 to a 1 to ensure proper operation.  
108 of 238  
 
DS2155  
20. G.706 INTERMEDIATE CRC-4 UPDATING (E1 MODE ONLY)  
The DS2155 can implement the G.706 CRC-4 recalculation at intermediate path points. When this mode  
is enabled, the data stream presented at TSER already has the FAS/NFAS, CRC multiframe alignment  
word, and CRC-4 checksum in time slot 0. The user can modify the Sa bit positions. This change in data  
content is used to modify the CRC-4 checksum. This modification, however, does not corrupt any error  
information the original CRC-4 checksum may contain. In this mode of operation, TSYNC must be  
configured to multiframe mode. The data at TSER must be aligned to the TSYNC signal. If TSYNC is an  
input, then the user must assert TSYNC aligned at the beginning of the multiframe relative to TSER. If  
TSYNC is an output, the user must multiframe-align the data presented to TSER.  
Figure 20-1. CRC-4 Recalculate Method  
TPOSO/TNEGO  
INSERT  
EXTRACT  
OLD CRC-4  
CODE  
NEW CRC-4  
CODE  
TSER  
CRC-4  
XOR  
MODIFY  
Sa BIT  
CALCULATOR  
+
POSITIONS  
NEW Sa BIT  
DATA  
109 of 238  
DS2155  
21. T1 BIT-ORIENTED CODE (BOC) CONTROLLER  
The DS2155 contains a BOC generator on the transmit side and a BOC detector on the receive side. The  
BOC function is available only in T1 mode.  
21.1Transmit BOC  
Bits 0 to 5 in the TFDL register contain the BOC message to be transmitted. Setting BOCC.0 = 1 causes  
the transmit BOC controller to immediately begin inserting the BOC sequence into the FDL bit position.  
The transmit BOC controller automatically provides the abort sequence. BOC messages are transmitted as  
long as BOCC.0 is set.  
Transmit a BOC  
1) Write 6-bit code into the TFDL register.  
2) Set the SBOC bit in BOCC = 1.  
21.2Receive BOC  
The receive BOC function is enabled by setting BOCC.4 = 1. The RFDL register now operates as the  
receive BOC message and information register. The lower six bits of the RFDL register (BOC message  
bits) are preset to all 1s. When the BOC bits change state, the BOC change-of-state indicator, SR8.0,  
alerts the host. The host then reads the RFDL register to get the BOC status and message. A change-of-  
state occurs when either a new BOC code has been present for a time determined by the receive BOC  
filter bits RBF0 and RBF1 in the BOCC register, or a nonvalid code is being received.  
Receive a BOC  
1) Set integration time through BOCC.1 and BOCC.2.  
2) Enable the receive BOC function (BOCC.4 = 1).  
3) Enable interrupt (IMR8.0 = 1).  
4) Wait for interrupt to occur.  
5) Read the RFDL register.  
6) If SR2.7 = 1, then a valid BOC message was received.  
– The lower six bits of the RFDL register comprise the message.  
110 of 238  
 
DS2155  
Register Name:  
BOCC  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BOC Control Register  
37h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
RBOCE  
0
3
RBR  
0
2
RBF1  
0
1
RBF0  
0
0
SBOC  
0
Bit 0/Send BOC (SBOC). Set = 1 to transmit the BOC code placed in bits 0 to 5 of the TFDL register.  
Bits 1 and 2/Receive BOC Filter Bits (RBF0, RBF1). The BOC filter sets the number of consecutive patterns that  
must be received without error prior to an indication of a valid message.  
Consecutive BOC Codes for  
RBF1  
RBF0  
Valid Sequence Identification  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
None  
3
5
7
Bit 3/Receive BOC Reset (RBR). A 0-to-1 transition resets the BOC circuitry. Must be cleared and set again for a  
subsequent reset.  
Bit 4/Receive BOC Enable (RBOCE). Enables the receive BOC function. The RFDL register reports the received  
BOC code and two information bits when this bit is set.  
0 = receive BOC function disabled  
1 = receive BOC function enabled; the RFDL register reports BOC messages and information  
Bits 5 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
Register Name:  
RFDL  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive FDL Register  
C0h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
RBOC5 RBOC4 RBOC3 RBOC2 RBOC1 RBOC0  
0
0
0
0
0
0
RFDL register bit definitions when BOCC.4 = 1:  
Bit 0/BOC Bit 0 (RBOC0)  
Bit 1/BOC Bit 1 (RBOC1)  
Bit 2/BOC Bit 2 (RBOC2)  
Bit 3/BOC Bit 3 (RBOC3)  
Bit 4/BOC Bit 4 (RBOC4)  
Bit 5/BOC Bit 5 (RBOC5)  
Bits 6, 7/This bit position is unused when BOCC.4 = 1.  
111 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
SR8  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Status Register 8  
24h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
BOCC RFDLAD RFDLF TFDLE RMTCH RBOC  
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive BOC Detector Change-of-State Event (RBOC). Set whenever the BOC detector sees a change of  
state to a valid BOC. The setting of this bit prompts the user to read the RFDL register.  
Bit 1/Receive FDL Match Event (RMTCH). Set whenever the contents of the RFDL register matches RFDLM1  
or RFDLM2.  
Bit 2/TFDL Register Empty Event (TFDLE). Set when the transmit FDL buffer (TFDL) empties.  
Bit 3/RFDL Register Full Event (RFDLF). Set when the receive FDL buffer (RFDL) fills to capacity.  
Bit 4/RFDL Abort Detect Event (RFDLAD). Set when eight consecutive 1s are received on the FDL.  
Bit 5/BOC Clear Event (BOCC). Set when 30 FDL bits occur without an abort sequence.  
Register Name:  
IMR8  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Interrupt Mask Register 8  
25h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
BOCC  
0
4
RFDLAD  
0
3
RFDLF  
0
2
1
0
RBOC  
0
TFDLE RMTCH  
0
0
Bit 0/Receive BOC Detector Change-of-State Event (RBOC)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 1/Receive FDL Match Event (RMTCH)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 2/TFDL Register Empty Event (TFDLE)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 3/RFDL Register Full Event (RFDLF)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 4/RFDL Abort Detect Event (RFDLAD)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 5/BOC Clear Event (BOCC)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
112 of 238  
DS2155  
22. ADDITIONAL (SA) AND INTERNATIONAL (SI) BIT OPERATION (E1  
ONLY)  
When operated in the E1 mode, the DS2155 provides three methods for accessing the Sa and the Si bits.  
The first method involves a hardware scheme that uses the RLINK/RLCLK and TLINK/TLCLK pins  
(Section 22.1). The second method involves using the internal RAF/RNAF and TAF/TNAF registers  
(Section 22.2). The third method, which is covered in Section 22.3, involves an expanded version of the  
second method.  
22.1Method 1: Hardware Scheme  
On the receive side, all of the received data is reported at the RLINK pin. Using the E1RCR2 register, the  
user can control the RLCLK pin to pulse during any combination of Sa bits. This allows the user to create  
a clock that can be used to capture the needed Sa bits. If RSYNC is programmed to output a frame  
boundary, it identifies the Si bits.  
On the transmit side, the individual Sa bits can be either sourced from the internal TNAF register (Section  
22.2) or externally from the TLINK pin. Using the E1TCR2 register, the framer can be programmed to  
source any combination of the Sa bits from the TLINK pin. Si bits can be sampled through the TSER pin  
if by setting E1TCR1.4 = 0.  
22.2Method 2: Internal Register Scheme Based on Double-Frame  
On the receive side, the RAF and RNAF registers always report the data as it received in the Sa and Si bit  
locations. The RAF and RNAF registers are updated on align-frame boundaries. The setting of the receive  
align frame bit in Status Register 4 (SR4.0) indicates that the contents of the RAF and RNAF have been  
updated. The host can use the SR4.0 bit to know when to read the RAF and RNAF registers. The host has  
250µs to retrieve the data before it is lost.  
On the transmit side, data is sampled from the TAF and TNAF registers with the setting of the transmit  
align frame bit in Status Register 4 (SR4.3). The host can use the SR4.3 bit to know when to update the  
TAF and TNAF registers. It has 250µs to update the data or else the old data is retransmitted. If the TAF  
and TNAF registers are only being used to source the align frame and nonalign frame-sync  
patterns, then the host need only write once to these registers. Data in the Si bit position is  
overwritten if either the framer is (1) programmed to source the Si bits from the TSER pin, (2) in the  
CRC4 mode, or (3) has automatic E-bit insertion enabled. Data in the Sa bit position is overwritten if any  
of the E1TCR2.3 to E1TCR2.7 bits are set to 1.  
113 of 238  
 
 
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RAF  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Align Frame Register  
C6h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
Si  
0
6
0
0
5
0
0
4
1
0
3
1
0
2
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
Bit 0/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)  
Bit 1/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)  
Bit 2/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)  
Bit 3/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)  
Bit 4/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)  
Bit 5/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)  
Bit 6/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)  
Bit 7/International Bit (Si)  
Register Name:  
RNAF  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Nonalign Frame Register  
C7h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
Si  
0
6
1
0
5
A
0
4
Sa4  
0
3
Sa5  
0
2
Sa6  
0
1
Sa7  
0
0
Sa8  
0
Bit 0/Additional Bit 8 (Sa8)  
Bit 1/Additional Bit 7 (Sa7)  
Bit 2/Additional Bit 6 (Sa6)  
Bit 3/Additional Bit 5 (Sa5)  
Bit 4/Additional Bit 4 (Sa4)  
Bit 5/Remote Alarm (A)  
Bit 6/Frame Nonalignment Signal Bit (1)  
Bit 7/International Bit (Si)  
114 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
TAF  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Align Frame Register  
D0h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
Si  
0
6
0
0
5
0
0
4
1
1
3
1
1
2
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
Bit 0/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)  
Bit 1/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)  
Bit 2/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)  
Bit 3/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)  
Bit 4/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)  
Bit 5/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)  
Bit 6/Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)  
Bit 7/International Bit (Si)  
Register Name:  
TNAF  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Nonalign Frame Register  
D1h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
Si  
0
6
1
1
5
A
0
4
Sa4  
0
3
Sa5  
0
2
Sa6  
0
1
Sa7  
0
0
Sa8  
0
Bit 0/Additional Bit 8 (Sa8)  
Bit 1/Additional Bit 7 (Sa7)  
Bit 2/Additional Bit 6 (Sa6)  
Bit 3/Additional Bit 5 (Sa5)  
Bit 4/Additional Bit 4 (Sa4)  
Bit 5/Remote Alarm [used to transmit the alarm (A)]  
Bit 6/Frame Nonalignment Signal Bit (1)  
Bit 7/International Bit (Si)  
115 of 238  
DS2155  
22.3 Method 3: Internal Register Scheme Based on CRC4 Multiframe  
The receive side contains a set of eight registers (RSiAF, RSiNAF, RRA, and RSa4–RSa8) that report the  
Si and Sa bits as they are received. These registers are updated with the setting of the receive CRC4  
multiframe bit in Status Register 2 (SR4.1). The host can use the SR4.1 bit to know when to read these  
registers. The user has 2ms to retrieve the data before it is lost. The MSB of each register is the first  
received. See the following register descriptions for more details.  
The transmit side also contains a set of eight registers (TSiAF, TSiNAF, TRA, and TSa4–TSa8) that,  
through the transmit Sa bit control register (TSaCR), can be programmed to insert Si and Sa data. Data is  
sampled from these registers with the setting of the transmit multiframe bit in Status Register 2 (SR4.4).  
The host can use the SR4.4 bit to know when to update these registers. It has 2ms to update the data or  
else the old data is retransmitted. The MSB of each register is the first bit transmitted. See the following  
register descriptions for more details.  
Register Name:  
RSiAF  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Received Si Bits of the Align Frame  
C8h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
SiF0  
0
6
SiF2  
0
5
SiF4  
0
4
SiF6  
0
3
SiF8  
0
2
SiF10  
0
1
SiF12  
0
0
SiF14  
0
Bit 0/Si Bit of Frame 14 (SiF14)  
Bit 1/Si Bit of Frame 12 (SiF12)  
Bit 2/Si Bit of Frame 10 (SiF10)  
Bit 3/Si Bit of Frame 8 (SiF8)  
Bit 4/Si Bit of Frame 6 (SiF6)  
Bit 5/Si Bit of Frame 4 (SiF4)  
Bit 6/Si Bit of Frame 2 (SiF2)  
Bit 7/Si Bit of Frame 0 (SiF0)  
116 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RSiNAF  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Received Si Bits of the Nonalign Frame  
C9h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
SiF1  
0
6
SiF3  
0
5
SiF5  
0
4
SiF7  
0
3
SiF9  
0
2
SiF11  
0
1
SiF13  
0
0
SiF15  
0
Bit 0/Si Bit of Frame 15 (SiF15)  
Bit 1/Si Bit of Frame 13 (SiF13)  
Bit 2/Si Bit of Frame 11 (SiF11)  
Bit 3/Si Bit of Frame 9 (SiF9)  
Bit 4/Si Bit of Frame 7 (SiF7)  
Bit 5/Si Bit of Frame 5 (SiF5)  
Bit 6/Si Bit of Frame 3 (SiF3)  
Bit 7/Si Bit of Frame 1 (SiF1)  
Register Name:  
RRA  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Received Remote Alarm  
Cah  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
RRAF5  
0
4
3
2
1
0
RRAF1 RRAF3  
RRAF7 RRAF9 RRAF11 RRAF13 RRAF15  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 15 (RRAF15)  
Bit 1/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 13 (RRAF13)  
Bit 2/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 11 (RRAF11)  
Bit 3/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 9 (RRAF9)  
Bit 4/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 7 (RRAF7)  
Bit 5/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 5 (RRAF5)  
Bit 6/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 3 (RRAF3)  
Bit 7/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 1 (RRAF1)  
117 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RSa4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Received Sa4 Bits  
CBh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
RSa4F1  
0
6
RSa4F3  
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
RSa4F5 RSa4F7 RSa4F9 RSa4F11 RSa4F13 RSa4F15  
0 0  
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa4 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa4F15)  
Bit 1/Sa4 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa4F13)  
Bit 2/Sa4 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa4F11)  
Bit 3/Sa4 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa4F9)  
Bit 4/Sa4 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa4F7)  
Bit 5/Sa4 Bit of Frame 5(RSa4F5)  
Bit 6/Sa4 Bit of Frame 3 (RSa4F3)  
Bit 7/Sa4 Bit of Frame 1 (RSa4F1)  
Register Name:  
RSa5  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Received Sa5 Bits  
CCh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
RSa5F1  
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RSa5F3 RSa5F5 RSa5F7 RSa5F9 RSa5F11 RSa5F13 RSa5F15  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa5 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa5F15)  
Bit 1/Sa5 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa5F13)  
Bit 2/Sa5 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa5F11)  
Bit 3/Sa5 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa5F9)  
Bit 4/Sa5 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa5F7)  
Bit 5/Sa5 Bit of Frame 5 (RSa5F5)  
Bit 6/Sa5 Bit of Frame 3 (RSa5F3)  
Bit 7/Sa5 Bit of Frame 1 (RSa5F1)  
118 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RSa6  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Received Sa6 Bits  
CDh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
RSa6F1  
0
6
RSa6F3  
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
RSa6F5 RSa6F7 RSa6F9 RSa6F11 RSa6F13 RSa6F15  
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa6 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa6F15)  
Bit 1/Sa6 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa6F13)  
Bit 2/Sa6 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa6F11)  
Bit 3/Sa6 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa6F9)  
Bit 4/Sa6 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa6F7)  
Bit 5/Sa6 Bit of Frame 5 (RSa6F5)  
Bit 6/Sa6 Bit of Frame 4 (RSa6F4)  
Bit 7/Sa6 Bit of Frame 3(RSa6F3)  
Register Name:  
RSa7  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Received Sa7 Bits  
CEh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
RSa7F1  
0
6
Rsa7F3  
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
RSa7F5 RSa7F7 RSa7F9 RSa7F11 RSa7F13 RSa7F15  
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa7 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa7F15)  
Bit 1/Sa7 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa7F13)  
Bit 2/Sa7 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa7F11)  
Bit 3/Sa7 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa7F9)  
Bit 4/Sa7 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa7F7)  
Bit 5/Sa7 Bit of Frame 5 (RSa7F5)  
Bit 6/Sa7 Bit of Frame 3 (RSa7F3)  
Bit 7/Sa7 Bit of Frame 1(RSa4F1)  
119 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RSa8  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Received Sa8 Bits  
CFh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
RSa8F1  
0
6
RSa8F3  
0
5
RSa8F5  
0
4
RSa8F7  
0
3
2
1
0
RSa8F9 RSa8F11 RSa8F13 RSa8F15  
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa8 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa8F15)  
Bit 1/Sa8 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa8F13)  
Bit 2/Sa8 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa8F11)  
Bit 3/Sa8 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa8F9)  
Bit 4/Sa8 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa8F7)  
Bit 5/Sa8 Bit of Frame 5 (RSa8F5)  
Bit 6/Sa8 Bit of Frame 3 (RSa8F3)  
Bit 7/Sa8 Bit of Frame 1 (RSa8F1)  
Register Name:  
TSiAF  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Si Bits of the Align Frame  
D2h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
TSiF0  
0
6
TSiF2  
0
5
TSiF4  
0
4
TSiF6  
0
3
TSiF8  
0
2
1
0
TSiF10 TSiF12  
TSiF14  
0
0
0
Bit 0/Si Bit of Frame 14 (TSiF14)  
Bit 1/Si Bit of Frame 12 (TSiF12)  
Bit 2/Si Bit of Frame 10 (TSiF10)  
Bit 3/Si Bit of Frame 8 (TSiF8)  
Bit 4/Si Bit of Frame 6 (TSiF6)  
Bit 5/Si Bit of Frame 4 (TSiF4)  
Bit 6/Si Bit of Frame 2 (TSiF2)  
Bit 7/Si Bit of Frame 0 (TSiF0)  
120 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
TSiNAF  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Si Bits of the Nonalign Frame  
D3h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
TSiF1  
0
6
TSiF3  
0
5
TSiF5  
0
4
TSiF7  
0
3
TSiF9  
0
2
1
0
TSiF15  
0
TSiF11 TSiF13  
0
0
Bit 0/Si Bit of Frame 15 (TSiF15)  
Bit 1/Si Bit of Frame 13 (TSiF13)  
Bit 2/Si Bit of Frame 11 (TSiF11)  
Bit 3/Si Bit of Frame 9 (TSiF9)  
Bit 4/Si Bit of Frame 7 (TSiF7)  
Bit 5/Si Bit of Frame 5 (TSiF5)  
Bit 6/Si Bit of Frame 3 (TSiF3)  
Bit 7/Si Bit of Frame 1 (TSiF1)  
Register Name:  
TRA  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Remote Alarm  
D4h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
TRAF1  
0
6
TRAF3  
0
5
TRAF5  
0
4
3
2
1
0
TRAF7 TRAF9 TRAF11 TRAF13 TRAF15  
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 15 (TRAF15)  
Bit 1/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 13 (TRAF13)  
Bit 2/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 11 (TRAF11)  
Bit 3/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 9 (TRAF9)  
Bit 4/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 7 (TRAF7)  
Bit 5/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 5 (TRAF5)  
Bit 6/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 3 (TRAF3)  
Bit 7/Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 1 (TRAF1)  
121 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
TSa4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Sa4 Bits  
D5h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
TSa4F1  
0
6
TSa4F3  
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
TSa4F5 TSa4F7 TSa4F9 TSa4F11 TSa4F13 TSa4F15  
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa4 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa4F15)  
Bit 1/Sa4 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa4F13)  
Bit 2/Sa4 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa4F11)  
Bit 3/Sa4 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa4F9)  
Bit 4/Sa4 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa4F7)  
Bit 5/Sa4 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa4F5)  
Bit 6/Sa4 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa4F3)  
Bit 7/Sa4 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa4F1)  
Register Name:  
TSa5  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmitted Sa5 Bits  
D6h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
TSa5F1  
0
6
TSa5F3  
0
5
TSa5F5  
0
4
3
TSa5F9  
0
2
1
0
TSa5F7  
0
TSa5F11 TSa5F13  
TSa5F15  
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa5 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa5F15)  
Bit 1/Sa5 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa5F13)  
Bit 2/Sa5 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa5F11)  
Bit 3/Sa5 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa5F9)  
Bit 4/Sa5 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa5F7)  
Bit 5/Sa5 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa5F5)  
Bit 6/Sa5 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa5F3)  
Bit 7/Sa5 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa5F1)  
122 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
TSa6  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Sa6 Bits  
D7h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
TSa6F1  
0
6
TSa6F3  
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
TSa6F5 TSa6F7 TSa6F9 TSa6F11 TSa6F13 TSa6F15  
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa6 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa6F15)  
Bit 1/Sa6 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa6F13)  
Bit 2/Sa6 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa6F11)  
Bit 3/Sa6 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa6F9)  
Bit 4/Sa6 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa6F7)  
Bit 5/Sa6 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa6F5)  
Bit 6/Sa6 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa6F3)  
Bit 7/Sa6 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa6F1)  
Register Name:  
TSa7  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Sa7 Bits  
D8h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
TSa7F1  
0
6
TSa7F3  
0
5
TSa7F5  
0
4
3
2
1
0
TSa7F7 TSa7F9 TSa7F11 TSa7F13 TSa7F15  
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa7 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa7F15)  
Bit 1/Sa7 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa7F13)  
Bit 2/Sa7 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa7F11)  
Bit 3/Sa7 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa7F9)  
Bit 4/Sa7 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa7F7)  
Bit 5/Sa7 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa7F5)  
Bit 6/Sa7 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa7F3)  
Bit 7/Sa7 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa4F1)  
123 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
TSa8  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Sa8 Bits  
D9h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
TSa8F1  
0
6
TSa8F3  
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
TSa8F5 TSa8F7 TSa8F9 TSa8F11 TSa8F13 TSa8F15  
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Sa8 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa8F15)  
Bit 1/Sa8 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa8F13)  
Bit 2/Sa8 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa8F11)  
Bit 3/Sa8 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa8F9)  
Bit 4/Sa8 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa8F7)  
Bit 5/Sa8 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa8F5)  
Bit 6/Sa8 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa8F3)  
Bit 7/Sa8 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa8F1)  
124 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
TSACR  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Sa Bit Control Register  
DAh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
SiAF  
0
6
SiNAF  
0
5
RA  
0
4
Sa4  
0
3
Sa5  
0
2
Sa6  
0
1
Sa7  
0
0
Sa8  
0
Bit 0/Additional Bit 8 Insertion Control Bit (Sa8)  
0 = do not insert data from the TSa8 register into the transmit data stream  
1 = insert data from the TSa8 register into the transmit data stream  
Bit 1/Additional Bit 7 Insertion Control Bit (Sa7)  
0 = do not insert data from the TSa7 register into the transmit data stream  
1 = insert data from the TSa7 register into the transmit data stream  
Bit 2/Additional Bit 6 Insertion Control Bit (Sa6)  
0 = do not insert data from the TSa6 register into the transmit data stream  
1 = insert data from the TSa6 register into the transmit data stream  
Bit 3/Additional Bit 5 Insertion Control Bit (Sa5)  
0 = do not insert data from the TSa5 register into the transmit data stream  
1 = insert data from the TSa5 register into the transmit data stream  
Bit 4/Additional Bit 4 Insertion Control Bit (Sa4)  
0 = do not insert data from the TSa4 register into the transmit data stream  
1 = insert data from the TSa4 register into the transmit data stream  
Bit 5/Remote Alarm Insertion Control Bit (RA)  
0 = do not insert data from the TRA register into the transmit data stream  
1 = insert data from the TRA register into the transmit data stream  
Bit 6/International Bit in Nonalign Frame Insertion Control Bit (SiNAF)  
0 = do not insert data from the TSiNAF register into the transmit data stream  
1 = insert data from the TSiNAF register into the transmit data stream  
Bit 7/International Bit in Align Frame Insertion Control Bit (SiAF)  
0 = do not insert data from the TSiAF register into the transmit data stream  
1 = insert data from the TSiAF register into the transmit data stream  
125 of 238  
DS2155  
23. HDLC CONTROLLERS  
This device has two enhanced HDLC controllers, HDLC #1 and HDLC #2. Each controller is  
configurable for use with time slots, Sa4 to Sa8 bits (E1 mode), or the FDL (T1 mode). Each HDLC  
controller has 128-byte buffers in the transmit and receive paths. When used with time slots, the user can  
select any time slot or multiple time slots, contiguous or noncontiguous, as well as any specific bits  
within the time slot(s) to assign to the HDLC controllers.  
The user must not map both transmit HDLC controllers to the same Sa bits, time slots or, in T1 mode,  
map both controllers to the FDL. HDLC #1 and HDLC #2 are identical in operation and therefore the  
following operational description refers only to a singular controller.  
The HDLC controller performs the entire necessary overhead for generating and receiving performance  
report messages (PRMs) as described in ANSI T1.403 and the messages as described in AT&T TR54016.  
The HDLC controller automatically generates and detects flags, generates and checks the CRC check  
sum, generates and detects abort sequences, stuffs and destuffs zeros, and byte aligns to the data stream.  
The 128-byte buffers in the HDLC controller are large enough to allow a full PRM to be received or  
transmitted without host intervention.  
23.1 Basic Operation Details  
The HDLC registers are divided into four groups: control/configuration, status/information, mapping, and  
FIFOs. Table 23-A lists these registers by group.  
23.2 HDLC Configuration  
The HxTC and HxRC registers perform the basic configuration of the HDLC controllers. Operating  
features such as CRC generation, zero stuffer, transmit and receive HDLC mapping options, and idle  
flags are selected here. These registers also reset the HDLC controllers.  
126 of 238  
 
DS2155  
Table 23-A. HDLC Controller Registers  
REGISTER  
FUNCTION  
CONTROL AND CONFIGURATION  
H1TC, HDLC #1 Transmit Control Register  
H2TC, HDLC #2 Transmit Control Register  
H1RC, HDLC #1 Receive Control Register  
H2RC, HDLC #2 Receive Control Register  
H1FC, HDLC #1 FIFO Control Register  
H2FC, HDLC #2 FIFO Control Register  
General control over the transmit HDLC  
controllers  
General control over the receive HDLC  
controllers  
Sets high watermark for receiver and low  
watermark for transmitter  
STATUS AND INFORMATION  
SR6, HDLC #1 Status Register  
Key status information for both transmit and  
receive directions  
SR7, HDLC #2 Status Register  
IMR6, HDLC #1 Interrupt Mask Register  
IMR7, HDLC #2 Interrupt Mask Register  
INFO4, HDLC #1 and #2 Information Register  
INFO5, HDLC #1 Information Register  
INFO6, HDLC #2 Information Register  
H1RPBA, HDLC #1 Receive Packet Bytes  
Available Register  
Selects which bits in the status registers (SR7  
and SR8) cause interrupts  
Information about HDLC controller  
Indicates the number of bytes that can be read  
from the receive FIFO  
H2RPBA, HDLC #2 Receive Packet Bytes  
Available Register  
H1TFBA, HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO Buffer  
Available Register  
Indicates the number of bytes that can be  
written to the transmit FIFO  
H2TFBA, HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO Buffer  
Available Register  
MAPPING  
H1RCS1, H1RCS2, H1RCS3, H1RCS4, HDLC Selects which channels are mapped to the  
#1 Receive Channel Select Registers  
H2RCS1, H2RCS2, H2RCS3, H2RCS4, HDLC  
#2 Receive Channel Select Registers  
H1RTSBS, HDLC #1 Receive TS/Sa Bit Select  
Register  
receive HDLC controller  
Selects which bits in a channel are used or  
which Sa bits are used by the receive HDLC  
controller  
H2RTSBS, HDLC #2 Receive TS/Sa Bit Select  
Register  
H1TCS1, H1TCS2, H1TCS3, H1TCS4, HDLC  
#1 Transmit Channel Select Registers  
H2TCS1, H2TCS2, H2TCS3, H2TCS4, HDLC  
#2 Transmit Channel Select Registers  
Selects which channels are mapped to the  
transmit HDLC controller  
H1TTSBS, HDLC # 1 Transmit TS/Sa Bit Select Selects which bits in a channel are used or  
Register  
which Sa bits are used by the transmit HDLC  
H2TTSBS, HDLC # 2 Transmit TS/Sa Bit Select controller  
Register  
FIFOs  
H1RF, HDLC #1 Receive FIFO Register  
H2RF, HDLC #1 Receive FIFO Register  
H1TF, HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO Register  
H2TF, HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO Register  
Access to 128-byte receive FIFO  
Access to 128-byte transmit FIFO  
127 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
H1TC, H2TC  
Register Description:  
HDLC #1 Transmit Control  
HDLC #2 Transmit Control  
90h, A0h  
Register Address:  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
THR  
0
4
THMS  
0
3
TFS  
0
2
TEOM  
0
1
TZSD  
0
0
TCRCD  
0
NOFS TEOML  
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit CRC Defeat (TCRCD). A 2-byte CRC code is automatically appended to the outbound message.  
This bit can be used to disable the CRC function.  
0 = enable CRC generation (normal operation)  
1 = disable CRC generation  
Bit 1/Transmit Zero-Stuffer Defeat (TZSD). The zero-stuffer function automatically inserts a 0 in the message  
field (between the flags) after five consecutive 1s to prevent the emulation of a flag or abort sequence by the data  
pattern. The receiver automatically removes (destuffs) any 0 after five 1s in the message field.  
0 = enable the zero stuffer (normal operation)  
1 = disable the zero stuffer  
Bit 2/Transmit End of Message (TEOM). Should be set to a 1 just before the last data byte of an HDLC packet is  
written into the transmit FIFO at HxTF. If not disabled through TCRCD, the transmitter automatically appends a 2-  
byte CRC code to the end of the message.  
Bit 3/Transmit Flag/Idle Select (TFS). This bit selects the intermessage fill character after the closing and before  
the opening flags (7Eh).  
0 = 7Eh  
1 = FFh  
Bit 4/Transmit HDLC Mapping Select (THMS)  
0 = transmit HDLC assigned to channels  
1 = transmit HDLC assigned to FDL (T1 mode), Sa bits (E1 mode)  
Bit 5/Transmit HDLC Reset (THR). Resets the transmit HDLC controller and flushes the transmit FIFO. An  
abort followed by 7Eh or FFh flags/idle is transmitted until a new packet is initiated by writing new data into the  
FIFO. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent reset.  
0 = normal operation  
1 = reset transmit HDLC controller and flush the transmit FIFO  
Bit 6/Transmit End of Message and Loop (TEOML). To loop on a message, this bit should be set to a 1 just  
before the last data byte of an HDLC packet is written into the transmit FIFO. The message repeats until the user  
clears this bit or a new message is written to the transmit FIFO. If the host clears the bit, the looping message  
completes, then flags are transmitted until a new message is written to the FIFO. If the host terminates the loop by  
writing a new message to the FIFO, the loop terminates, one or two flags are transmitted, and the new message  
starts. If not disabled through TCRCD, the transmitter automatically appends a 2-byte CRC code to the end of all  
messages. This is useful for transmitting consecutive SS7 FISUs without host intervention.  
Bit 7/Number of Flags Select (NOFS)  
0 = send one flag between consecutive messages  
1 = send two flags between consecutive messages  
128 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
H1RC, H2RC  
Register Description:  
HDLC #1 Receive Control  
HDLC #2 Receive Control  
31h, 32h  
Register Address:  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
RHR  
0
6
RHMS  
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
0
0
RSFD  
0
Bit 0/Receive SS7 Fill-In Signal Unit Delete (RSFD)  
0 = normal operation; all FISUs are stored in the receive FIFO and reported to the host.  
1 = When a consecutive FISU having the same BSN the previous FISU is detected, it is deleted without  
host intervention.  
Bits 1 to 5/Unused, must be set to 0 or proper operation  
Bit 6/Receive HDLC Mapping Select (RHMS)  
0 = receive HDLC assigned to channels  
1 = receive HDLC assigned to FDL (T1 mode), Sa bits (E1 mode)  
Bit 7/Receive HDLC Reset (RHR). Resets the receive HDLC controller and flushes the receive FIFO. Must be  
cleared and set again for a subsequent reset.  
0 = normal operation  
1 = reset receive HDLC controller and flush the receive FIFO  
129 of 238  
DS2155  
23.2.1 FIFO Control  
The FIFO control register (HxFC) controls and sets the watermarks for the transmit and receive FIFOs.  
Bits 3, 4, and 5 set the transmit low watermark and the lower 3 bits set the receive high watermark.  
When the transmit FIFO empties below the low watermark, the TLWM bit in the appropriate HDLC  
status register SR6 or SR7 is set. TLWM is a real-time bit and remains set as long as the transmit FIFO’s  
read pointer is below the watermark. If enabled, this condition can also cause an interrupt through the INT  
pin.  
When the receive FIFO fills above the high watermark, the RHWM bit in the appropriate HDLC status  
register is set. RHWM is a real-time bit and remains set as long as the receive FIFO’s write pointer is  
above the watermark. If enabled, this condition can also cause an interrupt through the INT pin.  
Register Name:  
H1FC, H2FC  
Register Description:  
HDLC # 1 FIFO Control  
HDLC # 2 FIFO Control  
91h, A1h  
Register Address:  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
TFLWM2  
0
4
3
2
1
0
TFLWM1  
0
TFLWM0 RFHWM2 RFHWM1 RFHWM0  
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 2/Receive FIFO High-Watermark Select (RFHWM0 to RFHWM2)  
Receive FIFO Watermark  
RFHWM2 RFHWM1 RFHWM0  
(bytes)  
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
4
16  
32  
48  
64  
80  
96  
112  
Bits 3 to 5/Transmit FIFO Low-Watermark Select (TFLWM0 to TFLWM2)  
Transmit FIFO Watermark  
TFLWM2  
TFLWM1  
TFLWM0  
(bytes)  
4
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
16  
32  
48  
64  
80  
96  
112  
Bits 6, 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
130 of 238  
DS2155  
23.3HDLC Mapping  
23.3.1 Receive  
The HDLC controllers must be assigned a space in the T1/E1 bandwidth in which they transmit and  
receive data. The controllers can be mapped to either the FDL (T1), Sa bits (E1), or to channels. If  
mapped to channels, then any channel or combination of channels, contiguous or not, can be assigned to  
an HDLC controller. When assigned to a channel(s), any combination of bits within the channel(s) can be  
avoided.  
The HxRCS1–HxRCS4 registers are used to assign the receive controllers to channels 1–24 (T1) or  
1–32 (E1) according to the following table:  
Register  
Channels  
HxRCS1  
HxRCS2  
HxRCS3  
HxRCS4  
1–8  
9–16  
17–24  
25–32  
Register Name:  
H1RCS1, H1RCS2, H1RCS3, H1RCS4  
H2RCS1, H2RCS2, H2RCS3, H2RCS4  
HDLC # 1 Receive Channel Select x  
HDLC # 2 Receive Channel Select x  
92h, 93h, 94h, 95h  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
A2h, A3h, A4h, A5h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RHCS0  
0
RHCS7 RHCS6 RHCS5 RHCS4 RHCS3 RHCS2 RHCS1  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 0 (RHCS0). Select Channel 1, 9, 17, or 25.  
Bit 1/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 1 (RHCS1). Select Channel 2, 10, 18, or 26.  
Bit 2/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 2 (RHCS2). Select Channel 3, 11, 19, or 27.  
Bit 3/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 3 (RHCS3). Select Channel 4, 12, 20, or 28.  
Bit 4/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 4 (RHCS4). Select Channel 5, 13, 21, or 29.  
Bit 5/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 5 (RHCS5). Select Channel 6, 14, 22, or 30.  
Bit 6/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 6 (RHCS6). Select Channel 7, 15, 23, or 31.  
Bit 7/Receive HDLC Channel Select Bit 7 (RHCS7). Select Channel 8, 16, 24, or 32.  
131 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
H1RTSBS, H2RTSBS  
Register Description:  
HDLC # 1 Receive Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select  
HDLC # 2 Receive Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select  
96h, A6h  
Register Address:  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
RCB4SE  
0
2
1
0
RCB8SE RCB7SE RCB6SE RCB5SE  
RCB3SE RCB2SE RCB1SE  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Channel Bit 1 Suppress Enable/Sa8 Bit Enable (RCB1SE ). LSB of the channel. Set to 1 to stop  
this bit from being used.  
Bit 1/Receive Channel Bit 2 Suppress Enable/Sa7 Bit Enable (RCB2SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being  
used.  
Bit 2/Receive Channel Bit 3 Suppress Enable/Sa6 Bit Enable (RCB3SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being  
used.  
Bit 3/Receive Channel Bit 4 Suppress Enable/Sa5 Bit Enable (RCB4SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being  
used.  
Bit 4/Receive Channel Bit 5 Suppress Enable/Sa4 Bit Enable (RCB5SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being  
used.  
Bit 5/Receive Channel Bit 6 Suppress Enable (RCB6SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being used.  
Bit 6/Receive Channel Bit 7 Suppress Enable (RCB7SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being used.  
Bit 7/Receive Channel Bit 8 Suppress Enable (RCB8SE). MSB of the channel. Set to 1 to stop this bit from  
being used.  
132 of 238  
DS2155  
23.3.2 Transmit  
The HxTCS1–HxTCS4 registers are used to assign the transmit controllers to channels 1–24 (T1) or  
1–32 (E1) according to the following table.  
Register  
Channels  
HxTCS1  
HxTCS2  
HxTCS3  
HxTCS4  
1–8  
9–16  
17–24  
25–32  
Register Name:  
H1TCS1, H1TCS2, H1TCS3, H1TCS4  
H2TCS1, H2TCS2, H2TCS3, H2TCS4  
HDLC # 1 Transmit Channel Select  
HDLC # 2 Transmit Channel Select  
97h, 98h, 99h, 9Ah  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
A7h, A8h, A9h, AAh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
THCS7 THCS6 THCS5 THCS4 THCS3  
THCS2 THCS1 THCS0  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 0 (THCS0). Select Channel 1, 9, 17, or 25.  
Bit 1/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 1 (THCS1). Select Channel 2, 10, 18, or 26.  
Bit 2/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 2 (THCS2). Select Channel 3, 11, 19, or 27.  
Bit 3/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 3 (THCS3). Select Channel 4, 12, 20, or 28.  
Bit 4/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 4 (THCS4). Select Channel 5, 13, 21, or 29.  
Bit 5/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 5 (THCS5). Select Channel 6, 14, 22, or 30.  
Bit 6/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 6 (THCS6). Select Channel 7, 15, 23, or 31.  
Bit 7/Transmit HDLC Channel Select Bit 7 (THCS7). Select Channel 8, 16, 24, or 32.  
133 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
H1TTSBS, H2TTSBS  
Register Description:  
HDLC # 1 Transmit Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select  
HDLC # 2 Transmit Time Slot Bits/Sa Bits Select  
9Bh, ABh  
Register Address:  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TCB8SE TCB7SE TCB6SE TCB5SE TCB4SE TCB3SE TCB2SE TCB1SE  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit Channel Bit 1 Suppress Enable/Sa8 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). LSB of the channel. Set to 1 to stop  
this bit from being used.  
Bit 1/Transmit Channel Bit 2 Suppress Enable/Sa7 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being  
used.  
Bit 2/Transmit Channel Bit 3 Suppress Enable/Sa6 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being  
used.  
Bit 3/Transmit Channel Bit 4 Suppress Enable/Sa5 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being  
used.  
Bit 4/Transmit Channel Bit 5 Suppress Enable/Sa4 Bit Enable (TCB1SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being  
used.  
Bit 5/Transmit Channel Bit 6 Suppress Enable (TCB1SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being used.  
Bit 6/Transmit Channel Bit 7 Suppress Enable (TCB1SE). Set to 1 to stop this bit from being used.  
Bit 7/Transmit Channel Bit 8 Suppress Enable (TCB1SE). MSB of the channel. Set to 1 to stop this bit from  
being used.  
134 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
SR6, SR7  
Register Description:  
HDLC #1 Status Register 6  
HDLC #2 Status Register 7  
20h, 22h  
Register Address:  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
TMEND  
0
5
RPE  
0
4
RPS  
0
3
RHWM  
0
2
RNE  
0
1
TLWM  
0
0
TNF  
0
Bit 0/Transmit FIFO Not Full Condition (TNF). Set when the transmit 128-byte FIFO has at least 1 byte  
available.  
Bit 1/Transmit FIFO Below Low-Watermark Condition (TLWM). Set when the transmit 128-byte FIFO  
empties beyond the low watermark as defined by the transmit low-watermark register (TLWMR).  
Bit 2/Receive FIFO Not Empty Condition (RNE). Set when the receive 128-byte FIFO has at least 1 byte  
available for a read.  
Bit 3/Receive FIFO Above High-Watermark Condition (RHWM). Set when the receive 128-byte FIFO fills  
beyond the high watermark as defined by the receive high-watermark register (RHWMR).  
Bit 4/Receive Packet-Start Event (RPS). Set when the HDLC controller detects an opening byte. This is a latched  
bit and is cleared when read.  
Bit 5/Receive Packet-End Event (RPE). Set when the HDLC controller detects either the finish of a valid  
message (i.e., CRC check complete) or when the controller has experienced a message fault such as a CRC  
checking error, or an overrun condition, or an abort has been seen. This is a latched bit and is cleared when read.  
Bit 6/Transmit Message-End Event (TMEND). Set when the transmit HDLC controller has finished sending a  
message. This is a latched bit and is cleared when read.  
135 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
IMR6, IMR7  
Register Description:  
HDLC # 1 Interrupt Mask Register 6  
HDLC # 2 Interrupt Mask Register 7  
21h, 23h  
Register Address:  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
TMEND  
0
5
RPE  
0
4
RPS  
0
3
RHWM  
0
2
RNE  
0
1
TLWM  
0
0
TNF  
0
Bit 0/Transmit FIFO Not Full Condition (TNF)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only  
Bit 1/Transmit FIFO Below Low-Watermark Condition (TLWM)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only  
Bit 2/Receive FIFO Not Empty Condition (RNE)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only  
Bit 3/Receive FIFO Above High-Watermark Condition (RHWM)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising edge only  
Bit 4/Receive Packet-Start Event (RPS)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 5/Receive Packet-End Event (RPE)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 6/Transmit Message-End Event (TMEND)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
136 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
INFO5, INFO6  
Register Description:  
HDLC #1 Information Register  
HDLC #2 Information Register  
2Eh, 2Fh  
Register Address:  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
TEMPTY  
0
4
TFULL  
0
3
REMPTY  
0
2
PS2  
0
1
PS1  
0
0
PS0  
0
Bits 0 to 2/Receive Packet Status (PS0 to PS2). These are real-time bits indicating the status as of the last read of  
the receive FIFO.  
PS2  
PS1  
PS0  
Packet Status  
0
0
0
In Progress  
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
Packet OK: Packet ended with correct CRC codeword  
CRC Error: A closing flag was detected, preceded by a corrupt CRC  
codeword  
Abort: Packet ended because an abort signal was detected (seven or  
more 1s in a row).  
Overrun: HDLC controller terminated reception of packet because  
receive FIFO is full.  
Bit 3/Receive FIFO Empty (REMPTY). A real-time bit that is set high when the receive FIFO is empty.  
Bit 4/Transmit FIFO Full (TFULL). A real-time bit that is set high when the FIFO is full.  
Bit 5/Transmit FIFO Empty (TEMPTY). A real-time bit that is set high when the FIFO is empty.  
Register Name:  
INFO4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
HDLC Event Information Register #4  
2Dh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
2
1
0
H2UDR H2OBT H1UDR H1OBT  
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/HDLC #1 Opening Byte Event (H1OBT). Set when the next byte available in the receive FIFO is the first  
byte of a message.  
Bit 1/HDLC #1 Transmit FIFO Underrun Event (H1UDR). Set when the transmit FIFO empties out without  
having seen the TMEND bit set. An abort is automatically sent. This bit is latched and is cleared when read.  
Bit 2/HDLC #2 Opening Byte Event (H2OBT). Set when the next byte available in the receive FIFO is the first  
byte of a message.  
Bit 3/HDLC #2 Transmit FIFO Underrun Event (H2UDR). Set when the transmit FIFO empties out without  
having seen the TMEND bit set. An abort is automatically sent. This bit is latched and is cleared when read.  
137 of 238  
DS2155  
23.3.3 FIFO Information  
The transmit FIFO buffer-available register indicates the number of bytes that can be written into the  
transmit FIFO. The count form this register informs the host as to how many bytes can be written into the  
transmit FIFO without overflowing the buffer.  
Register Name:  
H1TFBA, H2TFBA  
Register Description:  
HDLC # 1 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available  
HDLC # 2 Transmit FIFO Buffer Available  
9Fh, Afh  
Register Address:  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TFBA7 TFBA6 TFBA5 TFBA4 TFBA3  
TFBA2 TFBA1 TFBA0  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Transmit FIFO Bytes Available (TFBAO to TFBA7). TFBA0 is the LSB.  
23.3.4 Receive Packet-Bytes Available  
The lower 7 bits of the receive packet-bytes available register indicates the number of bytes (0 through  
127) that can be read from the receive FIFO. The value indicated by this register (lower seven bits)  
informs the host as to how many bytes can be read from the receive FIFO without going past the end of a  
message. This value refers to one of four possibilities: the first part of a packet, the continuation of a  
packet, the last part of a packet, or a complete packet. After reading the number of bytes indicated by this  
register, the host then checks the HDLC information register for detailed message status.  
If the value in the HxRPBA register refers to the beginning portion of a message or continuation of a  
message, then the MSB of the HxRPBA register returns a value of 1. This indicates that the host can  
safely read the number of bytes returned by the lower seven bits of the HxRPBA register, but there is no  
need to check the information register since the packet has not yet terminated (successfully or otherwise).  
Register Name:  
H1RPBA, H2RPBA  
Register Description:  
HDLC # 1 Receive Packet Bytes Available  
HDLC # 2 Receive Packet Bytes Available  
9Ch, ACh  
Register Address:  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
MS  
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RPBA6 RPBA5 RPBA4 RPBA3  
RPBA2 RPBA1 RPBA0  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 6/Receive FIFO Packet Bytes Available Count (RPBA0 to RPBA6). RPBA0 is the LSB.  
Bit 7/Message Status (MS)  
0 = bytes indicated by RPBA0 through RPBA6 are the end of a message. Host must check the INFO5 or  
INFO6 register for details.  
1 = bytes indicated by RPBA0 through RPBA6 are the beginning or continuation of a message. The host  
does not need to check the INFO5 or INFO6 register.  
138 of 238  
DS2155  
23.3.5 HDLC FIFOs  
Register Name:  
H1TF, H2TF  
Register Description:  
HDLC # 1 Transmit FIFO  
HDLC # 2 Transmit FIFO  
9Dh, ADh  
Register Address:  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
THD7  
0
6
THD6  
0
5
THD5  
0
4
THD4  
0
3
THD3  
0
2
THD2  
0
1
THD1  
0
0
THD0  
0
Bit 0/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 0 (THD0). LSB of an HDLC packet data byte.  
Bit 1/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 1 (THD1)  
Bit 2/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 2 (THD2)  
Bit 3/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 3 (THD3)  
Bit 4/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 4 (THD4)  
Bit 5/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 5 (THD5)  
Bit 6/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 6 (THD6)  
Bit 7/Transmit HDLC Data Bit 7 (THD7). MSB of an HDLC packet data byte.  
Register Name:  
H1RF, H2RF  
Register Description:  
HDLC # 1 Receive FIFO  
HDLC # 2 Receive FIFO  
9Eh, AEh  
Register Address:  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
RHD7  
0
6
RHD6  
0
5
RHD5  
0
4
RHD4  
0
3
RHD3  
0
2
RHD2  
0
1
RHD1  
0
0
RHD0  
0
Bit 0/Receive HDLC Data Bit 0 (RHD0). LSB of an HDLC packet data byte.  
Bit 1/Receive HDLC Data Bit 1 (RHD1)  
Bit 2/Receive HDLC Data Bit 2 (RHD2)  
Bit 3/Receive HDLC Data Bit 3 (RHD3)  
Bit 4/Receive HDLC Data Bit 4 (RHD4)  
Bit 5/Receive HDLC Data Bit 5 (RHD5)  
Bit 6/Receive HDLC Data Bit 6 (RHD6)  
Bit 7/Receive HDLC Data Bit 7 (RHD7). MSB of an HDLC packet data byte.  
139 of 238  
DS2155  
23.4Receive HDLC Code Example  
The following is an example of a receive HDLC routine:  
1) Reset receive HDLC controller.  
2) Set HDLC mode, mapping, and high watermark.  
3) Start new message buffer.  
4) Enable RPE and RHWM interrupts.  
5) Wait for interrupt.  
6) Disable RPE and RHWM interrupts.  
7) Read HxRPBA register. N = HxRPBA (lower 7 bits are byte count, MSB is status).  
8) Read (N and 7Fh) bytes from receive FIFO and store in message buffer.  
9) Read INFO5 register.  
10) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 000, then go to Step 4.  
11) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 001, then packet terminated OK, save present message buffer.  
12) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 010, then packet terminated with CRC error.  
13) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 011, then packet aborted.  
14) If PS2, PS1, PS0 = 100, then FIFO overflowed.  
15) Go to Step 3.  
23.5Legacy FDL Support (T1 Mode)  
23.5.1 Overview  
To provide backward compatibility to the older DS21x52 T1 device, the DS2155 maintains the circuitry  
that existed in the previous generation of the T1 framer. In new applications, it is recommended that the  
HDLC controllers and BOC controller described in Section 21 and 23 are used.  
23.5.2 Receive Section  
In the receive section, the recovered FDL bits or Fs bits are shifted bit-by-bit into the receive FDL  
register (RFDL). Because the RFDL is 8 bits in length, it fills up every 2ms (8 x 250µs). The framer  
signals an external microcontroller that the buffer has filled through the SR8.3 bit. If enabled through  
IMR8.3, the INT pin toggles low, indicating that the buffer has filled and needs to be read. The user has  
2ms to read this data before it is lost. If the byte in the RFDL matches either of the bytes programmed  
into the RFDLM1 or RFDLM2 registers, then the SR8.1 bit is set to a 1 and the INT pin toggles low if  
enabled through IMR8.1. This feature allows an external microcontroller to ignore the FDL or Fs pattern  
until an important event occurs.  
The framer also contains a zero destuffer, which is controlled through the T1RCR2.3 bit. In both ANSI  
T1.403 and TR54016, communications on the FDL follows a subset of an LAPD protocol. The LAPD  
protocol states that no more than five 1s should be transmitted in a row so that the data does not resemble  
an opening or closing flag (01111110) or an abort signal (11111111). If enabled through T1RCR2.3, the  
DS2155 automatically looks for five 1s in a row, followed by a 0. If it finds such a pattern, it  
automatically removes the zero. If the zero destuffer sees six or more 1s in a row followed by a 0, the 0 is  
not removed. The T1RCR2.3 bit should always be set to a 1 when the DS2155 is extracting the FDL.  
Refer to Application Note 335: DS2141A, DS2151 Controlling the FDL for information about using the  
DS2155 in FDL applications in this legacy support mode.  
140 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RFDL  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive FDL Register  
C0h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RFDL0  
0
RFDL7 RFDL6 RFDL5 RFDL4 RFDL3 RFDL2 RFDL1  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The receive FDL register (RFDL) reports the incoming FDL or the incoming Fs bits. The LSB is received first.  
Bit 0/Receive FDL Bit 0 (RFDL0). LSB of the received FDL code.  
Bit 1/Receive FDL Bit 1 (RFDL1)  
Bit 2/Receive FDL Bit 2 (RFDL2)  
Bit 3/Receive FDL Bit 3 (RFDL3)  
Bit 4/Receive FDL Bit 4 (RFDL4)  
Bit 5/Receive FDL Bit 5 (RFDL5)  
Bit 6/Receive FDL Bit 6 (RFDL6)  
Bit 7/Receive FDL Bit 7 (RFDL7). MSB of the received FDL code.  
Register Name:  
RFDLM1, RFDLM2  
Register Description:  
Receive FDL Match Register 1  
Receive FDL Match Register 2  
C2h, C3h  
Register Address:  
7
RFDLM7  
0
6
RFDLM6  
0
5
RFDLM5  
0
4
RFDLM4  
0
3
RFDLM3  
0
2
RFDLM2  
0
1
0
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
RFDLM1 RFDLM0  
0
0
Bit 0/Receive FDL Match Bit 0 (RFDLM0). LSB of the FDL match code.  
Bit 1/Receive FDL Match Bit 1 (RFDLM1)  
Bit 2/Receive FDL Match Bit 2 (RFDLM2)  
Bit 3/Receive FDL Match Bit 3 (RFDLM3)  
Bit 4/Receive FDL Match Bit 4 (RFDLM4)  
Bit 5/Receive FDL Match Bit 5 (RFDLM5)  
Bit 6/Receive FDL Match Bit 6 (RFDLM6)  
Bit 7/Receive FDL Match Bit 7 (RFDLM7). MSB of the FDL match code.  
141 of 238  
DS2155  
23.5.3 Transmit Section  
The transmit section shifts out into the T1 data stream either the FDL (in the ESF framing mode) or the  
Fs bits (in the D4 framing mode) contained in the transmit FDL register (TFDL). When a new value is  
written to the TFDL, it is multiplexed serially (LSB first) into the proper position in the outgoing T1 data  
stream. After the full 8 bits have been shifted out, the framer signals the host microcontroller by setting  
the SR8.2 bit to a 1 that the buffer is empty and that more data is needed. The INT also toggles low if  
enabled through IMR8.2. The user has 2ms to update the TFDL with a new value. If the TFDL is not  
updated, the old value in the TFDL is transmitted once again. The framer also contains a zero stuffer that  
is controlled through the T1TCR2.5 bit. In both ANSI T1.403 and TR54016, communications on the FDL  
follows a subset of an LAPD protocol. The LAPD protocol states that no more than five 1s should be  
transmitted in a row so that the data does not resemble an opening or closing flag (01111110) or an abort  
signal (11111111). If enabled through T1TCR2.5, the framer automatically looks for five 1s in a row. If it  
finds such a pattern, it automatically inserts a 0 after the five 1s. The T1TCR2.5 bit should always be set  
to a 1 when the framer is inserting the FDL.  
Register Name:  
TFDL  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit FDL Register  
C1h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TFDL0  
0
TFDL7 TFDL6 TFDL5 TFDL4 TFDL3  
TFDL2 TFDL1  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Note: Also used to insert Fs framing pattern in D4 framing mode.  
The transmit FDL register (TFDL) contains the FDL information that is to be inserted on a byte basis into the  
outgoing T1 data stream. The LSB is transmitted first.  
Bit 0/Transmit FDL Bit 0 (TFDL0). LSB of the transmit FDL code.  
Bit 1/Transmit FDL Bit 1 (TFDL1)  
Bit 2/Transmit FDL Bit 2 (TFDL2)  
Bit 3/Transmit FDL Bit 3 (TFDL3)  
Bit 4/Transmit FDL Bit 4 (TFDL4)  
Bit 5/Transmit FDL Bit 5 (TFDL5)  
Bit 6/Transmit FDL Bit 6 (TFDL6)  
Bit 7/Transmit FDL Bit 7 (TFDL7). MSB of the transmit FDL code.  
23.6D4/SLC-96 Operation  
In the D4 framing mode, the framer uses the TFDL register to insert the Fs framing pattern. To allow the  
device to properly insert the Fs framing pattern, the TFDL register at address C1h must be programmed to  
1Ch and the following bits must be programmed as shown:  
T1TCR1.2 = 0 (source Fs data from the TFDL register)  
T1TCR2.6 = 1 (allow the TFDL register to load on multiframe boundaries)  
Since the SLC-96 message fields share the Fs-bit position, the user can access these message fields  
through the TFDL and RFDL registers. Refer to Application Note 345: DS2141A, DS2151, DS2152 SLC-  
96 for a detailed description about implementing an SLC-96 function.  
142 of 238  
DS2155  
24. LINE INTERFACE UNIT (LIU)  
The LIU contains three sections: the receiver that handles clock and data recovery, the transmitter that  
waveshapes and drives the T1 line, and the jitter attenuator. These three sections are controlled by the line  
interface control registers (LIC1–LIC4), which are described in the following sections. The LIU has its  
own T1/E1 mode-select bit and can operate independently of the framer function.  
The DS2155 can switch between T1 or E1 networks without changing any external components on either  
the transmit or receive side. Figure 24-3 shows a network connection using minimal components. In this  
configuration, the DS2155 can connect to T1, J1, or E1 (75or 120) without any component change.  
The receiver can adjust the 120termination to 100or 75. The transmitter can adjust its output  
impedance to provide high return-loss characteristics for 120, 100, and 75lines. Other components  
can be added to this configuration to meet safety and network protection requirements (Section 24.8).  
24.1LIU Operation  
The analog AMI/HDB3 waveform off the E1 line or the AMI/B8ZS waveform off of the T1 line is  
transformer-coupled into the RTIP and RRING pins of the DS2155. The user has the option to use  
internal termination, software selectable for 75/100/120applications, or external termination. The  
LIU recovers clock and data from the analog signal and passes it through the jitter-attenuation mux  
outputting the received line clock at RCLKO and bipolar or NRZ data at RPOSO and RNEGO. The  
DS2155 contains an active filter that reconstructs the analog-received signal for the nonlinear losses that  
occur in transmission. The receive circuitry also is configurable for various monitor applications. The  
device has a usable receive sensitivity of 0dB to -43dB for E1 and 0dB to -36dB for T1, which allow the  
device to operate on 0.63mm (22AWG) cables up to 2.5km (E1) and 6k feet (T1) in length. Data input at  
TPOSI and TNEGI is sent through the jitter-attenuation mux to the waveshaping circuitry and line driver.  
The DS2155 drives the E1 or T1 line from the TTIP and TRING pins through a coupling transformer.  
The line driver can handle both CEPT 30/ISDN-PRI lines for E1 and long-haul (CSU) or short-haul  
(DSX-1) lines for T1.  
24.2Receiver  
The DS2155 contains a digital clock recovery system. The DS2155 couples to the receive E1 or T1  
twisted pair (or coaxial cable in 75E1 applications) through a 1:1 transformer. See Table 24-C for  
transformer details. The DS2155 has the option of using software-selectable termination requiring only a  
single fixed pair of termination resistors.  
The DS2155’s LIU is designed to be fully software selectable for E1 and T1, requiring no change to any  
external resistors for the receive side. The receive side allows the user to configure the DS2155 for 75,  
100, or 120receive termination by setting the RT1 (LIC4.1) and RT0 (LIC4.0) bits. When using the  
internal termination feature, the resistors labeled R in Figure 24-3 should be 60each. If external  
termination is used, RT1 and RT0 should be set to 0 and the resistors labeled R in Figure 24-3 should be  
37.5, 50, or 60each, depending on the line impedance.  
There are two ranges of user-selectable receive sensitivity for T1 and E1. The EGL bit of LIC1 (LIC1.4)  
selects the full or limited sensitivity. The resultant E1 or T1 clock derived from MCLK is multiplied by  
16 through an internal PLL and fed to the clock recovery system. The clock recovery system uses the  
clock from the PLL circuit to form a 16-times over-sampler that is used to recover the clock and data.  
This over-sampling technique offers outstanding performance to meet jitter tolerance specifications  
shown in Figure 24-7.  
143 of 238  
DS2155  
Normally, the clock that is output at the RCLK pin is the recovered clock from the E1 AMI/HDB3 or T1  
AMI/B8ZS waveform presented at the RTIP and RRING inputs. If the jitter attenuator is placed in the  
receive path (as is the case in most applications), the jitter attenuator restores the RCLK to an  
approximate 50% duty cycle. If the jitter attenuator is either placed in the transmit path or is disabled, the  
RCLK output can exhibit slightly shorter high cycles of the clock. This is because of the highly over-  
sampled digital-clock recovery circuitry. See the Receive AC Timing Characteristics in Section 37.3 for  
more details. When no signal is present at RTIP and RRING, a receive carrier loss (RCL) condition  
occurs and the RCLK is derived from the JACLK source.  
24.2.1 Receive Level Indicator and Threshold Interrupt  
The DS2155 reports the signal strength at RTIP and RRING in 2.5dB increments through RL3–RL0  
located in Information Register 2 (INFO2). This feature is helpful when trouble-shooting line-  
performance problems. The DS2155 can initiate an interrupt whenever the input falls below a certain  
level through the input-level under-threshold indicator (SR1.7). Using the RLT0–RLT4 bits of the CCR4  
register, the user can set a threshold in 2.5dB increments. The SR1.7 bit is set whenever the input level at  
RTIP and RRING falls below the threshold set by the value in RLT0–RLT4. The level must remain  
below the programmed threshold for approximately 50ms for this bit to be set. The accuracy of the  
receive level indication is +/- 1 LSB (2.5dB) from 25C to 85C and +/- 2 LSB’s (5dB) from –40C to 25C.  
24.2.2 Receive G.703 Synchronization Signal (E1 Mode)  
The DS2155 is capable of receiving a 2.048MHz square-wave synchronization clock as specified in  
Section 13 of ITU G.703, October 1998. In order to use the DS2155 in this mode, set the receive  
synchronization clock enable (LIC3.2) = 1.  
24.2.3 Monitor Mode  
Monitor applications in both E1 and T1 require various flat gain settings for the receive-side circuitry.  
The DS2155 can be programmed to support these applications through the monitor mode control bits  
MM1 and MM0 in the LIC3 register (Figure 24-1).  
Figure 24-1. Typical Monitor Application  
PRIMARY  
T1/E1 LINE  
Rm  
T1/E1 TERMINATING  
DEVICE  
Rm  
X
F
DS2156  
Rt  
M
R
MONITOR  
PORT JACK  
SECONDARY T1/E1  
TERMINATING  
DEVICE  
144 of 238  
 
DS2155  
24.3Transmitter  
The DS2155 uses a phase-lock loop along with a precision digital-to-analog converter (DAC) to create  
the waveforms that are transmitted onto the E1 or T1 line. The waveforms created by the DS2155 meet  
the latest ETSI, ITU, ANSI, and AT&T specifications. The user selects which waveform is generated by  
setting the ETS bit (LIC2.7) for E1 or T1 operation, then programming the L2/L1/L0 bits in register LIC1  
for the appropriate application.  
A 2.048MHz or 1.544MHz clock is required at TCLKI for transmitting data presented at TPOSI and  
TNEGI. Normally these pins are connected to TCLKO, TPOSO, and TNEGO. However, the LIU can  
operate in an independent fashion. ITU specification G.703 requires an accuracy of ±50ppm for both T1  
and E1. TR62411 and ANSI specifications require an accuracy of ±32ppm for T1 interfaces. The clock  
can be sourced internally from RCLK or JACLK. See LIC2.3, LIC4.4, and LIC4.5 for details. Because of  
the nature of the transmitter’s design, very little jitter (less than 0.005UIP-P broadband from 10Hz to  
100kHz) is added to the jitter present on TCLK. Also, the waveforms created are independent of the duty  
cycle of TCLK. The transmitter in the DS2155 couples to the E1 or T1 transmit twisted pair (or coaxial  
cable in some E1 applications) through a 1:2 step-up transformer. For the device to create the proper  
waveforms, the transformer used must meet the specifications listed in Table 24-C. The DS2155 has the  
option of using software-selectable transmit termination.  
The transmit line drive has two modes of operation: fixed gain or automatic gain. In the fixed gain mode,  
the transmitter outputs a fixed current into the network load to achieve a nominal pulse amplitude. In the  
automatic gain mode, the transmitter adjusts its output level to compensate for slight variances in the  
network load. See the Transmit Line Build-Out Control (TLBC) register for details.  
24.3.1 Transmit Short-Circuit Detector/Limiter  
The DS2155 has an automatic short-circuit limiter that limits the source current to 50mA (RMS) into a  
1load. This feature can be disabled by setting the SCLD bit (LIC2.1) = 1. TCLE (INFO2.5) provides a  
real-time indication of when the current limiter is activated. If the current limiter is disabled, TCLE  
indicates that a short-circuit condition exists. Status Register SR1.2 provides a latched version of the  
information, which can be used to activate an interrupt when enabled by the IMR1 register. The TPD bit  
(LIC1.0) powers down the transmit line driver and tri-states the TTIP and TRING pins.  
24.3.2 Transmit Open-Circuit Detector  
The DS2155 can also detect when the TTIP or TRING outputs are open circuited. TOCD (INFO2.4)  
provides a real-time indication of when an open circuit is detected. SR1 provides a latched version of the  
information (SR1.1), which can be used to activate an interrupt when enabled by the IMR1 register.  
24.3.3 Transmit BPV Error Insertion  
When IBPV (LIC2.5) is transitioned from a 0 to a 1, the device waits for the next occurrence of three  
consecutive 1s to insert a BPV. IBPV must be cleared and set again for another BPV error insertion.  
24.3.4 Transmit G.703 Synchronization Signal (E1 Mode)  
The DS2155 can transmit the 2.048MHz square-wave synchronization clock as specified in Section 13 of  
ITU G.703, October 1998. In order to transmit the 2.048MHz clock, when in E1 mode, set the transmit  
synchronization clock enable (LIC3.1) = 1.  
145 of 238  
DS2155  
24.4MCLK Prescaler  
A 16.384MHz, 8.192MHz, 4.096MHz, 2.048MHz, or 1.544MHz clock must be applied at MCLK. ITU  
specification G.703 requires an accuracy of ±50ppm for both T1 and E1. TR62411 and ANSI  
specifications require an accuracy of ±32ppm for T1 interfaces. A prescaler divides the 16MHz, 8MHz,  
or 4MHz clock down to 2.048MHz. There is an on-board PLL for the jitter attenuator, which converts the  
2.048MHz clock to a 1.544MHz rate for T1 applications. Setting JAMUX (LIC2.3) to a logic 0 bypasses  
this PLL.  
24.5Jitter Attenuator  
The DS2155 contains an on-board jitter attenuator that can be set to a depth of either 32 or 128 bits  
through the JABDS bit (LIC1.2). The 128-bit mode is used in applications where large excursions of  
wander are expected. The 32-bit mode is used in delay-sensitive applications. The characteristics of the  
attenuation are shown in Figure 24-9. The jitter attenuator can be placed in either the receive path or the  
transmit path by appropriately setting or clearing the JAS bit (LIC1.3). Setting the DJA bit (LIC1.1)  
disables (in effect, removes) the jitter attenuator. On-board circuitry adjusts either the recovered clock  
from the clock/data recovery block or the clock applied at the TCLK pin to create a smooth jitter-free  
clock that is used to clock data out of the jitter attenuator FIFO. It is acceptable to provide a  
gapped/bursty clock at the TCLK pin if the jitter attenuator is placed on the transmit side. If the incoming  
jitter exceeds either 120UIP-P (buffer depth is 128 bits) or 28UIP-P (buffer depth is 32 bits), then the  
DS2155 divides the internal nominal 32.768MHz (E1) or 24.704MHz (T1) clock by either 15 or 17  
instead of the normal 16 to keep the buffer from overflowing. When the device divides by either 15 or 17,  
it also sets the jitter attenuator limit trip (JALT) bit in Status Register 1 (SR1.4).  
24.6CMI (Code Mark Inversion) Option  
The DS2155 provides a CMI interface for connection to optical transports. This interface is a unipolar  
1T2B signal type. Ones are encoded as either a logical 1 or 0 level for the full duration of the clock  
period. Zeros are encoded as a 0-to-1 transition at the middle of the clock period.  
Figure 24-2. CMI Coding  
CLOCK  
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
DATA  
CMI  
Transmit and receive CMI are enabled through LIC4.7. When this register bit is set, the TTIP pin outputs  
CMI-coded data at normal levels. This signal can be used to directly drive an optical interface. When  
CMI is enabled, the user can also use HDB3/B8ZS coding. When this register bit is set, the RTIP pin  
becomes a unipolar CMI input. The CMI signal is processed to extract and align the clock with data.  
146 of 238  
DS2155  
24.7 LIU Control Registers  
Register Name:  
LIC1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Line Interface Control 1  
78h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
L2  
0
6
L1  
0
5
L0  
0
4
EGL  
0
3
JAS  
0
2
JABDS  
0
1
DJA  
0
0
TPD  
0
Bit 0/Transmit Power-Down (TPD)  
0 = powers down the transmitter and tri-states the TTIP and TRING pins  
1 = normal transmitter operation  
Bit 1/Disable Jitter Attenuator (DJA)  
0 = jitter attenuator enabled  
1 = jitter attenuator disabled  
Bit 2/Jitter Attenuator Buffer Depth Select (JABDS)  
0 = 128 bits  
1 = 32 bits (use for delay-sensitive applications)  
Bit 3/Jitter Attenuator Select (JAS)  
0 = place the jitter attenuator on the receive side  
1 = place the jitter attenuator on the transmit side  
Bit 4/Receive Equalizer Gain Limit (EGL). This bit controls the sensitivity of the receive equalizer.  
T1 Mode  
0 = -36dB (long haul)  
1 = -15dB (limited long haul)  
E1 Mode  
0 = -12dB (short haul)  
1 = -43dB (long haul)  
Bits 5 to 7/Line Buildout Select (L0 to L2). When using the internal termination, the user needs only to select 000  
for 75operation or 001 for 120operation below. This selects the proper voltage levels for 75or 120Ω  
operation. Using TT0 and TT1 of the LICR4 register, the user can then select the proper internal source  
termination. Line buildouts 100 and 101 are for backwards compatibility with older products only.  
E1 Mode  
L2 L1  
L0  
0
Application  
N (1)  
1:2  
Return Loss Rt (1) ()  
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
75normal  
NM  
NM  
0
0
1
120normal  
1:2  
0
1
75with high return loss*  
1:2  
1:2  
21dB  
21dB  
6.2  
11.6  
120with high return loss*  
*TT0 and TT1 of LIC4 register must be set to 0 in this configuration.  
147 of 238  
DS2155  
T1 Mode  
L2  
L1  
0
L0  
0
Application  
DSX-1 (0ft to 133ft) / 0dB CSU  
DSX-1 (133ft to 266ft)  
DSX-1 (266ft to 399ft)  
DSX-1 (399ft to 533ft)  
DSX-1 (533ft to 655ft)  
-7.5dB CSU  
N (1) Return Loss Rt (1) ()  
0
1:2  
1:2  
1:2  
1:2  
1:2  
1:2  
1:2  
1:2  
NM  
NM  
NM  
NM  
NM  
NM  
NM  
NM  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
0
-15dB CSU  
1
1
1
-22.5dB CSU  
148 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
TLBC  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Line Build-Out Control  
7Dh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
-
0
6
AGCE  
0
5
GC5  
0
4
GC4  
0
3
GC3  
0
2
GC2  
0
1
GC1  
0
0
GC0  
0
Bit 0–5 Gain Control Bits 0–5 (GC0–GC5). The GC0 through GC5 bits control the gain setting for the  
nonautomatic gain mode. Use the tables below for setting the recommended values. The LB (line build-out)  
column refers to the value in the  
L0–L2 bits in LIC1 (Line Interface Control 1) register.  
NETWORK MODE  
LB GC5 GC4 GC3 GC2 GC1 GC0  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
4
5
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
T1, Impedance Match  
Off  
T1, Impedance Match On  
E1, Impedance Match  
Off  
E1, Impedance Match On  
Bit 6/Automatic Gain Control Enable (AGCE).  
0 = use Transmit AGC, TLBC bits 0–5 are “don’t care”  
1 = do not use Transmit AGC, TLBC bits 0–5 set nominal level  
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to zero for proper operation.  
149 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
LIC2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Line Interface Control 2  
79h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
ETS  
0
6
LIRST  
0
5
IBPV  
0
4
3
2
0
1
SCLD  
0
0
CLDS  
0
TUA1 JAMUX  
0
0
Bit 0/Custom Line Driver Select (CLDS). Setting this bit to a 1 redefines the operation of the transmit line  
driver. When this bit is set to a 1 and LIC1.5 = LIC1.6 = LIC1.7 = 0, the device generates a square wave at the  
TTIP and TRING outputs instead of a normal waveform. When this bit is set to a 1 and LIC1.5 = LIC1.6 = LIC1.7  
0, the device forces TTIP and TRING outputs to become open-drain drivers instead of their normal push-pull  
operation. This bit should be set to 0 for normal operation of the device.  
Bit 1/Short-Circuit Limit Disable (ETS = 1) (SCLD). Controls the 50mA (RMS) current limiter.  
0 = enable 50mA current limiter  
1 = disable 50mA current limiter  
Bit 2/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
Bit 3/Jitter Attenuator Mux (JAMUX). Controls the source for JACLK.  
0 = JACLK sourced from MCLK (2.048MHz or 1.544MHz at MCLK)  
1 = JACLK sourced from internal PLL (2.048MHz at MCLK)  
Bit 4/Transmit Unframed All Ones (TUA1). The polarity of this bit is set such that the device transmits an all-  
ones pattern on power-up or device reset. This bit must be set to a 1 to allow the device to transmit data. The  
transmission of this data pattern is always timed off of the JACLK.  
0 = transmit all ones at TTIP and TRING  
1 = transmit data normally  
Bit 5/Insert BPV (IBPV). A 0-to-1 transition on this bit causes a single BPV to be inserted into the transmit data  
stream. Once this bit has been toggled from a 0 to a 1, the device waits for the next occurrence of three consecutive  
1s to insert the BPV. This bit must be cleared and set again for a subsequent error to be inserted.  
Bit 6/Line Interface Reset (LIRST). Setting this bit from a 0 to a 1 initiates an internal reset that resets the clock  
recovery state machine and recenters the jitter attenuator. Normally this bit is only toggled on power-up. Must be  
cleared and set again for a subsequent reset.  
Bit 7/E1/T1 Select (ETS)  
0 = T1 mode selected  
1 = E1 mode selected  
150 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
LIC3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Line Interface Control 3  
7Ah  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
TCES  
0
5
RCES  
0
4
MM1  
0
3
2
1
0
MM0 RSCLKE TSCLKE TAOZ  
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Transmit Alternate Ones and Zeros (TAOZ). Transmit a …101010… pattern (customer disconnect  
indication signal) at TTIP and TRING. The transmission of this data pattern is always timed off of TCLK.  
0 = disabled  
1 = enabled  
Bit 1/Transmit Synchronization G.703 Clock Enable (TSCLKE)  
0 = disable 1.544MHz (T1)/2.048MHz (E1) transmit synchronization clock  
1 = enable 1.544MHz (T1)/2.048MHz (E1) transmit synchronization clock  
Bit 2/Receive Synchronization G.703 Clock Enable (RSCLKE)  
0 = disable 1.544MHz (T1)/2.048MHz (E1) synchronization receive mode  
1 = enable 1.544MHz (T1)/2.048MHz (E1) synchronization receive mode  
Bits 3 to 4/Monitor Mode (MM0 to MM1)  
Internal Linear Gain Boost  
MM1  
MM0  
(dB)  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Normal operation (no boost)  
20  
26  
32  
Bit 5/Receive-Clock Edge Select (RCES). Selects which RCLKO edge to update RPOSO and RNEGO.  
0 = update RPOSO and RNEGO on rising edge of RCLKO  
1 = update RPOSO and RNEGO on falling edge of RCLKO  
Bit 6/Transmit-Clock Edge Select (TCES). Selects which TCLKI edge to sample TPOSI and TNEGI.  
0 = sample TPOSI and TNEGI on falling edge of TCLKI  
1 = sample TPOSI and TNEGI on rising edge of TCLKI  
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
151 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
LIC4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Line Interface Control 4  
7Bh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
CMIE  
0
6
CMII  
0
5
MPS1  
0
4
MPS0  
0
3
TT1  
0
2
TT0  
0
1
RT1  
0
0
RT0  
0
Bits 0, 1/Receive Termination Select (RT0, RT1)  
RT1  
RT0  
Internal Receive-Termination Configuration  
Internal receive-side termination disabled  
Internal receive-side 75enabled  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Internal receive-side 100enabled  
Internal receive-side 120enabled  
Bits 2, 3/Transmit Termination Select (TT0, TT1)  
TT1  
TT0  
Internal Transmit-Termination Configuration  
Internal transmit-side termination disabled  
Internal transmit -side 75enabled  
Internal transmit -side 100enabled  
Internal transmit -side 120enabled  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Bits 4, 5/MCLK Prescaler for T1 Mode  
MCLK  
JAMUX  
MPS1  
MPS0  
(MHz)  
1.544  
3.088  
6.176  
12.352  
2.048  
4.096  
8.192  
16.384  
(LIC2.3)  
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
Bits 4, 5/MCLK Prescaler for E1 Mode  
MCLK  
JAMUX  
MPS1  
MPS0  
(MHz)  
2.048  
4.096  
8.192  
16.384  
(LIC2.3)  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
Bit 6/CMI Invert (CMII)  
0 = CMI normal at TTIP and RTIP  
1 = invert CMI signal at TTIP and RTIP  
Bit 7/CMI Enable (CMIE)  
0 = disable CMI mode  
1 = enable CMI mode  
152 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
INFO2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Information Register 2  
11h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
BSYNC  
0
6
BD  
0
5
TCLE  
0
4
TOCD  
0
3
RL3  
0
2
RL2  
0
1
RL1  
0
0
RL0  
0
Bits 0 to 3/Receive Level Bits (RL0 to RL3). Real-time bits  
RL3  
0
RL2  
0
RL1  
0
RL0  
0
Receive Level (dB)  
Greater than -2.5  
-2.5 to -5.0  
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
-5.0 to -7.5  
0
0
1
1
-7.5 to -10.0  
0
1
0
0
-10.0 to -12.5  
-12.5 to -15.0  
-15.0 to -17.5  
-17.5 to -20.0  
-20.0 to -22.5  
-22.5 to -25.0  
-25.0 to -27.5  
-27.5 to -30.0  
-30.0 to -32.5  
-32.5 to -35.0  
-35.0 to -37.5  
Less than -37.5  
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
NOTE: RL0 through RL3 only indicate the signal range as specified by the EGL bit in LIC1. Example; if  
EGL = 1 and in T1 mode, RL0 through RL3 will only indicate a signal range of >-2.5dB to –15dB even if the  
signal is < -15dB.  
Bit 4/Transmit Open-Circuit Detect (TOCD). A real-time bit that is set when the device detects that the TTIP  
and TRING outputs are open-circuited.  
Bit 5/Transmit Current-Limit Exceeded (TCLE). A real-time bit that is set when the 50mA (RMS) current  
limiter is activated, whether the current limiter is enabled or not.  
Bit 6/BOC Detected (BD). A real-time bit that is set high when the BOC detector is presently seeing a valid  
sequence and set low when no BOC is currently being detected.  
Bit 7/BERT Real-Time Synchronization Status (BSYNC). Real-time status of the synchronizer (this bit is not  
latched). This bit is set when the incoming pattern matches for 32 consecutive bit positions. It is cleared when six  
or more bits out of 64 are received in error. Refer to BSYNC in the BERT status register, SR9, for an interrupt-  
generating version of this signal.  
153 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
SR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Status Register 1  
16h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
ILUT  
0
6
5
4
JALT  
0
3
LRCL  
0
2
TCLE  
0
1
TOCD  
0
0
LOLITC  
0
TIMER RSCOS  
0
0
Bit 0/Loss of Line-Interface Transmit-Clock Condition (LOLITC). Set when TCLKI has not transitioned for  
one channel time. This is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).  
Bit 1/Transmit Open-Circuit Detect Condition (TOCD). Set when the device detects that the TTIP and TRING  
outputs are open-circuited. This is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).  
Bit 2/Transmit Current-Limit Exceeded Condition (TCLE). Set when the 50mA (RMS) current limiter is  
activated, whether the current limiter is enabled or not. This is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).  
Bit 3/Line Interface Receive Carrier-Loss Condition (LRCL). Set when the carrier signal is lost. This is a  
double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).  
Bit 4/Jitter Attenuator Limit Trip Event (JALT). Set when the jitter attenuator FIFO reaches to within 4 bits of  
its useful limit. This bit is cleared when read. Useful for debugging jitter attenuation operation.  
Bit 5/Receive Signaling Change-of-State Event (RSCOS). Set when any channel selected by the receive  
signaling change-of-state interrupt-enable registers (RSCSE1 through RSCSE4) changes signaling state.  
Bit 6/Timer Event (TIMER). Follows the error-counter update interval as determined by the ECUS bit in the  
error-counter configuration register (ERCNT).  
T1: set on increments of 1 second or 42ms based on RCLK  
E1: set on increments of 1 second or 62.5ms based on RCLK  
Bit 7/Input Level Under Threshold (ILUT). This bit is set whenever the input level at RTIP and RRING falls  
below the threshold set by the value in CCR4.4 through CCR4.7. The level must remain below the programmed  
threshold for approximately 50ms for this bit to be set. This is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).  
154 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
IMR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Interrupt Mask Register 1  
17h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
ILUT  
0
6
5
4
JALT  
0
3
LRCL  
0
2
TCLE  
0
1
TOCD  
0
0
LOLITC  
0
TIMER RSCOS  
0
0
Bit 0/Loss-of-Transmit Clock Condition (LOLITC)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—generates interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 1/Transmit Open-Circuit Detect Condition (TOCD)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—generates interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 2/Transmit Current-Limit Exceeded Condition (TCLE)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—generates interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 3/Line Interface Receive Carrier-Loss Condition (LRCL)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—generates interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 4/Jitter Attenuator Limit Trip Event (JALT)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 5/Receive Signaling Change-of-State Event (RSCOS)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 6/Timer Event (TIMER)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 7/Input Level Under Threshold (ILUT)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
155 of 238  
DS2155  
24.8 Recommended Circuits  
Figure 24-3. Software-Selected Termination, Metallic Protection  
VCC  
TTIP  
DVDD  
DVSS  
1.0 µF  
T1  
0.01 µF2  
0.1 µF 2  
T3 1  
F1  
75/100/110/120 Ω  
Tw isted Pair/Coax  
S3  
S1  
TRING  
VCC  
VCC  
2:1  
68 µF2  
Dallas Semiconductor  
T1/E1/J1 SCT or LIU  
RTIP  
TVDD  
TVSS  
RVDD  
RVSS  
T2  
0.1 µF 2  
0.1 µF 2  
T4 1  
F2  
75/100/110/120 Ω  
Tw isted Pair/Coax  
S4  
S2  
RRING  
1:1  
60 Ω  
60 Ω  
Design Notes:  
1 Choke is optional but should be included when necessary for common mode noise reduction.  
0.1 µF  
2
Decoupling capacitors need to be placed near dev ice power pins  
Table 24-A. Component List (Software-Selected Termination, Metallic  
Protection)  
NAME  
DESCRIPTION  
F1 and F2  
S1 and S2  
S3 andS4  
T1 and T2  
T3 and T4  
1.25A slow blow fuse  
25V (max) transient suppressor  
77V (max) transient suppressor  
Transformer 1:1CT and 1:2CT (3.3V, SMT)  
Dual common-mode choke (SMT)  
T3 and T4 are optional. For more information, contact the Telecom Support Group at  
telecom.support@dalsemi.com.  
The layout from the transformers to the network interface is critical. Traces should be at least 25  
mils wide and separated from other circuit lines by at least 150 mils. The area under this portion  
of the circuit should not contain power planes.  
Some T1 (never in E1) applications source or sink power from the network-side center taps of  
the Rx/Tx transformers.  
A list of transformer part numbers and manufacturers is available by contacting  
telecom.support@dalsemi.com.  
Note 1:  
Note 2:  
Note 3:  
Note 4:  
156 of 238  
DS2155  
0.1 µF 2  
Figure 24-4. Software-Selected Termination, Longitudinal Protection  
VCC  
TTIP  
DVDD  
1.0 µF  
F1  
T1  
0.01 µF2  
T3 1  
DVSS  
S3  
S4  
100/110/120 Ω  
Tw isted Pair  
S7  
S1  
TRING  
F2  
VCC  
VCC  
2:1  
68 µF2  
Dallas Semiconductor  
T1/E1/J1 SCT or LIU  
RTIP  
TVDD  
TVSS  
RVDD  
RVSS  
F3  
F4  
T2  
0.1 µF 2  
0.1 µF 2  
T4 1  
S5  
S6  
100/110/120 Ω  
Tw isted Pair  
S8  
S2  
RRING  
1:1  
60 Ω  
60 Ω  
Design Notes:  
1 Choke is optional but should be included when necessary f or common mode noise reduction.  
0.1 µF  
2
Decoupling capacitors need to be placed near device power pins  
Table 24-B. Component List (Software-Selected Termination, Longitudinal  
Protection)  
NAME  
F1 to F4  
S1 and S2  
DESCRIPTION  
1.25A slow blow fuse  
25V (max) transient suppressor  
S3, S4, S5, S6 180V (max) transient suppressor  
S7 and S8  
T1 and T2  
T3 and T4  
40V (max) transient suppressor  
Transformer 1:1CT and 1:2CT (3.3V, SMT)  
Dual common-mode choke (SMT)  
T3 and T4 are optional. For more information, contact the Telecom Support Group at  
telecom.support@dalsemi.com.  
Note 1:  
Note 2:  
Note 3:  
A list of alternate transformer part numbers and manufacturers is available at  
telecom.support@dalsemi.com.  
The layout from the transformers to the network interface is critical. Traces should be at least 25  
mils wide and separated from other circuit lines by at least 150 mils. The area under this portion  
of the circuit should not contain power planes.  
Some T1 (never in E1) applications source or sink power from the network-side center taps of  
the Rx/Tx transformers.  
The ground trace connected to the S2/S3 pair and the S4/S5 pair should be at least 50 mils wide  
to conduct the extra current from a longitudinal power-cross event.  
Note 4:  
Note 5:  
157 of 238  
DS2155  
24.9Component Specifications  
Table 24-C. Transformer Specifications  
SPECIFICATION  
RECOMMENDED VALUE  
Turns Ratio 3.3V Applications  
Primary Inductance  
1:1 (receive) and 1:2 (transmit) ±2%  
600µH (min)  
Leakage Inductance  
1.0µH (max)  
Intertwining Capacitance  
Transmit Transformer DC Resistance  
Primary (Device Side)  
Secondary  
Receive Transformer DC Resistance  
Primary (Device Side)  
Secondary  
40pF (max)  
1.0(max)  
2.0(max)  
1.2(max)  
1.2(max)  
158 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 24-5. E1 Transmit Pulse Template  
1.2  
1.1  
1.0  
0.9  
0.8  
0.7  
269ns  
G.703  
TEMPLATE  
194ns  
0.6  
0.5  
219ns  
0.4  
0.3  
0.2  
0.1  
0
-0.1  
-0.2  
-250  
-200  
-150  
-100  
-50  
0
50  
100  
150  
200  
250  
TIME (ns)  
Figure 24-6. T1 Transmit Pulse Template  
1.2  
1.1  
1.0  
0.9  
0.8  
0.7  
0.6  
0.5  
0.4  
0.3  
0.2  
0.1  
0
MAXIMUM CURVE  
UI Time Amp.  
MINIMUM CURVE  
UI Time Amp.  
-0.77 -500 0.05  
-0.39 -255 0.05  
-0.27 -175 0.80  
-0.27 -175 1.15  
-0.77 -500 -0.05  
-0.23 -150 -0.05  
-0.23 -150 0.50  
-0.15 -100 0.95  
-0.12 -75  
1.15  
1.05  
1.05  
-0.07  
0.05  
0.05  
0.00  
0
0.95  
0.00  
0
0.15 100  
0.23 150  
0.23 150  
0.46 300  
0.66 430  
0.93 600  
1.16 750  
0.90  
0.27 175  
0.35 225  
0.93 600  
1.16 750  
0.50  
-0.45  
-0.45  
-0.20  
-0.05  
-0.05  
-0.1  
T1.102/87, T1.403,  
-0.2  
-0.3  
-0.4  
-0.5  
CB 119 (OCT. 79), AND  
I.431 TEMPLATE  
-500 -400 -300 -200 -100  
0
100  
200  
300  
400  
500  
600  
700  
TIME (ns)  
159 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 24-7. Jitter Tolerance  
1k  
DS2155  
TOLERANCE  
100  
TR 62411 (DEC. 90)  
10  
1
ITU-T G.823  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
1k  
10k  
100k  
FREQUENCY (Hz)  
Figure 24-8. Jitter Tolerance (E1 Mode)  
1k  
DS2155  
TOLERANCE  
100  
40  
10  
1.5  
1
MINIMUM TOLERANCE  
LEVEL AS PER  
ITU G.823  
0.2  
0.1  
2.4k  
20  
18k  
1
10  
100  
1k  
10k  
100k  
FREQUENCY (Hz)  
160 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 24-9. Jitter Attenuation (T1 Mode)  
0dB  
-20dB  
-40dB  
TR 62411 (Dec. 90)  
Prohibited Area  
DS2155  
T1 MODE  
-60dB  
1
10  
100  
1K  
10K  
100K  
FREQUENCY (Hz)  
Figure 24-10. Jitter Attenuation (E1 Mode)  
0
ITU G.7XX  
TBR12  
Prohibited  
Area  
Prohibited Area  
-20  
DS2155  
E1 MODE  
-40  
-60  
1
10  
100  
1k  
10k  
100k  
FREQUENCY (Hz)  
161 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 24-11. Optional Crystal Connections  
DS2155  
XTALD  
1.544MHz/2.048MHz  
MCLK  
C1  
C2  
Note 1: C1 and C2 should be 5pF lower than two times the nominal loading capacitance of the crystal to adjust for the input capacitance of the  
DS2155.  
162 of 238  
DS2155  
25. PROGRAMMABLE IN-BAND LOOP CODE GENERATION AND  
DETECTION  
The DS2155 has the ability to generate and detect a repeating bit pattern from one to eight bits or 16 bits  
in length. This function is available only in T1 mode. To transmit a pattern, the user loads the pattern  
into the transmit code-definition registers (TCD1 and TCD2) and selects the proper length of the pattern  
by setting the TC0 and TC1 bits in the in-band code control (IBCC) register. When generating a 1-, 2-, 4-,  
8-, or 16-bit pattern, both transmit code-definition registers must be filled with the proper code.  
Generation of a 3-, 5-, 6-, and 7-bit pattern only requires TCD1 to be filled. Once this is accomplished,  
the pattern is transmitted as long as the TLOOP control bit (T1CCR1.0) is enabled. Normally (unless the  
transmit formatter is programmed to not insert the F-bit position) the framer overwrites the repeating  
pattern once every 193 bits to send the F-bit position.  
For example, to transmit the standard “loop-up” code for CSUs, which is a repeating pattern of  
...10000100001... , set TCD1 = 80h, IBCC = 0, and T1CCR1.0 = 1.  
The framer has three programmable pattern detectors. Typically two of the detectors are used for “loop-  
up” and “loop-down” code detection. The user programs the codes to be detected in the receive up-code  
definition (RUPCD1 and RUPCD2) registers and the receive down-code definition (RDNCD1 and  
RDNCD2) registers, and the length of each pattern is selected through the IBCC register. There is a third  
detector (spare) that is defined and controlled through the RSCD1/RSCD2 and RSCC registers. When  
detecting a 16-bit pattern, both receive code-definition registers are used together to form a 16-bit  
register. For 8-bit patterns, both receive code-definition registers are filled with the same value. Detection  
of a 1-, 2-, 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, and 7-bit pattern only requires the first receive code-definition register to be  
filled. The framer detects repeating pattern codes in both framed and unframed circumstances with bit  
error rates as high as 10E-2. The detectors are capable of handling both F-bit inserted and F-bit overwrite  
patterns. Writing the least significant byte of the receive code-definition register resets the integration  
period for that detector. The code detector has a nominal integration period of 36ms. Hence, after about  
36ms of receiving a valid code, the proper status bit (LUP at SR3.5, LDN at SR3.6, and LSPARE at  
SR3.7) is set to a 1. Normally codes are sent for a period of five seconds. It is recommended that the  
software poll the framer every 50ms to 1000ms until five seconds has elapsed to ensure the code is  
continuously present.  
163 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
IBCC  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
In-Band Code Control Register  
B6h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
TC1  
0
6
TC0  
0
5
RUP2  
0
4
RUP1  
0
3
RUP0  
0
2
RDN2  
0
1
RDN1  
0
0
RDN0  
0
Bits 0 to 2/Receive Down-Code Length Definition Bits (RDN0 to RDN2)  
RDN2  
RDN1  
RDN0  
Length Selected (bits)  
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8/16  
Bits 3 to 5/Receive Up-Code Length Definition Bits (RUP0 to RUP2)  
RUP2  
RUP1  
RUP0  
Length Selected (bits)  
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8/16  
Bits 6, 7/Transmit Code Length Definition Bits (TC0 to TC1)  
TC1  
TC0  
Length Selected (bits)  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
5
6/3  
7
16/8/4/2/1  
164 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
TCD1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Code-Definition Register 1  
B7h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
C7  
0
6
C6  
0
5
C5  
0
4
C4  
0
3
C3  
0
2
C2  
0
1
C1  
0
0
C0  
0
Bit 0/Transmit Code-Definition Bit 0 (C0). A don’t care if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected.  
Bit 1/Transmit Code-Definition Bit 1 (C1). A don’t care if a 5-bit or 6-bit length is selected.  
Bit 2/Transmit Code-Definition Bit 2 (C2). A don’t care if a 5-bit length is selected.  
Bits 3–6/Transmit Code-Definition Bits 3–6 (C3–C6)  
Bit 7/Transmit Code-Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern.  
Register Name:  
TCD2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Transmit Code Definition Register 2  
B8h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
C7  
0
6
C6  
0
5
C5  
0
4
C4  
0
3
C3  
0
2
C2  
0
1
C1  
0
0
C0  
0
Least significant byte of 16 bit codes.  
Bits 0–7/Transmit Code-Definition Bits 0–7 (C0–C7). A don’t care if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected.  
165 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RUPCD1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Up-Code Definition Register 1  
B9h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
C7  
0
6
C6  
0
5
C5  
0
4
C4  
0
3
C3  
0
2
C2  
0
1
C1  
0
0
C0  
0
Note: Writing this register resets the detector’s integration period.  
Bit 0/Receive Up-Code Definition Bits 0 (C0). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected.  
Bit 1/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 6-bit length is selected.  
Bit 2/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 5-bit length is selected.  
Bit 3/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 4-bit length is selected.  
Bit 4/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 3-bit length is selected.  
Bit 5/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A don’t care if a 1-bit or 2-bit length is selected.  
Bit 6/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A don’t care if a 1-bit length is selected.  
Bit 7/Receive Up-Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern.  
Register Name:  
RUPCD2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Up-Code Definition Register 2  
BAh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
C7  
0
6
C6  
0
5
C5  
0
4
C4  
0
3
C3  
0
2
C2  
0
1
C1  
0
0
C0  
0
Bits 0–7/Receive Up-Code Definition Bits 0–7 (C0–C7). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected.  
166 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RDNCD1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Down-Code Definition Register 1  
BBh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
C7  
0
6
C6  
0
5
C5  
0
4
C4  
0
3
C3  
0
2
C2  
0
1
C1  
0
0
C0  
0
Note: Writing this register resets the detector’s integration period.  
Bit 0/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected.  
Bit 1/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 6-bit length is selected.  
Bit 2/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 5-bit length is selected.  
Bit 3/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 4-bit length is selected.  
Bit 4/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 3-bit length is selected.  
Bit 5/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A don’t care if a 1-bit or 2-bit length is selected.  
Bit 6/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A don’t care if a 1-bit length is selected.  
Bit 7/Receive Down-Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern.  
Register Name:  
RDNCD2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Down-Code Definition Register 2  
BCh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
C7  
0
6
C6  
0
5
C5  
0
4
C4  
0
3
C3  
0
2
C2  
0
1
C1  
0
0
C0  
0
Bits 0–7/Receive Down-Code Definition Bits 0–7 (C0–C7). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected.  
167 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RSCC  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
In-Band Receive Spare Control Register  
BDh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
RSC2  
0
1
RSC1  
0
0
RSC0  
0
Bits 0 to 2/Receive Spare Code Length Definition Bits (RSC0 to RSC2)  
RSC2  
RSC1  
RSC0  
Length Selected (bits)  
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8/16  
Bits 3 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
168 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
RSCD1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Spare-Code Definition Register 1  
BEh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
C7  
0
6
C6  
0
5
C5  
0
4
C4  
0
3
C3  
0
2
C2  
0
1
C1  
0
0
C0  
0
Note: Writing this register resets the detector’s integration period.  
Bit 0/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected.  
Bit 1/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 6-bit length is selected.  
Bit 2/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 5-bit length is selected.  
Bit 3/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 4-bit length is selected.  
Bit 4/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 3-bit length is selected.  
Bit 5/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A don’t care if a 1-bit or 2-bit length is selected.  
Bit 6/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A don’t care if a 1-bit length is selected.  
Bit 7/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern.  
Register Name:  
RSCD2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Receive Spare Code Definition Register 2  
BFh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
C7  
0
6
C6  
0
5
C5  
0
4
C4  
0
3
C3  
0
2
C2  
0
1
C1  
0
0
C0  
0
Bits 0–7/Receive Spare-Code Definition Bits 0–7 (C0–C7). A don’t care if a 1-bit to 7-bit length is selected.  
169 of 238  
DS2155  
26. BERT FUNCTION  
The BERT block can generate and detect pseudorandom and repeating bit patterns. It is used to test and  
stress data communication links, and it is capable of generating and detecting the following patterns:  
The pseudorandom patterns 2E7, 2E11, 2E15, and QRSS  
A repetitive pattern from 1 to 32 bits in length  
Alternating (16-bit) words that flip every 1 to 256 words  
Daly pattern  
The BERT receiver has a 32-bit bit counter and a 24-bit error counter. The BERT receiver reports three  
events: a change in receive synchronizer status, a bit error being detected, and if either the bit counter or  
the error counter overflows. Each of these events can be masked within the BERT function through the  
BERT control register 1 (BC1). If the software detects that the BERT has reported an event, then the  
software must read the BERT information register (BIR) to determine which event(s) has occurred. To  
activate the BERT block, the host must configure the BERT mux through the BIC register.  
26.1Status  
SR9 contains the status information on the BERT function. The host can be alerted through this register  
when there is a BERT change-of-state. A major change-of-state is defined as either a change in the  
receive synchronization (i.e., the BERT has gone into or out of receive synchronization), a bit error has  
been detected, or an overflow has occurred in either the bit counter or the error counter. The host must  
read status register 9 (SR9) to determine the change-of-state.  
26.2Mapping  
The BERT function can be assigned to the network direction or backplane direction through the direction  
control bit in the BIC register (BIC.1). See Figure 26-1 and Figure 26-2. The BERT also can be assigned  
on a per-channel basis. The BERT transmit control selector (BTCS) and BERT receive control selector  
(BRCS) bits of the per-channel pointer register (PCPR) are used to map the BERT function into time slots  
of the transmit and receive data streams. In T1 mode, the user can enable mapping into the F-bit position  
for the transmit and receive directions through the RFUS and TFUS bits in the BERT interface control  
(BIC) register.  
170 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 26-1. Simplified Diagram of BERT in Network Direction  
TO RECEIVE  
FROM RECEIVE  
FRAMER  
SYSTEM  
BACKPLANE  
INTERFACE  
PER-CHANNEL AND  
F-BIT (T1 MODE)  
MAPPING  
BERT  
BERT  
RECEIVER TRANSMITTER  
1
0
TO TRANSMIT  
FRAMER  
FROM TRANSMIT  
SYSTEM  
BACKPLANE  
INTERFACE  
Figure 26-2. Simplified Diagram of BERT in Backplane Direction  
TO RECEIVE  
FROM RECEIVE  
FRAMER  
0
1
SYSTEM  
BACKPLANE  
INTERFACE  
PER-CHANNEL AND  
F-BIT (T1 MODE)  
MAPPING  
BERT  
BERT  
RECEIVER  
TRANSMITTER  
FROM TRANSMIT  
SYSTEM  
TO TRANSMIT  
FRAMER  
BACKPLANE  
INTERFACE  
171 of 238  
DS2155  
26.3BERT Register Descriptions  
Register Name:  
BC1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Control Register 1  
E0h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
TC  
0
6
TINV  
0
5
RINV  
0
4
PS2  
0
3
PS1  
0
2
PS0  
0
1
LC  
0
0
RESYNC  
0
Bit 0/Force Resynchronization (RESYNC). A low-to-high transition forces the receive BERT synchronizer to  
resynchronize to the incoming data stream. This bit should be toggled from low to high whenever the host wishes  
to acquire synchronization on a new pattern. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent resynchronization.  
Bit 1/Load Bit and Error Counters (LC). A low-to-high transition latches the current bit and error counts into  
registers BBC1/BBC2/BBC3/BBC4 and BEC1/BEC2/BEC3 and clears the internal count. This bit should be  
toggled from low to high whenever the host wishes to begin a new acquisition period. Must be cleared and set  
again for subsequent loads.  
Bits 2 to 4/Pattern Select Bits (PS0 to PS2)  
PS2 PS1 PS0  
Pattern Definition  
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
Pseudorandom 2E7 - 1  
Pseudorandom 2E11 - 1  
Pseudorandom 2E15 - 1  
Pseudorandom pattern QRSS. A 220 - 1 pattern with 14 consecutive zero  
restrictions.  
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
Repetitive pattern  
Alternating word pattern  
Modified 55 octet (Daly) pattern. The Daly pattern is a repeating 55 octet  
pattern that is byte-aligned into the active DS0 time slots. The pattern is  
defined in an ATIS (Alliance for Telecommunications Industry Solutions)  
Committee T1 Technical Report Number 25 (November 1993).  
Pseudorandom 2E9 - 1  
1
1
1
1
0
1
Bit 5/Receive Invert-Data Enable (RINV)  
0 = do not invert the incoming data stream  
1 = invert the incoming data stream  
Bit 6/Transmit Invert-Data Enable (TINV)  
0 = do not invert the outgoing data stream  
1 = invert the outgoing data stream  
Bit 7/Transmit Pattern Load (TC). A low-to-high transition loads the pattern generator with the pattern that is to  
be generated. This bit should be toggled from low to high whenever the host wishes to load a new pattern. Must be  
cleared and set again for subsequent loads.  
172 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
BC2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Control Register 2  
E1h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
EIB2  
0
6
EIB1  
0
5
EIB0  
0
4
SBE  
0
3
RPL3  
0
2
RPL2  
0
1
RPL1  
0
0
RPL0  
0
Bits 0 to 3/Repetitive Pattern Length Bit 3 (RPL0 to RPL3). RPL0 is the LSB and RPL3 is the MSB of a nibble  
that describes how long the repetitive pattern is. The valid range is 17 (0000) to 32 (1111). These bits are ignored if  
the receive BERT is programmed for a pseudorandom pattern. To create repetitive patterns fewer than 17 bits in  
length, the user must set the length to an integer number of the desired length that is less than or equal to 32. For  
example, to create a 6-bit pattern, the user can set the length to 18 (0001) or to 24 (0111) or to 30 (1101).  
Length  
RPL3  
RPL2 RPL1 RPL0  
(bits)  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Bit 4/Single Bit-Error Insert (SBE). A low-to-high transition creates a single-bit error. Must be cleared and set  
again for a subsequent bit error to be inserted.  
Bits 5 to 7/Error Insert Bits 0 to 2 (EIB0 to EIB2). Automatically inserts bit errors at the prescribed rate into the  
generated data pattern. Can be used for verifying error-detection features.  
EIB2  
EIB1  
EIB0  
Error Rate Inserted  
No errors automatically inserted  
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
10E-1  
10E-2  
10E-3  
10E-4  
10E-5  
10E-6  
10E-7  
173 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
SR9  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Status Register 9  
26h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
BBED  
0
5
BBCO  
0
4
BEC0  
0
3
BRA1  
0
2
1
0
BSYNC  
0
BRA0 BRLOS  
0
0
Bit 0/BERT in Synchronization Condition (BSYNC). Set when the incoming pattern matches for 32 consecutive  
bit positions. Refer to BSYNC in the INFO2 register for a real-time version of this bit. This is a double interrupt bit  
(Section 6.2).  
Bit 1/BERT Receive Loss-of-Synchronization Condition (BRLOS). A latched bit that is set whenever the  
receive BERT begins searching for a pattern. Once synchronization is achieved, this bit remains set until read. This  
is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).  
Bit 2/BERT Receive All-Zeros Condition (BRA0). A latched bit that is set when 32 consecutive 0s are received.  
Allowed to be cleared once a 1 is received. This is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).  
Bit 3/BERT Receive All-Ones Condition (BRA1). A latched bit that is set when 32 consecutive 1s are received.  
Allowed to be cleared once a 0 is received. This is a double interrupt bit (Section 6.2).  
Bit 4/BERT Error-Counter Overflow (BECO) Event (BECO). A latched bit that is set when the 24-bit BERT  
error counter (BEC) overflows. Cleared when read and is not set again until another overflow occurs.  
Bit 5/BERT Bit-Counter Overflow Event (BBCO). A latched bit that is set when the 32-bit BERT bit counter  
(BBC) overflows. Cleared when read and is not set again until another overflow occurs.  
Bit 6/BERT Bit-Error Detected (BED) Event (BBED). A latched bit that is set when a bit error is detected. The  
receive BERT must be in synchronization for it to detect bit errors. Cleared when read.  
174 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
IMR9  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Interrupt Mask Register 9  
27h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
BBED  
0
5
BBCO  
0
4
BEC0  
0
3
BRA1  
0
2
1
0
BSYNC  
0
BRA0 BRLOS  
0
0
Bit 0/BERT in Synchronization Condition (BSYNC)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 1/Receive Loss-of-Synchronization Condition (BRLOS)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 2/Receive All-Zeros Condition (BRA0)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 3/Receive All-Ones Condition (BRA1)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges  
Bit 4/BERT Error-Counter Overflow Event (BECO)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 5/BERT Bit-Counter Overflow Event (BBCO)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
Bit 6/Bit-Error Detected Event (BBED)  
0 = interrupt masked  
1 = interrupt enabled  
BERT Alternating Word-Count Rate. When the BERT is programmed in the alternating word mode, the words  
repeat for the count loaded into this register then flip to the other word and again repeat for the number of times  
loaded into this register.  
Register Name:  
BAWC  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Alternating Word-Count Rate  
DBh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ACNT7 ACNT6 ACNT5 ACNT4 ACNT3 ACNT2 ACNT1 ACNT0  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Alternating Word-Count Rate Bits 0 to 7 (ACNT0 to ACNT7). ACNT0 is the LSB of the 8-bit  
alternating word-count rate counter.  
175 of 238  
DS2155  
26.4 BERT Repetitive Pattern Set  
These registers must be properly loaded for the BERT to generate and synchronize to a repetitive pattern,  
a pseudorandom pattern, alternating word pattern, or a Daly pattern. For a repetitive pattern that is fewer  
than 32 bits, the pattern should be repeated so that all 32 bits are used to describe the pattern. For  
example, if the pattern was the repeating 5-bit pattern …01101… (where the rightmost bit is the one sent  
first and received first), then BRP1 should be loaded with ADh, BRP2 with B5h, BRP3 with D6h, and  
BRP4 with 5Ah. For a pseudorandom pattern, all four registers should be loaded with all 1s (i.e., FFh).  
For an alternating word pattern, one word should be placed into BRP1 and BRP2 and the other word  
should be placed into BRP3 and BRP4. For example, if the DDS stress pattern “7E” is to be described,  
the user would place 00h in BRP1, 00h in BRP2, 7Eh in BRP3, and 7Eh in BRP4 and the alternating  
word counter would be set to 50 (decimal) to allow 100 bytes of 00h followed by 100 bytes of 7Eh to be  
sent and received.  
Register Name:  
BRP1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 1  
DCh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RPAT0  
0
RPAT7 RPAT6 RPAT5 RPAT4 RPAT3 RPAT2 RPAT1  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 0 to 7 (RPAT0 to RPAT7). RPAT0 is the LSB of the 32-bit  
repetitive pattern set.  
Register Name:  
BRP2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 2  
DDh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
RPAT15  
0
6
5
4
3
2
RPAT10  
0
1
RPAT9  
0
0
RPAT8  
0
RPAT14 RPAT13 RPAT12 RPAT11  
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 8 to 15 (RPAT8 to RPAT15)  
Register Name:  
BRP3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 3  
DEh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
RPAT23  
0
6
5
4
3
2
RPAT18  
0
1
RPAT17  
0
0
RPAT16  
0
RPAT22 RPAT21 RPAT20 RPAT19  
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 16 to 23 (RPAT16 to RPAT23)  
Register Name:  
BRP4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 4  
DFh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
RPAT31  
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RPAT30 RPAT29 RPAT28 RPAT27 RPAT26 RPAT25 RPAT24  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 24 to 31 (RPAT24 to RPAT31). RPAT31 is the LSB of the 32-bit  
repetitive pattern set.  
176 of 238  
DS2155  
26.5 BERT Bit Counter  
Once BERT has achieved synchronization, this 32-bit counter increments for each data bit (i.e., clock)  
received. Toggling the LC control bit in BC1 can clear this counter. This counter saturates when full and  
sets the BBCO status bit.  
Register Name:  
BBC1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Bit Count Register 1  
E3h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
BBC7  
0
6
BBC6  
0
5
BBC5  
0
4
BBC4  
0
3
BBC3  
0
2
BBC2  
0
1
BBC1  
0
0
BBC0  
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Bit Counter Bits 0 to 7 (BBC0 to BBC7). BBC0 is the LSB of the 32-bit counter.  
Register Name:  
BBC2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Bit Count Register 2  
E4h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
BBC10  
0
1
BBC9  
0
0
BBC8  
0
BBC15 BBC14 BBC13 BBC12 BBC11  
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Bit Counter Bits 8 to 15 (BBC8 to BBC15)  
Register Name:  
BBC3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Bit Count Register 3  
E5h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
BBC16  
0
BBC23 BBC22 BBC21 BBC20 BBC19  
BBC18 BBC17  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Bit Counter Bits 16 to 23 (BBC16 to BBC23)  
Register Name:  
BBC4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Bit Count Register 4  
E6h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
BBC24  
0
BBC31 BBC30 BBC29 BBC28 BBC27  
BBC26 BBC25  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/BERT Bit Counter Bits 24 to 31 (BBC24 to BBC31). BBC31 is the MSB of the 32-bit counter.  
177 of 238  
DS2155  
26.6 BERT Error Counter  
Once BERT has achieved synchronization, this 24-bit counter increments for each data bit received in  
error. Toggling the LC control bit in BC1 can clear this counter. This counter saturates when full and sets  
the BECO status bit.  
Register Name:  
BEC1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Error-Count Register 1  
E7h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
EC7  
0
6
EC6  
0
5
EC5  
0
4
EC4  
0
3
EC3  
0
2
EC2  
0
1
EC1  
0
0
EC0  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Error Counter Bits 0 to 7 (EC0 to EC7). EC0 is the LSB of the 24-bit counter.  
Register Name:  
BEC2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Error-Count Register 2  
E8h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
EC15  
0
6
EC14  
0
5
EC13  
0
4
EC12  
0
3
EC11  
0
2
EC10  
0
1
EC9  
0
0
EC8  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Error Counter Bits 8 to 15 (EC8 to EC15)  
Register Name:  
BEC3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Error-Count Register 3  
E9h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
EC23  
0
6
EC22  
0
5
EC21  
0
4
EC20  
0
3
EC19  
0
2
EC18  
0
1
EC17  
0
0
EC16  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Error Counter Bits 16 to 23 (EC16 to EC23). EC0 is the MSB of the 24-bit counter.  
178 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
BIC  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
BERT Interface Control Register  
EAh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
RFUS  
0
5
0
4
TBAT  
0
3
TFUS  
0
2
0
1
0
BERTDIR BERTEN  
0
0
Bit 0/BERT Enable (BERTEN)  
0 = BERT disabled  
1 = BERT enabled  
Bit 1/BERT Direction (BERTDIR)  
0 = network  
BERT transmits toward the network (TTIP and TRING) and receives from the network (RTIP and  
RRING). The BERT pattern can be looped back to the receiver internally by using the framer loopback  
function.  
1 = system  
BERT transmits toward the system backplane (RSER) and receives from the system backplane (TSER).  
Bits 2, 5, 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
Bit 3/Transmit Framed/Unframed Select (TFUS)  
0 = BERT does not source data into the F-bit position (framed)  
1 = BERT does source data into the F-bit position (unframed)  
Bit 4/Transmit Byte-Align Toggle (TBAT). A 0-to-1 transition forces the BERT to byte align its pattern with the  
transmit formatter. This bit must be transitioned in order to byte align the Daly pattern.  
Bit 6/Receive Framed/Unframed Select (RFUS)  
0 = BERT is not sent data from the F-bit position (framed)  
1 = BERT is sent data from the F-bit position (unframed)  
179 of 238  
DS2155  
27. PAYLOAD ERROR-INSERTION FUNCTION (T1 MODE ONLY)  
An error-insertion function is available in the DS2155 and is used to create errors in the payload portion  
of the T1 frame in the transmit path. This function is only available in T1 mode. Errors can be inserted  
over the entire frame or the user can select which channels are to be corrupted. Errors are created by  
inverting the last bit in the count sequence. For example, if the error rate 1 in 16 is selected, the 16th bit is  
inverted. F-bits are excluded from the count and are never corrupted. Error rate changes occur on frame  
boundaries. Error-insertion options include continuous and absolute number with both options supporting  
selectable insertion rates.  
Table 27-A. Transmit Error-Insertion Setup Sequence  
STEP  
ACTION  
1
Enter desired error rate in the ERC register. Note: If ER3 through ER0 = 0, no errors  
are generated even if the constant error-insertion feature is enabled.  
For constant error insertion, set CE = 1 (ERC.4).  
2A  
or  
2B  
For a defined number of errors:  
Set CE = 0 (ERC.4)  
Load NOE1 and NOE2 with the number of errors to be inserted  
Toggle WNOE (ERC.7) from 0 to 1 to begin error insertion  
180 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
ERC  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Error-Rate Control Register  
EBh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
WNOE  
0
6
0
5
0
4
CE  
0
3
ER3  
0
2
ER2  
0
1
ER1  
0
0
ER0  
0
Bits 0 to 3/Error-Insertion Rate Select Bits (ER0 to ER3)  
ER3 ER2 ER1 ER0  
Error Rate  
No errors inserted  
1 in 16  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1 in 32  
1 in 64  
1 in 128  
1 in 256  
1 in 512  
1 in 1024  
1 in 2048  
1 in 4096  
1 in 8192  
1 in 16,384  
1 in 32,768  
1 in 65,536  
1 in 131,072  
1 in 262,144  
Bit 4/Constant Errors (CE). When this bit is set high (and the ER0 to ER3 bits are not set to 0000), the error-  
insertion logic ignores the number-of-error registers (NOE1, NOE2) and generates errors constantly at the selected  
insertion rate. When CE is set to 0, the NOEx registers determine how many errors are to be inserted.  
Bits 5, 6/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
Bit 7/Write NOE Registers (WNOE). If the host wishes to update to the NOEx registers, this bit must be toggled  
from a 0 to a 1 after the host has already loaded the prescribed error count into the NOEx registers. The toggling of  
this bit causes the error count loaded into the NOEx registers to be loaded into the error-insertion circuitry on the  
next clock cycle. Subsequent updates require that the WNOE bit be set to 0 and then 1 once again.  
181 of 238  
DS2155  
27.1Number-of-Errors Registers  
The number-of-error registers determine how many errors are generated. Up to 1023 errors can be  
generated. The host loads the number of errors to be generated into the NOE1 and NOE2 registers. The  
host can also update the number of errors to be created by first loading the prescribed value into the NOE  
registers and then toggling the WNOE bit in the error-rate control registers.  
Table 27-B. Error Insertion Examples  
VALUE  
WRITE  
READ  
000h  
001h  
002h  
3FFh  
Do not create any errors  
Create a single error  
Create two errors  
No errors left to be inserted  
One error left to be inserted  
Two errors left to be inserted  
1023 errors left to be inserted  
Create 1023 errors  
Register Name:  
NOE1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Number-of-Errors 1  
ECh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
C7  
0
6
C6  
0
5
C5  
0
4
C4  
0
3
C3  
0
2
C2  
0
1
C1  
0
0
C0  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Number-of-Errors Counter Bits 0 to 7 (C0 to C7). Bit C0 is the LSB of the 10-bit counter.  
Register Name:  
NOE2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Number-of-Errors 2  
EDh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
C9  
0
0
C8  
0
Bits 0, 1/Number-of-Errors Counter Bits 8 to 9 (C8 to C9). Bit C9 is the MSB of the 10-bit counter.  
182 of 238  
DS2155  
27.1.1 Number-of-Errors Left Register  
The host can read the NOELx registers at any time to determine how many errors are left to be inserted.  
Register Name:  
NOEL1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Number-of-Errors Left 1  
EEh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
C7  
0
6
C6  
0
5
C5  
0
4
C4  
0
3
C3  
0
2
C2  
0
1
C1  
0
0
C0  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Number-of-Errors Left Counter Bits 0 to 7 (C0 to C7). Bit C0 is the LSB of the 10-bit counter.  
Register Name:  
NOEL2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Number-of-Errors Left 2  
EFh  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
0
1
C9  
0
0
C8  
0
Bits 0, 1/Number-of-Errors Left Counter Bits 8 to 9 (C8 to C9). Bit C9 is the MSB of the 10-bit counter.  
183 of 238  
DS2155  
28. INTERLEAVED PCM BUS OPERATION (IBO)  
In many architectures, the PCM outputs of individual framers are combined into higher speed PCM buses  
to simplify transport across the system backplane. The DS2155 can be configured to allow PCM data to  
be multiplexed into higher speed buses eliminating external hardware, saving board space and cost. The  
DS2155 can be configured for channel or frame interleave.  
The interleaved PCM bus operation (IBO) supports three bus speeds. The 4.096MHz bus speed allows  
two PCM data streams to share a common bus. The 8.192MHz bus speed allows four PCM data streams  
to share a common bus. The 16.384MHz bus speed allows eight PCM data streams to share a common  
bus. See Figure 28-1 for an example of four transceivers sharing a common 8.192MHz PCM bus. The  
receive elastic stores of each transceiver must be enabled. Through the IBO register, the user can  
configure each transceiver for a specific bus position. For all IBO bus configurations, each transceiver is  
assigned an exclusive position in the high-speed PCM bus. The 8kHz frame sync can be generated from  
the system backplane or from the first device on the bus. All other devices on the bus must have their  
frame syncs configured as inputs. Relative to this common frame sync, the devices await their turn to  
drive or sample the bus according to the settings of the DA0, DA1, and DA2 bits of the IBOC register.  
28.1Channel Interleave  
In channel interleave mode, data is output to the PCM data-out bus one channel at a time from each of the  
connected DS2155s until all channels of frame n from each DS2155 have been placed on the bus. This  
mode can be used even when the DS2155s are operating asynchronous to each other. The elastic stores  
manage slip conditions (Figure 35-22).  
28.2Frame Interleave  
In frame interleave mode, data is output to the PCM data-out bus one frame at a time from each of the  
DS2155s. This mode is used only when all connected DS2155s are operating in a synchronous fashion  
(all inbound T1 or E1 lines are synchronous) and are synchronous with the system clock (system clock  
derived from T1 or E1 line). Slip conditions are not allowed in this mode (Figure 35-23).  
184 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
IBOC  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Interleave Bus Operation Control Register  
C5h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
IBS1  
0
5
IBS0  
0
4
3
2
1
DA1  
0
0
DA0  
0
IBOSEL IBOEN DA2  
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 2/Device Assignment Bits (DA0 to DA2)  
DA2  
DA1  
DA0  
Device Position on Bus  
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1st  
2nd  
3rd  
4th  
5th  
6th  
7th  
8th  
Bit 3/Interleave Bus Operation Enable (IBOEN)  
0 = IBO disabled  
1 = IBO enabled  
Bit 4/Interleave Bus Operation Select (IBOSEL). This bit selects channel or frame interleave mode.  
0 = channel interleave  
1 = frame interleave  
Bits 5, 6/IBO Bus Size Bit 1 (IBS0 to IBS1). Indicates how many devices are on the bus.  
IBS1  
IBS0  
Bus Size  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Two devices on bus  
Four devices on bus  
Eight devices on bus  
Reserved for future use  
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
185 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 28-1. IBO Example  
RSYSCLK  
TSYSCLK  
RSYSCLK  
TSYSCLK  
RSYNC  
RSYNC  
TSSYNC  
TSSYNC  
RSIG  
TSIG  
RSIG  
TSIG  
TSER  
TSER  
RSER  
RSER  
DS2155 #1  
DS2155 #3  
8.192MHz SYSTEM CLOCK IN  
SYSTEM 8kHz FRAME SYNC IN  
PCM SIGNALING OUT  
PCM SIGNALING IN  
PCM DATA IN  
PCM DATA OUT  
RSYSCLK  
TSYSCLK  
RSYSCLK  
TSYSCLK  
RSYNC  
RSYNC  
TSSYNC  
TSSYNC  
RSIG  
TSIG  
RSIG  
TSIG  
TSER  
TSER  
RSER  
RSER  
DS2155 #2  
DS2155 #4  
186 of 238  
DS2155  
29. EXTENDED SYSTEM INFORMATION BUS (ESIB)  
The extended system information bus (ESIB) allows up to eight DS2155s to share an 8-bit CPU bus for  
reporting alarms and interrupt status as a group. With a single bus read, the host can be updated with  
alarm or interrupt status from all members of the group. There are two control registers (ESIBCR1 and  
ESIBCR2) and four information registers (ESIB1, ESIB2, ESIB3, and ESIB4). For example, eight  
DS2155s can be grouped into an ESIB group. A single read of the ESIB1 register of any member of the  
group yields the interrupt status of all eight DS2155s. Therefore, the host can determine which device or  
devices are causing an interrupt without polling all eight devices. Through ESIB2, the host can gather  
synchronization status on all members of the group. ESIB3 and ESIB4 can be programmed to report  
various alarms on a device-by-device basis.  
There are three device pins involved in forming an ESIB group: ESIBS0, ESIBS1, and ESIBRD. A 10kΩ  
pullup resistor must be provided on ESIBS0, ESIBS1, and ESIBRD.  
Figure 29-1. ESIB Group of Four DS2155s  
VDD  
10k(3)  
DS2155 # 1  
ESIB0  
CPU I/F  
ESIB1  
ESIBRD  
DS2155 # 2  
ESIB0  
ESIB1  
CPU I/F  
ESIBRD  
DS2155 # 3  
ESIB0  
ESIB1  
CPU I/F  
ESIBRD  
DS2155 # 4  
ESIB0  
ESIB1  
CPU I/F  
ESIBRD  
187 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
ESIBCR1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Extended System Information Bus Control Register 1  
B0h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
2
1
0
ESIBSEL2 ESIBSEL1 ESIBSEL0 ESIEN  
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Extended System Information Bus Enable (ESIEN)  
0 = disabled  
1 = enabled  
Bits 1 to 3/Output Data Bus Line Select (ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2). These bits tell the DS2155 what data bus  
bit to output the ESIB data on when one of the ESIB information registers is accessed. Each member of the ESIB  
group must have a unique bit selected.  
ESIBSEL2 ESIBSEL1 ESIBSEL0  
Bus Bit Driven  
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
AD0  
AD1  
AD2  
AD3  
AD4  
AD5  
AD6  
AD7  
Bits 4 to 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
188 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
ESIBCR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Extended System Information Bus Control Register 2  
B1h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
5
4
3
0
2
1
0
ESI4SEL2 ESI4SEL1 ESI4SEL0  
ESI3SEL2 ESI3SEL1 ESI3SEL0  
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 2/Address ESI3 Data Output Select (ESI3SEL0 to ESI3SEL2). These bits select what status is to be  
output when the DS2155 decodes an ESI3 address during a bus read operation.  
Status Output  
(T1 Mode)  
RBL  
Status Output  
(E1 Mode)  
RUA1  
ESI3SEL2 ESI3SEL1 ESI3SEL0  
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
RYEL  
LUP  
RRA  
RDMA  
V52LNK  
SIGCHG  
ESSLIP  
LDN  
SIGCHG  
ESSLIP  
Bit 3/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
Bits 4 to 6/Address ESI4 Data-Output Select (ESI4SEL0 to ESI4SEL2). These bits select what status is to be  
output when the DS2155 decodes an ESI4 address during a bus read operation.  
Status Output  
(T1 Mode)  
RBL  
Status Output  
(E1 Mode)  
RUA1  
ESI4SEL2 ESI4SEL1 ESI4SEL0  
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
RYEL  
LUP  
RRA  
RDMA  
V52LNK  
SIGCHG  
ESSLIP  
LDN  
SIGCHG  
ESSLIP  
Bit 7/Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
189 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
ESIB1  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Extended System Information Bus Register 1  
B2h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
DISn  
0
6
DISn  
0
5
DISn  
0
4
DISn  
0
3
DISn  
0
2
DISn  
0
1
DISn  
0
0
DISn  
0
Bits 0 to 7/Device Interrupt Status (DISn). Causes all devices participating in the ESIB group to output their  
interrupt status on the appropriate data bus line selected by the ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2 bits of the ESIBCR1  
register.  
Register Name:  
ESIB2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Extended System Information Bus Register 2  
B3h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DRLOSn DRLOSn DRLOSn DRLOSn DRLOSn DRLOSn DRLOSn DRLOSn  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 0 to 7/Device Receive Loss-of-Sync (DRLOSn). Causes all devices participating in the ESIB group to output  
their frame synchronization status on the appropriate data bus line selected by the ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2 bits of  
the ESIBCR1 register.  
Register Name:  
ESIB3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Extended System Information Bus Register 3  
B4h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
UST1n  
0
6
UST1n  
0
5
UST1n  
0
4
UST1n  
0
3
UST1n  
0
2
UST1n  
0
1
UST1n  
0
0
UST1n  
0
Bits 0 to 7/User-Selected Status 1 (UST1n). Causes all devices participating in the ESIB group to output status or  
alarms as selected by the ESI3SEL0 to ESI3SEL2 bits in the ESIBCR2 configuration register on the appropriate  
data bus line selected by the ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2 bits of the ESIBCR2 register  
Register Name:  
ESIB4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Extended System Information Bus Register 4  
B5h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
UST2n  
0
6
UST2n  
0
5
UST2n  
0
4
UST2n  
0
3
UST2n  
0
2
UST2n  
0
1
UST2n  
0
0
UST2n  
0
Bits 0 to 7/User-Selected Status 2 (UST2n). Causes all devices participating in the ESIB group to output status or  
alarms as selected by the ESI4SEL0 to ESI4SEL2 bits in the ESIBCR2 configuration register on the appropriate  
data bus line selected by the ESIBSEL0 to ESIBSEL2 bits of the ESIBCR2 register  
190 of 238  
DS2155  
30. PROGRAMMABLE BACKPLANE CLOCK SYNTHESIZER  
The DS2155 contains an on-chip clock synthesizer that generates a user-selectable clock output on the  
BPCLK pin, referenced to the recovered receive clock (RCLK). The synthesizer uses a phase-locked loop  
to generate low-jitter clocks. Common applications include generation of port and backplane system  
clocks. The CCR2 register is used to enable (CCR2.0) and select (CCR2.1 and CCR2.2) the clock  
frequency of the BPCLK pin.  
Register Name:  
CCR2  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Common Control Register 2  
71h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
0
6
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
BPCS1  
0
1
BPCS0  
0
0
BPEN  
0
Bit 0/Backplane Clock Enable (BPEN)  
0 = disable BPCLK pin (pin held at logic 0)  
1 = enable BPCLK pin  
Bits 1, 2/Backplane Clock Selects (BPCS0, BPCS1)  
BPCS1  
BPCS0  
BPCLK Frequency (MHz)  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
16.384  
8.192  
4.096  
2.048  
Bits 3 to 7/ Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
31. FRACTIONAL T1/E1 SUPPORT  
The DS2155 can be programmed to output gapped clocks for selected channels in the receive and  
transmit paths to simplify connections into a USART or LAPD controller in fractional T1/E1 or ISDN-  
PRI applications. The receive and transmit paths have independent enables. Channel formats supported  
include 56kbps and 64kbps. This is accomplished by assigning an alternate function to the RCHCLK and  
TCHCLK pins. Setting CCR3.0 = 1 causes the RCHCLK pin to output a gapped clock as defined by the  
receive fractional T1/E1 function of the PCPR register. Setting CCR3.2 = 1 causes the TCHCLK pin to  
output a gapped clock as defined by the transmit fractional T1/E1 function of the PCPR register. CCR3.1  
and CCR3.3 can be used to select between 64kbps and 56kbps operation. See Section 7 for details about  
programming the per-channel function. In T1 mode no clock is generated at the F-bit position.  
When 56kbps mode is selected, the LSB clock in the channel is omitted. Only the seven most significant  
bits of the channel have clocks.  
191 of 238  
DS2155  
Register Name:  
CCR3  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Common Control Register 3  
72h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
6
5
-
0
4
-
0
3
2
1
0
TMSS INTDIS  
TDATFMT TGPCKEN  
RDATFMT  
0
RGPCKEN  
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 0/Receive Gapped-Clock Enable (RGPCKEN)  
0 = RCHCLK functions normally  
1 = enable gapped bit-clock output on RCHCLK  
Bit 1/Receive Channel-Data Format (RDATFMT)  
0 = 64kbps (data contained in all 8 bits)  
1 = 56kbps (data contained in seven out of the 8 bits)  
Bit 2/Transmit Gapped-Clock Enable (TGPCKEN)  
0 = TCHCLK functions normally  
1 = enable gapped bit-clock output on TCHCLK  
Bit 3/Transmit Channel-Data Format (TDATFMT)  
0 = 64kbps (data contained in all 8 bits)  
1 = 56kbps (data contained in seven out of the 8 bits)  
Bit 4/ Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
Bit 5/ Unused, must be set to 0 for proper operation  
Bit 6/Interrupt Disable (INTDIS). This bit is convenient for disabling interrupts without altering the various  
interrupt mask register settings.  
0 = interrupts are enabled according to the various mask register settings  
1 = interrupts are disabled regardless of the mask register settings  
Bit 7/Transmit Multiframe Sync Source (TMSS). Should be set = 0 only when transmit hardware signaling is  
enabled.  
0 = elastic store is source of multiframe sync  
1 = framer or TSYNC pin is source of multiframe sync  
192 of 238  
DS2155  
32. USER-PROGRAMMABLE OUTPUT PINS  
The DS2155 provides four user-programmable output pins. The pins are automatically cleared to 0 at  
power-up or as a result of a hardware- or software-issued reset.  
Register Name:  
CCR4  
Register Description:  
Register Address:  
Common Control Register 4  
73h  
Bit #  
Name  
Default  
7
RLT3  
0
6
RLT2  
0
5
RLT1  
0
4
RLT0  
0
3
UOP3  
0
2
UOP2  
0
1
UOP1  
0
0
UOP0  
0
Bit 0/User-Defined Output 0 (UOP0)  
0 = logic 0 level at pin  
1 = logic 1 level at pin  
Bit 1/User-Defined Output 1 (UOP1)  
0 = logic 0 level at pin  
1 = logic 1 level at pin  
Bit 2/User-Defined Output 2 (UOP2)  
0 = logic 0 level at pin  
1 = logic 1 level at pin  
Bit 3/User-Defined Output 3 (UOP3)  
0 = logic 0 level at pin  
1 = logic 1 level at pin  
Bits 4 to 7/Receive Level Threshold Bits (RLT0 to RLT3)  
RLT3  
RLT2  
RLT1  
RLT0  
Receive Level (dB)  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Greater than -2.5  
-2.5  
-5.0  
-7.5  
-10.0  
-12.5  
-15.0  
-17.5  
-20.0  
-22.5  
-25.0  
-27.5  
-30.0  
-32.5  
-35.0  
Less than -37.5  
193 of 238  
DS2155  
33. TRANSMIT FLOW DIAGRAMS  
Figure 33-1. T1 Transmit Flow Diagram  
TSER  
TSIG  
T1 TRANSMIT  
FLOW  
Hardware  
Signaling  
HSIE1-3  
through  
PCPR  
DIAGRAM  
TX  
ESTORE  
KEY  
Estore Mux  
ESCR.4 TESE  
- PIN  
- SELECTOR  
- REGISTER  
TESO  
Off-Chip  
RDATA  
From  
Connection  
T1_rcv_logic  
TDATA  
Payload  
Loopback  
LBCR1.1 PLB  
HDLC  
Engine  
#1  
TLINK  
THMS1 H1TC.4  
H1TCS1-3  
H1TC.4  
THMS1  
HDLC FDL #1  
HDLC Mux #1  
H1TTSBS  
HDLC  
Engine  
#2  
THMS2 H2TC.4  
H2TCS1-3  
H2TC.4  
THMS2  
HDLC Mux #2  
HDLC FDL #2  
TFDL  
H2TTSBS  
Idle  
Code  
Array  
Tx FDL  
Zero  
T1TCR2.5  
TZSE  
Stuffer  
TCICE1-3  
Idle Code Mux  
T1TCR1.2  
TFDLS  
TFDL  
FDL Mux  
Loop  
Code  
Gen  
BOC  
Engine  
Loop Code  
TLOOP T1CCR1.0  
BOC Mux  
BOCC.0 SBOC  
T1CCR1.2 TFM  
T1TCR2.2 TD4YM  
T1TCR1.0 TYEL  
D4 12th Fs  
Yellow  
Per-Channel  
PCLR1-3  
Loopback  
alarm  
Software  
Sig  
Registers  
FPS or  
ESF Yellow  
Ft/Fs  
SSIE1-3  
Alarm  
Software Sig  
insertion  
F-bit Mux  
To FDL Mux  
TFPT T1TCR1.5  
To ESF Yellow  
Mux  
To FDL Mux  
194 of 238  
DS2155  
From ESF  
From BOC Mux  
From F-bit Mux  
Yellow Alarm  
TFPT T1TCR1.5  
FDL Mux  
TFM T1CCR1.2  
TYEL T1TCR1.0  
ESF Yellow  
CRC Mux  
TCPT T1TCR1.5  
D4 bit 2  
Yellow  
Alm  
TFM T1CCR1.2  
BERT  
TD4YM T1TCR2.2  
TYEL T1TCR1.0  
Engine  
TFUS BIC.3  
F-bit  
BERT Mux  
BERTEN  
BIC.0  
BTCS1-3  
from PCPR  
T1TCR2.3 FBCT1  
T1TCR2.4 FBCT2  
F-bit  
Corruption  
Payload  
error  
NOEL != 0  
ERC.4 CE  
insertion  
SSIE1-3  
GB7S T1TCR1.3  
PEICS1-3  
Bit 7  
stuffing  
B7SE T1TCR2.0  
Pulse  
Density  
Enforcer  
T1CCR1.1 PDE  
TPDV INFO1.6  
CRC  
DS0  
TCM0-4 TDS0SEL.0 - .3  
TDSOM  
Calculation  
Monitor  
B8ZS  
Encoding  
T1TCR2.7 B8ZSE  
Blue  
T1TCR1.1 TBL  
Alarm  
Bipolar/  
NRZ  
IOCR1.0 ODF  
coding  
1/2 CLK/  
CCR1.4 ODM  
FULL CLK  
TPOS  
TNEG  
195 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 33-2. E1 Transmit Flow Diagram  
TSER  
TSIG  
E1 TRANSMIT  
FLOW  
Hardware  
HSIE1-4  
DIAGRAM  
Signaling  
through  
PCPR  
TX  
ESTORE  
Estore Mux  
TESO  
ESCR.4 TESE  
Off-Chip  
Connection  
TDATA  
RDATA  
From  
E1_rcv_logic  
Payload  
LBCR1.1 PLB  
HDLC  
Engine  
#1  
Loopback Mux  
THMS1 H1TC.4  
H1TCS1-4  
HDLC DS0  
Mux #1  
H1TTSBS  
THMS1 H1TC.4  
HDLC Sa-bit  
Mux #1  
T1SaBE4-  
H1TTSBS.4 - H1TTSBS.0  
T1SaBE8  
HDLC  
Engine #2  
THMS2 H2TC.4  
H2TCS1-4  
HDLC DS0  
Mux #2  
H2TTSBS  
KEY  
- PIN  
THMS2 H2TC.4  
HDLC Sa-bit  
Mux #2  
T2SaBE4-T2SaBE8  
H2TTSBS.4 - H2TTSBS.0  
BERT  
Engine  
- SELECTOR  
- REGISTER  
BERTEN (BIC.0)  
BERT Mux  
BTCS1-4  
from PCPR  
Idle Code  
Array  
TCICE1-4  
Idle Code MUX  
To Per-Channel Mux  
196 of 238  
DS2155  
From Idle  
Code Mux  
RDATA  
From E1_rcv_logic  
E1 TRANSMIT  
Per-Channel  
Loopback  
FLOW  
PCLR1-4  
TNAF  
DIAGRAM  
H1TC.4  
H2TC.4  
THMS1  
THMS2  
Sa-bit Mux  
TAF/TNAF(non Sa)  
TS0 Mux  
TFPT E1TCR1.7  
Si-bit Mux  
E1TCR1.4 TSIS  
Si = CRC4 MF Align Word  
(Does not overwrite E-bits)  
E1TCR1.0 TCRC4  
E1TCR2.2 AEBE  
Si/CRC4 Mux  
TLINK  
Auto E-  
bit Gen  
TLINK Mux  
Sa4S - Sa8S  
E1TCR2.5 - E1TCR2.7  
TSiAF  
TSiNAF  
TRA  
TSa5  
TSa6  
TSa7  
TSa8  
Auto  
E1TCR2.8 ARA  
RA Gen  
TSa4  
TSaCR Mux  
TSaCR  
TS1-16  
TSA1 E1TCR1.3  
SSIE1-4  
Software Sig  
E1TCR1.0 T16S  
CRC  
E1TCR1.0 TCRC4  
Calculate  
TDS0SEL.0 - TDS0SEL.4  
TCM0-TCM4  
CRC Re-  
calculate  
CCR1.6 CRC4R  
E1TCR2.1 AAIS  
DS0  
TDSOM  
Monitor  
Auto  
AIS  
Gen  
UA1  
Gen  
E1TCR1.5 TUA1  
E1TCR1.2 THDB3  
HDB3  
Encoding  
To Bipolar/NRZ  
coding Mux  
197 of 238  
DS2155  
From HDB3  
Encoding Mux  
E1 TRANSMIT  
FLOW  
FLB LBCR1.0  
Bipolar/  
NRZ  
DIAGRAM  
IOCR1.0 ODF  
coding  
FLB  
TO RECEIVER  
Select  
RPOS  
RNEG  
RLB Mux  
RLB Mux  
RLB  
LBCR1.2  
1/2 CLK/  
CCR1.4 ODM  
FULL CLK  
TPOS  
TNEG  
198 of 238  
DS2155  
34. JTAG BOUNDARY SCAN ARCHITECTURE AND TEST ACCESS PORT  
34.1 Description  
The DS2155 IEEE 1149.1 design supports the standard instruction codes SAMPLE/PRELOAD,  
BYPASS, and EXTEST. Optional public instructions included are HIGH-Z, CLAMP, and IDCODE  
(Figure 34-1.). The DS2155 contains the following features as required by IEEE 1149.1 standard test  
access port (TAP) and boundary scan architecture.  
Test Access Port  
TAP Controller  
Instruction Register  
Bypass Register  
Boundary Scan Register  
Device Identification Register  
The DS2155 is pin-compatible with the DS2152, DS21x52 (T1) and DS2154, DS21x54 (E1) SCT  
families. The JTAG feature uses pins that had no function in the DS2152 and DS2154. Details about  
boundary scan architecture and the TAP are in IEEE 1149.1-1990, IEEE 1149.1a-1993, and IEEE  
1149.1b-1994. NOTE: JTAG functionality is production tested at 25C only.  
The TAP contains the necessary interface pins JTRST, JTCLK, JTMS, JTDI, and JTDO. See the pin  
descriptions in Section 4 for details.  
Figure 34-1. JTAG Functional Block Diagram  
BOUNDARY SCAN  
REGISTER  
IDENTIFICATION  
REGISTER  
BYPASS  
REGISTER  
MUX  
INSTRUCTION  
REGISTER  
SELECT  
TEST ACCESS PORT  
OUTPUT ENABLE  
CONTROLLER  
+V  
+V  
+V  
10k  
10kΩ  
10kΩ  
JTDO  
JTDI  
JTMS  
JTCLK  
JTRST  
199 of 238  
 
DS2155  
TAP Controller State Machine  
The TAP controller is a finite state machine that responds to the logic level at JTMS on the rising edge of  
JTCLK (Figure 34-2).  
Test-Logic-Reset  
Upon power-up, the TAP controller is in the Test-Logic-Reset state. The instruction register contains the  
IDCODE instruction. All system logic of the device operates normally.  
Run-Test-Idle  
The Run-Test-Idle is used between scan operations or during specific tests. The instruction register and  
test registers remain idle.  
Select-DR-Scan  
All test registers retain their previous state. With JTMS LOW, a rising edge of JTCLK moves the  
controller into the Capture-DR state and initiates a scan sequence. JTMS HIGH during a rising edge on  
JTCLK moves the controller to the Select-IR-Scan state.  
Capture-DR  
Data can be parallel-loaded into the test data registers selected by the current instruction. If the instruction  
does not call for a parallel load or the selected register does not allow parallel loads, the test register  
remains at its current value. On the rising edge of JTCLK, the controller goes to the Shift-DR state if  
JTMS is LOW or it goes to the Exit1-DR state if JTMS is HIGH.  
Shift-DR  
The test data register selected by the current instruction is connected between JTDI and JTDO and shifts  
data one stage toward its serial output on each rising edge of JTCLK. If a test register selected by the  
current instruction is not placed in the serial path, it maintains its previous state.  
Exit1-DR  
While in this state, a rising edge on JTCLK puts the controller in the Update-DR state, which terminates  
the scanning process, if JTMS is HIGH. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW puts the controller in  
the Pause-DR state.  
Pause-DR  
Shifting of the test registers is halted while in this state. All test registers selected by the current  
instruction retain their previous state. The controller remains in this state while JTMS is LOW. A rising  
edge on JTCLK with JTMS HIGH puts the controller in the Exit2-DR state.  
Exit2-DR  
A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS HIGH while in this state puts the controller in the Update-DR state  
and terminates the scanning process. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW enters the Shift-DR state.  
Update-DR  
A falling edge on JTCLK while in the Update-DR state latches the data from the shift register path of the  
test registers into the data output latches. This prevents changes at the parallel output because of changes  
in the shift register.  
200 of 238  
DS2155  
Select-IR-Scan  
All test registers retain their previous state. The instruction register remains unchanged during this state.  
With JTMS LOW, a rising edge on JTCLK moves the controller into the Capture-IR state and initiates a  
scan sequence for the instruction register. JTMS HIGH during a rising edge on JTCLK puts the controller  
back into the Test-Logic-Reset state.  
Capture-IR  
The Capture-IR state is used to load the shift register in the instruction register with a fixed value. This  
value is loaded on the rising edge of JTCLK. If JTMS is HIGH on the rising edge of JTCLK, the  
controller enters the Exit1-IR state. If JTMS is LOW on the rising edge of JTCLK, the controller enters  
the Shift-IR state.  
Shift-IR  
In this state, the shift register in the instruction register is connected between JTDI and JTDO and shifts  
data one stage for every rising edge of JTCLK toward the serial output. The parallel register and all test  
registers remain at their previous states. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS HIGH moves the controller  
to the Exit1-IR state. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW keeps the controller in the Shift-IR state  
while moving data one stage through the instruction shift register.  
Exit1-IR  
A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW puts the controller in the Pause-IR state. If JTMS is HIGH on  
the rising edge of JTCLK, the controller enters the Update-IR state and terminates the scanning process.  
Pause-IR  
Shifting of the instruction shift register is halted temporarily. With JTMS HIGH, a rising edge on JTCLK  
puts the controller in the Exit2-IR state. The controller remains in the Pause-IR state if JTMS is LOW  
during a rising edge on JTCLK.  
Exit2-IR  
A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW puts the controller in the Update-IR state. The controller loops  
back to Shift-IR if JTMS is HIGH during a rising edge of JTCLK in this state.  
Update-IR  
The instruction code shifted into the instruction shift register is latched into the parallel output on the  
falling edge of JTCLK as the controller enters this state. Once latched, this instruction becomes the  
current instruction. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW puts the controller in the Run-Test-Idle  
state. With JTMS HIGH, the controller enters the Select-DR-Scan state.  
201 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 34-2. TAP Controller State Diagram  
Test Logic  
1
Reset  
0
1
1
1
Run Test/  
Select  
Select  
0
Idle  
DR-Scan  
IR-Scan  
0
0
1
1
Capture DR  
Capture IR  
0
0
Shift DR  
Shift IR  
0
1
0
1
1
1
Exit DR  
Exit IR  
0
0
Pause DR  
Pause IR  
0
0
1
1
0
0
Exit2 DR  
Exit2 IR  
1
1
Update DR  
Update IR  
1
0
1
0
34.2Instruction Register  
The instruction register contains a shift register as well as a latched parallel output and is 3 bits in length.  
When the TAP controller enters the Shift-IR state, the instruction shift register is connected between JTDI  
and JTDO. While in the Shift-IR state, a rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW shifts the data one stage  
toward the serial output at JTDO. A rising edge on JTCLK in the Exit1-IR state or the Exit2-IR state with  
JTMS HIGH moves the controller to the Update-IR state. The falling edge of that same JTCLK latches  
the data in the instruction shift register to the instruction parallel output. Instructions supported by the  
DS2155 and its respective operational binary codes are shown in Table 17-A.  
202 of 238  
DS2155  
Table 34-A. Instruction Codes for IEEE 1149.1 Architecture  
INSTRUCTION  
SELECTED REGISTER  
INSTRUCTION CODES  
SAMPLE/PRELOAD  
BYPASS  
Boundary Scan  
Bypass  
010  
111  
000  
011  
100  
001  
EXTEST  
Boundary Scan  
Bypass  
CLAMP  
HIGHZ  
Bypass  
Device Identification  
IDCODE  
SAMPLE/PRELOAD  
This is a mandatory instruction for the IEEE 1149.1 specification that supports two functions. The digital  
I/Os of the device can be sampled at the boundary scan register without interfering with the normal  
operation of the device by using the Capture-DR state. SAMPLE/PRELOAD also allows the device to  
shift data into the boundary scan register through JTDI using the Shift-DR state.  
BYPASS  
When the BYPASS instruction is latched into the parallel instruction register, JTDI connects to JTDO  
through the 1-bit bypass test register. This allows data to pass from JTDI to JTDO without affecting the  
device’s normal operation.  
EXTEST  
This allows testing of all interconnections to the device. When the EXTEST instruction is latched in the  
instruction register, the following actions occur: Once enabled through the Update-IR state, the parallel  
outputs of all digital output pins are driven. The boundary scan register is connected between JTDI and  
JTDO. The Capture-DR samples all digital inputs into the boundary scan register.  
CLAMP  
All digital outputs of the device output data from the boundary scan parallel output while connecting the  
bypass register between JTDI and JTDO. The outputs do not change during the CLAMP instruction.  
HIGHZ  
All digital outputs of the device are placed in a high-impedance state. The BYPASS register is connected  
between JTDI and JTDO.  
IDCODE  
When the IDCODE instruction is latched into the parallel instruction register, the identification test  
register is selected. The device identification code is loaded into the identification register on the rising  
edge of JTCLK following entry into the Capture-DR state. Shift-DR can be used to shift the identification  
code out serially through JTDO. During Test-Logic-Reset, the identification code is forced into the  
instruction register’s parallel output. The ID code always has a 1 in the LSB position. The next 11 bits  
identify the manufacturer’s JEDEC number and number of continuation bytes followed by 16 bits for the  
device and 4 bits for the version (Table 34-B). Table 34-C lists the device ID codes for the SCT devices.  
203 of 238  
DS2155  
Table 34-B. ID Code Structure  
MSB  
LSB  
Version  
Device ID  
16 bits  
JEDEC  
1
1
Contact Factory  
4 bits  
00010100001  
Table 34-C. Device ID Codes  
PART  
16-BIT ID  
DS2155  
0010h  
0019h  
0005h  
0003h  
0004h  
0002h  
DS2156  
DS21354  
DS21554  
DS21352  
DS21552  
34.3 Test Registers  
IEEE 1149.1 requires a minimum of two test registers, the boundary scan register and the bypass register.  
An optional test register, the identification register, has been included with the DS2155 design. It is used  
with the IDCODE instruction and the Test-Logic-Reset state of the TAP controller.  
34.4 Boundary Scan Register  
This register contains both a shift register path and a latched parallel output for all control cells and digital  
I/O cells. It is n bits in length. See Table 34-D for cell bit locations and definitions.  
34.5 Bypass Register  
This is a single one-bit shift register used with the BYPASS, CLAMP, and HIGH-Z instructions that  
provides a short path between JTDI and JTDO.  
34.6 Identification Register  
The identification register contains a 32-bit shift register and a 32-bit latched parallel output. This register  
is selected during the IDCODE instruction and when the TAP controller is in the Test-Logic-Reset state.  
See Table 34-B and Table 34-C for more information on bit usage.  
204 of 238  
 
 
DS2155  
Table 34-D. Boundary Scan Control Bits  
BIT  
PIN  
NAME  
TYPE  
CONTROL BIT FUNCTION  
3
1
2
RCHBLK  
JTMS  
O
I
0 = BPCLK is an input  
2
BPCLK.cntl  
1 = BPCLK is an output  
1
3
4
5
6
7
BPCLK  
JTCLK  
JTRST  
RCL  
I/O  
I
I
O
I
0
JTDI  
0 = UOP0 is an input  
98  
97  
96  
95  
8
UOP0.cntl  
UOP0  
I/O  
1 = UOP0 is an output  
0 = UOP1 is an input  
UOP1.cntl  
1 = UOP1 is an output  
9
10  
11  
UOP1  
JTDO  
BTS  
I/O  
O
I
94  
93  
0 = LIUC is an input  
LIUC.cntl  
1 = LIUC is an output  
92  
91  
90  
89  
12  
LIUC  
8XCLK  
TSTRST  
UOP2  
I/O  
O
I
13  
14  
15  
O
I
I
16  
RTIP  
17  
18  
RRING  
RVDD  
RVSS  
I
19, 20, 24  
21  
MCLK  
XTALD  
22  
O
0 = UOP3 is an input  
1 = UOP3 is an output  
88  
UOP3.cntl  
87  
86  
85  
23  
25  
UOP3  
INT  
I/O  
O
26  
TUSEL  
N.C.  
I
27, 28  
29  
O
O
TTIP  
30  
TVSS  
TVDD  
TRING  
31  
32  
0 = TCHBLK is an input  
84  
83  
82  
33  
TCHBLK.cntl  
TCHBLK  
I/O  
1 = TCHBLK is an output  
0 = TLCLK is an input  
TLCLK.cntl  
1 = TLCLK is an output  
81  
80  
34  
35  
TLCLK  
TLINK  
I/O  
I
0 = ESIBS0 is an input  
79  
78  
77  
36  
ESIBS0.cntl  
ESIBS0  
I/O  
1 = ESIBS0 is an output  
0 = TSYNC is an input  
TSYNC.cntl  
1 = TSYNC is an output  
76  
75  
37  
38  
TSYNC  
TPOSI  
I/O  
I
205 of 238  
DS2155  
BIT  
PIN  
NAME  
TYPE  
CONTROL BIT FUNCTION  
74  
73  
39  
40  
TNEGI  
TCLKI  
I
I
0 = TCLKO is an input  
1 = TCLKO is an output  
72  
71  
70  
69  
68  
41  
42  
TCLKO.cntl  
TCLKO  
I/O  
0 = TNEGO is an input  
1 = TNEGO is an output  
TNEGO.cntl  
TNEGO  
I/O  
0 = TPOSO is an input  
TPOSO.cntl  
1 = TPOSO is an output  
67  
66  
65  
64  
63  
62  
61  
60  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
51  
52  
TPOSO  
DVDD  
DVSS  
I/O  
I
TCLK  
TSER  
I
I
TSIG  
TESO  
O
I
TDATA  
TSYSCLK  
TSSYNC  
I
I
0 = TCHCLK is an input  
59  
58  
57  
53  
TCHCLK.cntl  
TCHCLK  
I/O  
1 = TCHCLK is an output  
0 = ESIBS1 is an input  
ESIBS1.cntl  
1 = ESIBS1 is an output  
56  
55  
54  
55  
ESIBS1  
MUX  
I/O  
I
0 = D0–D7/AD0–AD7 are inputs  
54  
BUS.cntl  
1 = D0–D7/AD0–AD7 are inputs  
53  
52  
51  
50  
49  
48  
47  
46  
45  
44  
43  
42  
41  
40  
39  
38  
37  
36  
56  
D0/AD0  
D1/AD1  
D2/AD2  
D3/AD3  
DVSS  
DVDD  
D4/AD4  
D5/AD5  
D6/AD6  
D7/AD7  
A0  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I
57  
58  
59  
60, 80, 84  
61, 81, 83  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
A1  
I
68  
A2  
I
69  
A3  
I
70  
A4  
I
71  
A5  
I
72  
A6  
I
73  
ALE(AS)/A7  
RD (DS)  
CS  
I
74  
I
75  
I
0 = ESIBRD is an input  
35  
ESIBRD.cntl  
1 = ESIBRD is an output  
34  
33  
32  
31  
76  
77  
78  
79  
ESIBRD  
WR (R/W)  
RLINK  
I/O  
I
O
O
RLCLK  
206 of 238  
DS2155  
BIT  
PIN  
NAME  
TYPE  
CONTROL BIT FUNCTION  
30  
29  
82  
85  
RCLK  
O
O
RDATA  
0 = RPOSI is an input  
28  
27  
26  
25  
24  
86  
87  
RPOSI.cntl  
RPOSI  
I/O  
1 = RPOSI is an output  
0 = RNEGI is an input  
RNEGI.cntl  
RNEGI  
1 = RNEGI is an output  
I/O  
0 = RCLKI is an input  
RCLKI.cntl  
1 = RCLKI is an output  
23  
22  
21  
20  
88  
89  
90  
91  
RCLKI  
RCLKO  
RNEGO  
RPOSO  
I/O  
O
O
O
0 = RCHCLK is an input  
19  
18  
17  
16  
15  
92  
93  
RCHCLK.cntl  
RCHCLK  
RSIGF.cntl  
RSIGF  
I/O  
I/O  
1 = RCHCLK is an output  
0 = RSIGF is an input  
1 = RSIGF is an output  
I/O  
0 = RSIG is an input  
RSIG.cntl  
1 = RSIG is an output  
14  
13  
12  
11  
94  
95  
96  
RSIG  
RSER  
RMSYNC.cntl  
RMSYNC  
I/O  
O
I/O  
0 = RMSYNC is an input  
0 = RFSYNC is an input  
10  
9
97  
RFSYNC.cntl  
RFSYNC  
I/O  
1 = RFSYNC is an output  
0 = RSYNC is an input  
8
RSYNC.cntl  
1 = RSYNC is an output  
7
6
98  
99  
RSYNC  
RLOS/LOTC  
I/O  
O
0 = RSYSCLK is an input  
1 = RSYSCLK in an output  
5
4
RSYSCLK.cntl  
RSYSCLK  
100  
I/O  
207 of 238  
DS2155  
35. FUNCTIONAL TIMING DIAGRAMS  
35.1 T1 Mode  
Figure 35-1. Receive-Side D4 Timing  
1
FRAME#  
RFSYNC  
RSYNC1  
RSYNC 2  
RSYNC3  
RLCLK  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12  
1
2
3
4
5
RLINK 4  
Note 1: RSYNC in the frame mode (IOCR1.5 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is not enabled (IOCR1.6 = 0).  
Note 2: RSYNC in the frame mode (IOCR1.5 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is enabled (IOCR1.6 = 1).  
Note 3: RSYNC in the multiframe mode (IOCR1.5 = 1).  
Note 4: RLINK data (Fs bits) is updated one bit prior to even frames and held for two frames.  
Figure 35-2. Receive-Side ESF Timing  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24  
1
2
3
4
5
FRAME#  
RSYNC1  
RFSYNC  
RSYNC2  
RSYNC3  
RLCLK 4  
RLINK5  
TLCLK6  
TLINK 7  
Note 1: RSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.4 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is not enabled (IOCR1.6 = 0).  
Note 2: RSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.4 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is enabled (IOCR1.6 = 1).  
Note 3: RSYNC in multiframe mode (IOCR1.4 = 1).  
Note 4: ZBTSI mode disabled (T1RCR2.2 = 0).  
Note 5: RLINK data (FDL bits) is updated one bit time before odd frames and held for two frames.  
Note 6: ZBTSI mode is enabled (T1RCR2.2 = 1).  
Note 7: RLINK data (Z bits) is updated one bit time before odd frames and held for four frames.  
208 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 35-3. Receive-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)  
RCLK  
CHANNEL 23  
CHANNEL 24  
CHANNEL 1  
MSB  
LSB  
LSB MSB  
F
RSER  
RSYNC  
RFSYNC  
CHANNEL 23  
CHANNEL 24  
C/A  
CHANNEL 1  
A
C/A  
A
B
A
B
D/B  
D/B  
RSIG  
RCHCLK  
1
RCHBLK  
RLCLK  
2
RLINK  
Note 1: RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24.  
Note 2: Shown is RLINK/RLCLK in the ESF framing mode.  
Figure 35-4. Receive-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store  
Enabled)  
RSYSCLK  
CHANNEL 23  
CHANNEL 24  
CHANNEL 1  
MSB  
LSB  
LSB MSB  
F
RSER  
RSYNC1  
RMSYNC  
RSYNC2  
CHANNEL 1  
CHANNEL 23  
C/A  
CHANNEL 24  
C/A  
A
A
B
A
B
D/B  
D/B  
RSIG  
RCHCLK  
RCHBLK 3  
Note 1: RSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.4 = 0).  
Note 2: RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 1).  
Note 3: RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24.  
209 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 35-5. Receive-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store  
Enabled)  
RSYSCLK  
CHANNEL 31  
CHANNEL 32  
CHANNEL 1  
1
5
LSB  
F
LSB MSB  
RSER  
2
RSYNC  
RMSYNC  
3
RSYNC  
CHANNEL 1  
CHANNEL 32  
C/A  
CHANNEL 31  
C/A  
A
B
A
B
D/B  
D/B  
RSIG  
RCHCLK  
RCHBLK4  
Note 1: RSER data in channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 are forced to 1.  
Note 2: RSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.4 = 0).  
Note 3: RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 1).  
Note 4: RCHBLK is forced to 1 in the same channels as RSER (see Note 1).  
Note 5: The F-bit position is passed through the receive-side elastic store.  
Figure 35-6. Transmit-Side D4 Timing  
FRAME#  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12  
1
2
3
4
5
TSYNC1  
TSSYNC  
TSYNC2  
TSYNC3  
TLCLK  
TLINK4  
Note 1: TSYNC in the frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is not enabled (IOCR1.1 = 0).  
Note 2: TSYNC in the frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is enabled (IOCR1.1 = 1).  
Note 3: TSYNC in the multiframe mode (IOCR1.2 = 1).  
Note 4: TLINK data (Fs bits) is sampled during the F-bit position of even frames for insertion into the outgoing T1 stream when enabled through  
T1TCR1.2.  
210 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 35-7. Transmit-Side ESF Timing  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24  
1
2
3
4
5
FRAME#  
TSYNC1  
TSSYNC  
TSYNC2  
TSYNC3  
TLCLK4  
TLINK  
TLCLK5  
TLINK6  
Note 1: TSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is not enabled (IOCR1.3 = 0).  
Note 2: TSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0) and double-wide frame sync is enabled (IOCR1.3 = 1).  
Note 3: TSYNC in multiframe mode (IOCR1.2 = 1).  
Note 4: TLINK data (FDL bits) sampled during the F-bit time of odd frame and inserted into the outgoing T1 stream if enabled through TCR1.2.  
Note 5: ZBTSI mode is enabled (T1TCR2.1 = 1).  
Note 6: TLINK data (Z bits) sampled during the F-bit time of frames 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, and 21 and inserted into the outgoing stream if enabled  
through T1TCR1.2.  
Figure 35-8. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing (with Elastic Store Disabled)  
TCLK  
CHANNEL 1  
CHANNEL 2  
LSB  
F
MSB  
LSB MSB  
LSB MSB  
TSER  
TSYNC1  
TSYNC2  
CHANNEL 1  
CHANNEL 2  
D/B  
A
B
C/A D/B  
A
B
C/A D/B  
TSIG  
TCHCLK  
TCHBLK3  
TLCLK  
DON'T CARE  
TLINK4  
Note 1: TSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.1 = 1).  
Note 2: TSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.1 = 0).  
Note 3: TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 2.  
Note 4: Shown is TLINK/TLCLK in the ESF framing mode.  
211 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 35-9. Transmit-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store  
Enabled)  
TSYSCLK  
CHANNEL 23  
CHANNEL 24  
CHANNEL 1  
LSB MSB  
LSB  
F
MSB  
TSER  
TSSYNC  
CHANNEL 23  
CHANNEL 24  
CHANNEL 1  
A
A
B
C/A D/B  
A
B
C/A D/B  
TSIG  
TCHCLK  
TCHBLK1  
Note 1: TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24 (if the TPCSI bit is set, then the signaling data at TSIG is ignored during channel 24).  
Figure 35-10. Transmit-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store  
Enabled)  
TSYSCLK  
CHANNEL 31  
CHANNEL 32  
CHANNEL 1  
TSER1  
F4  
LSB MSB  
LSB  
TSSYNC  
CHANNEL 31  
CHANNEL 32  
CHANNEL 1  
A
B
C/A D/B  
A
B
C/A D/B  
A
TSIG  
TCHCLK  
TCHBLK2,3  
Note 1: TSER data in channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 is ignored.  
Note 2: TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 31 (if the TPCSI bit is set, then the signaling data at TSIG will be ignored).  
Note 3: TCHBLK is forced to 1 in the same channels as TSER is ignored (see Note 1).  
Note 4: The F-bit position for the T1 frame is sampled and passed through the transmit-side elastic store into the MSB bit position of channel 1.  
(Normally, the transmit-side formatter overwrites the F-bit position unless the formatter is programmed to pass through the F-bit  
position.)  
212 of 238  
DS2155  
35.2 E1 Mode  
Figure 35-11. Receive-Side Timing  
1
FRAME#  
RFSYNC  
RSYNC 1  
RSYNC2  
RLCLK 3  
RLINK 4  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16  
1
Note 1: RSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.5 = 0).  
Note 2: RSYNC in multiframe mode (IOCR1.5 = 1).  
Note 3: RLCLK is programmed to output just the Sa bits.  
Note 4: RLINK always outputs all five Sa bits as well as the rest of the receive data stream.  
Note 5: This diagram assumes the CAS MF begins in the RAF frame.  
Figure 35-12. Receive-Side Boundary Timing (with Elastic Store Disabled)  
RCLK  
CHANNEL 32  
CHANNEL 1  
CHANNEL 2  
MSB  
LSB Si  
1
A
Sa4 Sa5 Sa6 Sa7 Sa8  
RSER  
RSYNC  
RFSYNC  
CHANNEL 32  
CHANNEL 1  
CHANNEL 2  
C
D
A
A
B
B
RSIG  
RCHCLK  
RCHBLK1  
RLCLK  
Note 4  
RLINK 2  
Sa4 Sa5 Sa6 Sa7 Sa8  
Note 1: RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 1.  
Note 2: RLCLK is programmed to mark the Sa4 bit in RLINK.  
Note 3: Shown is a RNAF frame boundary.  
Note 4: RSIG normally contains the CAS multiframe alignment nibble (0000) in channel 1.  
213 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 35-13. Receive-Side Boundary Timing, RSYSCLK = 1.544MHz (Elastic  
Store Enabled)  
RSYSCLK  
CHANNEL 23/31  
LSB MSB  
CHANNEL 24/32  
CHANNEL 1/2  
RSER1  
RSYNC2  
RMSYNC  
RSYNC3  
MSB  
LSB  
F
RCHCLK  
RCHBLK 4  
Note 1: Data from the E1 channels 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, and 29 is dropped (channel 2 from the E1 link is mapped to channel 1 of the T1 link,  
etc.) and the F-bit position is added (forced to on 1).  
Note 2: RSYNC in the output mode (IOCR1.4 = 0).  
Note 3: RSYNC in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 1).  
Note 4: RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24.  
Figure 35-14. Receive-Side Boundary Timing, RSYSCLK = 2.048MHz (Elastic  
Store Enabled)  
RSYSCLK  
CHANNEL 31  
CHANNEL 32  
CHANNEL 1  
LSB MSB  
MSB  
LSB  
RSER  
RSYNC1  
RMSYNC  
2
RSYNC  
CHANNEL 1  
CHANNEL 32  
CHANNEL 31  
C
C
A
B
A
B
D
D
RSIG  
RCHCLK  
RCHBLK3  
Note 4  
Note 1: RSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.4 = 0).  
Note 2: RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 1).  
Note 3: RCHBLK is programmed to block channel 1.  
Note 4: RSIG normally contains the CAS multiframe alignment nibble (0000) in channel 1.  
214 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 35-15. Receive IBO Channel Interleave Mode Timing  
FRAMER #1, CHANNEL #1  
RSYNC  
1
F2 C32  
F2 C32  
F1 C1  
F1 C1  
F2 C1  
F2 C1  
F1 C2  
F1 C2  
F2 C2  
F2 C2  
RSER  
1
RSIG  
2
F3 32  
F3 C32  
F4 32  
F1 C1  
F1 C1  
F2 C1  
F2 C1  
F3 C1  
F3 C1  
F4 C1  
F4 C1  
F1 C2  
F1 C2  
F2 C2  
F2 C2  
F3 C2  
F3 C2  
F4 C2  
F4 C2  
RSER  
RSIG2  
F4 C32  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
3
RSER  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C32  
C32 C32 C32  
C1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
RSIG3  
C32  
C32 C32  
C32  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
BIT LEVEL DETAIL (4.096MHz bus configurtation)  
RSYSCLK  
RSYNC4  
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 1  
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 1  
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32  
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1  
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1  
MSB  
LSB  
LSB  
D
LSB MSB  
RSER  
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32  
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
A
B
C
D
RSIG  
Note 1: 4.096MHz bus configuration.  
Note 2: 8.192MHz bus configuration.  
Note 3: 16.384MHz bus configuration.  
Note 4: RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 0).  
215 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 35-16. Receive IBO Frame Interleave Mode Timing  
FRAMER #1, CHANNELS 1 through 32  
RSYNC  
1
F2  
F2  
F1  
F1  
F2  
F2  
F1  
F1  
F2  
F2  
RSER  
1
RSIG  
2
F3  
F3  
F5  
F4  
F4  
F1  
F1  
F2  
F2  
F3  
F3  
F4  
F4  
F1  
F1  
F2  
F2  
F3  
F3  
F4  
F4  
RSER  
RSIG2  
3
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
RSER  
RSIG3  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
BIT LEVEL DETAIL (4.096MHz bus configurtation)  
RSYSCLK  
RSYNC4  
FRAMER1, CHANNEL 2  
FRAMER1, CHANNEL 2  
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32  
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1  
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1  
MSB  
LSB  
LSB  
D
LSB MSB  
RSER  
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32  
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
A
B
C
D
RSIG  
Note 1: 4.096MHz bus configuration.  
Note 2: 8.192MHz bus configuration.  
Note 3: 16.384MHz bus configuration.  
Note 4: RSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.4 = 0).  
216 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 35-17. G.802 Timing, E1 Mode Only  
31 32 0  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 0  
1
2
TS #  
RSYNC  
TSYNC  
RCHCLK  
TCHCLK  
RCHBLK  
TCHBLK  
RCLK / RSYSCLK  
TCLK / TSYSCLK  
CHANNEL 25  
CHANNEL 26  
MSB  
LSB  
RSER / TSER  
RCHCLK / TCHCLK  
RCHBLK / TCHBLK  
Note 1: RCHBLK or TCHBLK programmed to pulse high during time slots 1 through 15, 17 through 25, and bit 1 of time slot 26.  
Figure 35-18. Transmit-Side Timing  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12 13  
1
14 15 16  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
FRAME# 14 15 16  
TSYNC1  
TSSYNC  
TSYNC2  
TLCLK 3  
TLINK3  
Note 1: TSYNC in frame mode (IOCR1.2 = 0).  
Note 2: TSYNC in multiframe mode (IOCR1.2 = 1).  
Note 3: TLINK is programmed to source just the Sa4 bit.  
Note 4: This diagram assumes both the CAS MF and the CRC4 MF begin with the TAF frame.  
Note 5: TLINK and TLCLK are not synchronous with TSSYNC.  
217 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 35-19. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)  
TCLK  
CHANNEL 1  
CHANNEL 2  
LSB  
MSB  
LSB MSB  
Si  
1
A
Sa4 Sa5 Sa6 Sa7 Sa8  
TSER  
TSYNC1  
TSYNC2  
CHANNEL 1  
CHANNEL 2  
D
A
B
C
D
TSIG  
TCHCLK  
TCHBLK3  
TLCLK4  
TLINK4  
DON'T CARE  
DON'T CARE  
Note 1: TSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.1 = 1).  
Note 2: TSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.1 = 0).  
Note 3: TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 2.  
Note 4: TLINK is programmed to source the Sa4 bit.  
Note 5: The signaling data at TSIG during channel 1 is normally overwritten in the transmit formatter with the CAS MF alignment nibble (0000).  
Note 6: Shown is a TNAF frame boundary.  
Figure 35-20. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing, TSYSCLK = 1.544MHz  
(Elastic Store Enabled)  
TSYSCLK  
CHANNEL 23  
CHANNEL 24  
CHANNEL 1  
1
LSB MSB  
LSB  
F
MSB  
TSER  
TSSYNC  
TCHCLK  
TCHBLK2  
Note 1: The F-bit position in the TSER data is ignored.  
Note 2: TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 24.  
218 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 35-21. Transmit-Side Boundary Timing, TSYSCLK = 2.048MHz (Elastic  
Store Enabled)  
TSYSCLK  
CHANNEL 31  
CHANNEL 32  
CHANNEL 1  
CHANNEL 1  
TSER1  
F4  
LSB MSB  
LSB  
D
TSSYNC  
CHANNEL 31  
CHANNEL 32  
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
A
TSIG  
TCHCLK  
TCHBLK2,3  
Note 1: TCHBLK is programmed to block channel 31.  
219 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 35-22. Transmit IBO Channel Interleave Mode Timing  
FRAMER #1, CHANNEL #1  
TSSYNC  
1
F2 C32  
F2 C32  
F1 C1  
F1 C1  
F2 C1  
F2 C1  
F1 C2  
F1 C2  
F2 C2  
F2 C2  
TSER  
TRSIG 1  
TSER2  
TSIG2  
F3 32  
F3 C32  
F4 32  
F1 C1  
F1 C1  
F2 C1  
F2 C1  
F3 C1  
F3 C1  
F4 C1  
F4 C1  
F1 C2  
F1 C2  
F2 C2  
F2 C2  
F3 C2  
F3 C2  
F4 C2  
F4 C2  
F4 C32  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
TSER3  
TSIG3  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C32  
C32 C32 C32  
C1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
C32  
C32 C32  
C32  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C1  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
C2  
BIT LEVEL DETAIL (4.096MHz bus configurtation)  
TSYSCLK  
TSYNC4  
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 1  
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 1  
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32  
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1  
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1  
MSB  
LSB  
LSB  
D
LSB MSB  
TSER  
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32  
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
A
B
C
D
TSIG  
Note 1: 4.096MHz bus configuration.  
Note 2: 8.192MHz bus configuration.  
Note 3: 16.384MHz bus configuration.  
Note 4: TSYNC is in input mode.  
220 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 35-23. Transmit IBO Frame Interleave Mode Timing  
FRAMER #1, CHANNELS 1 through 32  
TSSYNC  
1
F2  
F2  
F1  
F1  
F2  
F2  
F1  
F1  
F2  
F2  
TSER  
1
TSIG  
TSER2  
TSIG2  
TSER3  
TSIG3  
F3  
F3  
F5  
F4  
F4  
F1  
F1  
F2  
F2  
F3  
F3  
F4  
F4  
F1  
F1  
F2  
F2  
F3  
F3  
F4  
F4  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
BIT LEVEL DETAIL (4.096MHz bus configurtation)  
TSYSCLK  
TSYNC4  
FRAMER1, CHANNEL 2  
FRAMER1, CHANNEL 2  
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32  
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1  
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1  
MSB  
LSB  
LSB  
D
LSB MSB  
TSER  
FRAMER2, CHANNEL 32  
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
A
B
C
D
TSIG  
Note 1: 4.096MHz bus configuration.  
Note 2: 8.192MHz bus configuration.  
Note 3: 16.384MHz bus configuration.  
Note 4: TSYNC is in input mode.  
221 of 238  
DS2155  
36. OPERATING PARAMETERS  
ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS  
Voltage Range on Any Pin Relative to Ground  
Operating Temperature Range for DS2155L  
Operating Temperature Range for DS2155LN  
Storage Temperature Range  
-1.0V to +6.0V  
0°C to +70°C  
-40°C to +85°C (Note 1)  
-55°C to +125°C  
Soldering Temperature  
See IPC/JEDEC J-STD-020  
This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions above those indicated in the operation  
sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods of time may affect reliability.  
Note 1: Specifications to -40°C are guaranteed by design and not production tested.  
THERMAL CHARACTERISTICS  
PARAMETER  
Ambient Temperature  
Junction Temperature  
CONDITIONS  
MIN  
TYP  
MAX  
+85°C  
+125°C  
(Note 2)  
-40°C  
Theta-JA (θJA) in Still Air for  
100-Pin LQFP  
Theta-JA (θJA) in Still Air for  
10mm CSBGA  
(Note 3)  
(Note 3)  
+32°C/W  
+40°C/W  
THETA-JA (θJA) vs. AIRFLOW  
FORCED AIR  
(meters per second)  
THETA-JA (θJA)  
100-PIN LQFP  
+32°C/W  
THETA-JA (θJA)  
10mm CSBGA  
40°C/W  
0
1
+27°C/W  
34°C/W  
2.5  
+24°C/W  
30°C/W  
RECOMMENDED DC OPERATING CONDITIONS  
(TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155L; TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS2155LN.)  
PARAMETER  
Logic 1  
Logic 0  
Supply  
SYMBOL  
CONDITIONS  
MIN  
TYP  
MAX  
UNITS  
VIH  
VIL  
VDD  
2.0  
-0.3  
3.135  
5.5  
+0.8  
3.465  
V
V
V
(Note 4)  
3.3  
CAPACITANCE  
(TA = +25°C)  
PARAMETER  
Input Capacitance  
SYMBOL  
CIN  
CONDITIONS  
MIN  
TYP  
MAX  
UNITS  
pF  
5
7
Output Capacitance  
COUT  
pF  
222 of 238  
DS2155  
DC CHARACTERISTICS  
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155L; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS2155LN.)  
PARAMETER  
Supply Current  
Input Leakage  
Output Leakage  
Output Current (2.4V)  
Output Current (0.4V)  
SYMBOL  
CONDITIONS  
(Note 5)  
(Note 6)  
(Note 7)  
MIN  
TYP  
MAX  
UNITS  
IDD  
IIL  
ILO  
IOH  
IOL  
75  
mA  
μA  
μA  
mA  
mA  
-1.0  
+1.0  
1.0  
-1.0  
+4.0  
Note 2: The package is mounted on a four-layer JEDEC standard test board.  
Note 3: Theta-JA (θJA) is the junction to ambient thermal resistance, when the package is mounted on a four-layer JEDEC standard test board.  
Note 4: Applies to RVDD, TVDD, and DVDD  
.
Note 5: TCLK = TCLKI = RCLKI = TSYSCLK = RSYSCLK = MCLK = 1.544MHz; outputs open-circuited.  
Note 6: 0.0V < VIN < VDD  
Note 7: Applied to INT when tri-stated.  
223 of 238  
DS2155  
37. AC TIMING PARAMETERS AND DIAGRAMS  
Capacitive test loads are 40pF for bus signals, 20pF for all others.  
37.1Multiplexed Bus AC Characteristics  
AC CHARACTERISTICS: MULTIPLEXED PARALLEL PORT (MUX = 1)  
(Figure 37-1, Figure 37-2, and Figure 37-3)  
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155L; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS2155LN.)  
PARAMETER  
SYMBOL CONDITIONS MIN  
TYP MAX UNITS  
Cycle Time  
tCYC  
PWEL  
PWEH  
tR, tF  
tRWH  
200  
100  
100  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
Pulse Width, DS Low or RD High  
Pulse Width, DS High or RD Low  
Input Rise/Fall Times  
R/W Hold Time  
R/W Setup Time Before DS High  
20  
50  
10  
50  
tRWS  
CS Setup Time Before DS, WR, or RD  
tCS  
20  
ns  
Active  
tCH  
tDHR  
tDHW  
tASL  
tAHL  
0
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
CS Hold Time  
Read Data Hold Time  
Write Data Hold Time  
Muxed Address Valid to AS or ALE Fall  
10  
0
15  
10  
Muxed Address Hold Time  
Delay Time DS, WR, or RD to AS or ALE  
tASD  
20  
ns  
Rise  
Pulse Width AS or ALE High  
Delay Time, AS or ALE to DS, WR or RD  
Output Data Delay Time from DS or RD  
PWASH  
tASED  
tDDR  
30  
10  
20  
ns  
ns  
ns  
80  
Data Setup Time  
tDSW  
50  
ns  
224 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 37-1. Intel Multiplexed Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 1)  
t
CYC  
ALE  
PW  
ASH  
t
ASD  
WR*  
RD*  
t
ASED  
t
ASD  
PW  
EH  
t
t
CH  
PW  
CS  
EL  
CS*  
t
t
ASL  
t
DHR  
DDR  
AD0-AD7  
t
AHL  
Figure 37-2. Intel Multiplexed Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 1)  
t
CYC  
ALE  
PW  
ASH  
t
ASD  
RD*  
WR*  
t
t
ASED  
ASD  
PW  
EH  
t
t
CH  
PW  
EL  
CS  
CS*  
t
t
ASL  
DHW  
AD0-AD7  
t
t
AHL  
DSW  
225 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 37-3. Motorola Multiplexed Bus Timing (BTS = 1/MUX = 1)  
PW  
ASH  
AS  
PW  
EH  
t
t
ASED  
ASD  
DS  
PW  
EL  
t
CYC  
t
t
RWS  
RWH  
R/W*  
t
t
DDR  
t
ASL  
DHR  
AD0-AD7  
(read)  
t
t
AHL  
t
CH  
CS  
CS*  
t
DSW  
t
ASL  
t
AD0-AD7  
(write)  
t
DHW  
AHL  
226 of 238  
DS2155  
37.2Nonmultiplexed Bus AC Characteristics  
AC CHARACTERISTICS: NONMULTIPLEXED PARALLEL PORT (MUX = 0)  
(Figure 37-4, Figure 37-5, Figure 37-6, and Figure 37-7)  
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155L; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C; for DS2155LN.)  
PARAMETER  
SYMBOL CONDITIONS MIN  
TYP MAX UNITS  
Setup Time for A0 to A7, Valid to CS  
t1  
t2  
t3  
t4  
t5  
0
0
ns  
Active  
Setup Time for CS Active to Either RD,  
WR, or DS Active  
ns  
Delay Time from Either RD or DS Active  
75  
20  
ns  
ns  
ns  
to Data Valid  
Hold Time from Either RD, WR, or DS  
Inactive to CS Inactive  
0
5
Hold Time from CS Inactive to Data Bus  
Tri-State  
Wait Time from Either WR or DS Active  
t6  
t7  
t8  
t9  
75  
10  
10  
10  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
to Latch Data  
Data Setup Time to Either WR or DS  
Inactive  
Data Hold Time from Either WR or DS  
Inactive  
Address Hold from Either WR or DS  
Inactive  
227 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 37-4. Intel Nonmultiplexed Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 0)  
ADDRESS VALID  
A0 to A7  
DATA VALID  
D0 to D7  
t5  
5ns (min) / 20ns (max)  
WR  
CS  
RD  
t1  
0ns (min)  
t2  
0ns (min)  
t3  
t4  
0ns (min)  
50ns (max)  
Figure 37-5. Intel Nonmultiplexed Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0/MUX = 0)  
ADDRESS VALID  
A0 to A7  
D0 to D7  
t7  
t8  
10ns (min)  
10ns (min)  
RD  
CS  
t1  
0ns (min)  
t2  
t6  
75ns (min)  
t4  
0ns (min)  
0ns (min)  
WR  
228 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 37-6. Motorola Nonmultiplexed Bus Read Timing (BTS = 1/MUX = 0)  
ADDRESS VALID  
A0 to A7  
D0 to D7  
R/W  
DATA VALID  
5ns (min) / 20ns (max)  
t5  
t1  
0ns (min)  
t2  
CS  
t3  
t4  
0ns (min)  
0ns (min)  
75ns (max)  
DS  
Figure 37-7. Motorola Nonmultiplexed Bus Write Timing (BTS = 1/MUX = 0)  
ADDRESS VALID  
A0 to A7  
D0 to D7  
10ns (min)  
10ns (min)  
0ns (min)  
t8  
t7  
R/W  
CS  
t1  
0ns (min)  
t2  
t6  
75ns (min)  
t4  
0ns (min)  
DS  
229 of 238  
DS2155  
37.3Receive-Side AC Characteristics  
AC CHARACTERISTICS: RECEIVE SIDE  
(Figure 37-8., Figure 37-9, and Figure 37-10)  
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155L; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS2155LN.)  
PARAMETER  
RCLKO Period  
SYMBOL CONDITIONS MIN  
TYP  
488 (E1)  
648 (T1)  
MAX UNITS  
tLP  
ns  
tLH  
(Note 1)  
200  
0.5 tLP  
0.5 tLP  
0.5 tLP  
RCLKO Pulse Width  
RCLKO Pulse Width  
ns  
ns  
tLL  
tLH  
tLL  
200  
150  
150  
(Note 1)  
(Note 2)  
(Note 2)  
0.5 tLP  
488 (E1)  
648 (T1)  
0.5 tCP  
RCLKI Period  
tCP  
ns  
ns  
tCH  
tCL  
20  
20  
RCLKI Pulse Width  
0.5 tCP  
(Note 3)  
(Note 4)  
(Note 5)  
(Note 6)  
(Note 7)  
648  
488  
244  
122  
61  
ns  
ns  
RSYSCLK Period  
tSP  
tSH  
tSL  
20  
20  
0.5 tSP  
0.5 tSP  
ns  
ns  
RSYSCLK Pulse Width  
RSYNC Setup to RSYSCLK Falling  
RSYNC Pulse Width  
RPOSI/RNEGI Setup to RCLKI Falling  
tSU  
tPW  
tSU  
20  
50  
20  
ns  
ns  
ns  
RPOSI/RNEGI Hold From RCLKI  
tHD  
20  
ns  
Falling  
RSYSCLK, RCLKI Rise and Fall Times  
tR, tF  
tDD  
22  
50  
ns  
ns  
Delay RCLKO to RPOSO, RNEGO Valid  
Delay RCLK to RSER, RDATA, RSIG,  
RLINK Valid  
tD1  
50  
ns  
Delay RCLK to RCHCLK, RSYNC,  
tD2  
tD3  
tD4  
50  
22  
22  
ns  
ns  
ns  
RCHBLK, RFSYNC, RLCLK  
Delay RSYSCLK to RSER, RSIG Valid  
Delay RSYSCLK to RCHCLK,  
RCHBLK, RMSYNC, RSYNC  
Note 1: Jitter attenuator enabled in the receive path.  
Note 2: Jitter attenuator disabled or enabled in the transmit path.  
Note 3: RSYSCLK = 1.544MHz  
Note 4: RSYSCLK = 2.048MHz  
Note 5: RSYSCLK = 4.096MHz  
Note 6: RSYSCLK = 8.192MHz  
Note 7: RSYSCLK = 16.384MHz  
230 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 37-8. Receive-Side Timing  
RCLK  
t
D1  
1ST FRAME BIT  
RSER / RDATA / RSIG  
t
t
D2  
D2  
1
RSYNC  
RFSYNC / RMSYNC  
RCHCLK  
t
D2  
t
t
D2  
D2  
RCHBLK  
2
RLCLK  
t
D1  
RLINK (T1MODE)  
Sa4 to Sa8  
Bit Position  
4
RLINK (E1 MODE)  
Note 1: RSYNC is in the output mode.  
Note 2: Shown is RLINK/RLCLK in the ESF framing mode.  
Note 3: No relationship between RCHCLK and RCHBLK and other signals is implied.  
Note 4: RLCLK only pulses high during Sa bit locations as defined in the E1RCR2 register.  
231 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 37-9. Receive-Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled  
t
t
SL  
SH  
t
t
F
R
RSYSCLK  
t
SP  
t
D3  
SEE NOTE 3  
RSER / RSIG  
t
D4  
RCHCLK  
RCHBLK  
RMSYNC  
t
D4  
t
t
D4  
D4  
1
RSYNC  
t
HD  
t
SU  
2
RSYNC  
Note 1: RSYNC is in the output mode.  
Note 2: RSYNC is in the input mode.  
Note 3: F-bit when MSTRREG.1 = 0, MSB of TS0 when MSTREG.1 = 1.  
Figure 37-10. Receive Line Interface Timing  
t
t
LL  
LH  
RCLKO  
t
t
LP  
DD  
RPOSO, RNEGO  
t
t
CL  
CH  
t
t
F
R
RCLKI  
t
t
CP  
SU  
RPOSI, RNEGI  
t
HD  
232 of 238  
DS2155  
37.4Backplane Clock Timing: AC Characteristics  
AC CHARACTERISTICS: BACKPLANE CLOCK SYNTHESIS  
(Figure 37-11)  
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155L; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS2155LN.)  
PARAMETER  
Delay RCLK to BPCLK  
SYMBOL CONDITIONS MIN  
TYP  
MAX UNITS  
10 ns  
tD1  
Figure 37-11 Receive Timing Delay RCLK to BPCLK  
RCLK  
t
D1  
BPCLK  
Note 1: If RCLK is 1.544 MHz, BPCLK will be asynchronous.  
233 of 238  
 
DS2155  
37.5Transmit AC Characteristics  
AC CHARACTERISTICS: TRANSMIT SIDE  
(Figure 37-12, Figure 37-13, and Figure 37-14)  
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C for DS2155L; VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = 0°C to +70°C for DS2155LN)  
PARAMETER  
TCLK Period  
SYMBOL CONDITIONS MIN TYP (E1) MAX UNITS  
488 (E1)  
tCP  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
648 (T1)  
0.5 tCP  
0.5 tCP  
488 (E1)  
648 (T1)  
0.5 tLP  
0.5 tLP  
648  
tCH  
tCL  
20  
20  
TCLK Pulse Width  
TCLKI Period  
tLP  
tLH  
tLL  
20  
20  
TCLKI Pulse Width  
(Note 8)  
(Note 9)  
(Note 10)  
(Note 11)  
(Note 12)  
448  
244  
TSYSCLK Period  
tSP  
ns  
122  
61  
20  
20  
0.5 tSP  
TSYSCLK Pulse Width  
tSP  
ns  
0.5 tSP  
TSYNC or TSSYNC Setup to TCLK or  
TSYSCLK Falling  
TSYNC or TSSYNC Pulse Width  
tSU  
20  
50  
ns  
ns  
tPW  
TSER, TSIG, TDATA, TLINK, TPOSI,  
TNEGI Setup to TCLK, TSYSCLK,  
TCLKI Falling  
tSU  
20  
ns  
TSER, TSIG, TDATA, TLINK Hold  
from TCLK or TSYSCLK Falling  
TPOSI, TNEGI Hold from TCLKI  
Falling  
tHD  
tHD  
tR, tF  
tDD  
tD1  
20  
20  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
TCLK, TCLKI or TSYSCLK Rise and  
Fall Times  
25  
50  
50  
50  
22  
Delay TCLKO to TPOSO, TNEGO  
Valid  
Delay TCLK to TESO, UT-UTDO  
Valid  
Delay TCLK to TCHBLK, TCHCLK,  
TSYNC, TLCLK  
tD2  
Delay TSYSCLK to TCHCLK,  
TCHBLK  
tD3  
Note 8: TSYSCLK = 1.544MHz  
Note 9: TSYSCLK = 2.048MHz  
Note 10: TSYSCLK = 4.096MHz  
Note 11: TSYSCLK = 8.192MHz  
Note 12: TSYSCLK = 16.384MHz  
234 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 37-12. Transmit-Side Timing  
t
CP  
t
t
CL  
CH  
t
t
F
R
TCLK  
TESO  
t
D1  
t
SU  
TSER / TSIG /  
TDATA  
t
t
HD  
D2  
TCHCLK  
TCHBLK  
t
D2  
t
D2  
1
TSYNC  
t
HD  
t
SU  
2
TSYNC  
t
D2  
5
TLCLK  
t
HD  
TLINK  
t
SU  
Note 1: TSYNC is in the output mode (IOCR1.1 = 1).  
Note 2: TSYNC is in the input mode (IOCR1.1 = 0).  
Note 3: TSER is sampled on the falling edge of TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled.  
Note 4: TCHCLK and TCHBLK are synchronous with TCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled.  
Note 5: In E1 mode, TLINK is only sampled during Sa bit locations as defined in E1TCR2; no relationship between TLCLK/TLINK and TSYNC  
is implied.  
235 of 238  
DS2155  
Figure 37-13. Transmit-Side Timing, Elastic Store Enabled  
t
SP  
t
t
SL  
SH  
t
t
F
R
TSYSCLK  
TSER  
t
SU  
t
t
D3  
HD  
TCHCLK  
TCHBLK  
t
D3  
t
HD  
t
SU  
TSSYNC  
Note 1: TSER is only sampled on the falling edge of TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled.  
Note 2: TCHCLK and TCHBLK are synchronous with TSYSCLK when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled.  
Figure 37-14. Transmit Line Interface Timing  
TCLKO  
TPOSO, TNEGO  
t
DD  
t
LP  
t
t
LL  
LH  
t
t
F
R
TCLKI  
t
SU  
TPOSI, TNEGI  
t
HD  
236 of 238  
DS2155  
38. PACKAGE INFORMATION  
(The package drawing(s) in this data sheet may not reflect the most current specifications. The package number provided for  
each package is a link to the latest package outline information.)  
38.1 100-Pin LQFP (56-G5002-000)  
237 of 238  
DS2155  
38.2 100-Ball CSBGA (56-G6008-001)  
238 of 238  
Maxim/Dallas Semiconductor cannot assume responsibility for use of any circuitry other than circuitry entirely embodied in a Maxim/Dallas Semiconductor product.  
No circuit patent licenses are implied. Maxim/Dallas Semiconductor reserves the right to change the circuitry and specifications without notice at any time.  
Maxim Integrated Products, 120 San Gabriel Drive, Sunnyvale, CA 94086 408-737-7600  
© 2007 Maxim Integrated Products  
The Maxim logo is a registered trademark of Maxim Integrated Products, Inc. The Dallas logo is a registered trademark of Dallas Semiconductor.  

相关型号:

SI9130DB

5- and 3.3-V Step-Down Synchronous Converters

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9135LG-T1

SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply Controller

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9135LG-T1-E3

SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply Controller

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9135_11

SMBus Multi-Output Power-Supply Controller

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9136_11

Multi-Output Power-Supply Controller

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9130CG-T1-E3

Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCs

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9130LG-T1-E3

Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCs

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9130_11

Pin-Programmable Dual Controller - Portable PCs

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9137

Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile Applications

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9137DB

Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile Applications

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9137LG

Multi-Output, Sequence Selectable Power-Supply Controller for Mobile Applications

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY

SI9122E

500-kHz Half-Bridge DC/DC Controller with Integrated Secondary Synchronous Rectification Drivers

Warning: Undefined variable $rtag in /www/wwwroot/website_ic37/www.icpdf.com/pdf/pdf/index.php on line 217
-
VISHAY